Sie sind auf Seite 1von 252

NONRESIDENT

TRAINING
COURSE
November 1991

Military Requirements
for Petty Officer
First Class
NAVEDTRA 14145

DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT A: Approved for public release; distribution is unlimited.


Although the words he, him, and
his are used sparingly in this course to
enhance communication, they are not
intended to be gender driven or to affront or
discriminate against anyone.

DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT A: Approved for public release; distribution is unlimited.


COMMANDING OFFICER
NETPDTC
6490 SAUFLEY FIELD RD
PENSACOLA, FL 32509-5237

ERRATA #1 22 Sep 1997

Specific Instructions and Errata for


Training Manual

MILITARY REQUIREMENTS FOR PETTY OFFICER FIRST CLASS

1. No attempt has been made to issue corrections for errors in typing,


punctuation, etc.

2. In the training manual, delete the information under the following


heading, which begins on page 2-8 and ends on page 2-27.

Heading
"Enlisted Performance Evaluation Report"
PREFACE
By enrolling in this self-study course, you have demonstrated a desire to improve yourself and the Navy.
Remember, however, this self-study course is only one part of the total Navy training program. Practical
experience, schools, selected reading, and your desire to succeed are also necessary to successfully round
out a fully meaningful training program.

THE COURSE: This self-study course is organized into subject matter areas, each containing learning
objectives to help you determine what you should learn along with text and illustrations to help you
understand the information. The subject matter reflects day-to-day requirements and experiences of
personnel in the rating or skill area. It also reflects guidance provided by Enlisted Community Managers
(ECMs) and other senior personnel, technical references, instructions, etc., and either the occupational or
naval standards, which are listed in the Manual of Navy Enlisted Manpower Personnel Classifications
and Occupational Standards, NAVPERS 18068.

THE QUESTIONS: The questions that appear in this course are designed to help you understand the
material in the text.

VALUE: In completing this course, you will improve your military and professional knowledge.
Importantly, it can also help you study for the Navy-wide advancement in rate examination. If you are
studying and discover a reference in the text to another publication for further information, look it up.

1991 Edition Prepared by


MMC(SW) David S. Love and
BMC Mark R. Williams

Published by
NAVAL EDUCATION AND TRAINING
PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT
AND TECHNOLOGY CENTER

NAVSUP Logistics Tracking Number


0504-LP-026-7990

i
Sailors Creed

I am a United States Sailor.

I will support and defend the


Constitution of the United States of
America and I will obey the orders
of those appointed over me.

I represent the fighting spirit of the


Navy and those who have gone
before me to defend freedom and
democracy around the world.

I proudly serve my countrys Navy


combat team with honor, courage
and commitment.

I am committed to excellence and


the fair treatment of all.

ii
CONTENTS

CHAPTER Page

l. U. S. Naval Tradition....... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1

2. Leadership and Administrative Responsibilities . . . . . . . . 2-1

3. Programs and Policies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1

4. Professional Responsibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1

5. Military Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1

6. Safety and Survival . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1

7. Damage Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1

INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . .. INDEX-1

iii
INTRODUCTION TO MILITARY
REQUIREMENTS AND THE NAVAL
STANDARDS
The United States Navy has always placed the Navy. Your knowledge of NAVSTDs will be
great emphasis on the pride and professionalism tested on the military/leadership examination.
of its personnel. In keeping with this strong Unlike the Navy occupational standards, which
tradition, the Navy has taken a different approach state the tasks enlisted personnel are required to
in teaching military subjects by developing perform, naval standards, for the most part, state
individual military requirements training manuals. the knowledge required.
These manuals are divided into the basic military NAVSTDs encompass military requirements,
requirements (BMR) for apprenticeships and essential virtues of professionalism and pride of
advanced requirements for third class, second service in support of the oath of enlistment, and
class, first class, chief petty officers, and senior maintenance of good order and discipline. They
and master chief petty officers. These manuals also include knowledges pertaining to the well-
cover the MINIMUM naval standards required being of Navy personnel that directly contribute
for advancement in rate. to the mission of the Navy.
The purpose of the separate manuals for each
rate is to define more clearly the duties and NAVSTDs apply to all personnel at the
responsibilities of the petty officer at each rate. specified paygrade except where specific
That simply means if you are studying for advan- limitations are indicated. Primarily two factors
cement to first class petty officer, you will study make these qualifications necessarythe basic
material that applies to the first class. This is not requirements of duty at sea and the requirements
to say that a first class petty officer performs only of duty in an armed force. For example, all Navy
at that level. Many times the needs of the service personnel must know certain elements of
require a first class petty officer to fill the billet seamanship and must be prepared to assume battle
of a more senior petty officer or a commissioned station duties. Both men and women must learn
officer. That has always been the case and will the general orders for a sentry, be able to stand
continue to be true. a security watch, and possess certain skills and
Because the manuals have been separated knowledges needed for their own protection and
according to rate, you can now study the required survival. Certain other qualifications, mainly in
material at the appropriate time in your career. clerical and administrative duties, have been
added to the military and seagoing requirements
because knowledge of them is important for all
NAVAL STANDARDS enlisted personnel regardless of occupational
specialty.
Naval standards (NAVSTEs) are those This training manual covers the naval
qualifications which specify the minimum standards (military requirements) for petty officer
knowledges required of all enlisted personnel in first class.

iv
INSTRUCTIONS FOR TAKING THE COURSE

ASSIGNMENTS assignments. To submit your assignment


answers via the Internet, go to:
The text pages that you are to study are listed at
the beginning of each assignment. Study these https://courses.cnet.navy.mil
pages carefully before attempting to answer the
questions. Pay close attention to tables and Grading by Mail: When you submit answer
illustrations and read the learning objectives. sheets by mail, send all of your assignments at
The learning objectives state what you should be one time. Do NOT submit individual answer
able to do after studying the material. Answering sheets for grading. Mail all of your assignments
the questions correctly helps you accomplish the in an envelope, which you either provide
objectives. yourself or obtain from your nearest Educational
Services Officer (ESO). Submit answer sheets
SELECTING YOUR ANSWERS to:

Read each question carefully, then select the COMMANDING OFFICER


BEST answer. You may refer freely to the text. NETPDTC N331
The answers must be the result of your own 6490 SAUFLEY FIELD ROAD
work and decisions. You are prohibited from PENSACOLA FL 32559-5000
referring to or copying the answers of others and
from giving answers to anyone else taking the Answer Sheets: All courses include one
course. scannable answer sheet for each assignment.
These answer sheets are preprinted with your
SUBMITTING YOUR ASSIGNMENTS SSN, name, assignment number, and course
number. Explanations for completing the answer
To have your assignments graded, you must be sheets are on the answer sheet.
enrolled in the course with the Nonresident
Training Course Administration Branch at the Do not use answer sheet reproductions: Use
Naval Education and Training Professional only the original answer sheets that we
Development and Technology Center providereproductions will not work with our
(NETPDTC). Following enrollment, there are scanning equipment and cannot be processed.
two ways of having your assignments graded:
(1) use the Internet to submit your assignments Follow the instructions for marking your
as you complete them, or (2) send all the answers on the answer sheet. Be sure that blocks
assignments at one time by mail to NETPDTC. 1, 2, and 3 are filled in correctly. This
information is necessary for your course to be
Grading on the Internet: Advantages to properly processed and for you to receive credit
Internet grading are: for your work.

you may submit your answers as soon as COMPLETION TIME


you complete an assignment, and
you get your results faster; usually by the Courses must be completed within 12 months
next working day (approximately 24 hours). from the date of enrollment. This includes time
required to resubmit failed assignments.
In addition to receiving grade results for each
assignment, you will receive course completion
confirmation once you have completed all the

v
PASS/FAIL ASSIGNMENT PROCEDURES For subject matter questions:

If your overall course score is 3.2 or higher, you E-mail: n314.products@cnet.navy.mil


will pass the course and will not be required to Phone: Comm: (850) 452-1001, Ext. 1826
resubmit assignments. Once your assignments DSN: 922-1001, Ext. 1826
have been graded you will receive course FAX: (850) 452-1370
completion confirmation. (Do not fax answer sheets.)
Address: COMMANDING OFFICER
If you receive less than a 3.2 on any assignment NETPDTC (CODE 314)
and your overall course score is below 3.2, you 6490 SAUFLEY FIELD ROAD
will be given the opportunity to resubmit failed PENSACOLA FL 32509-5237
assignments. You may resubmit failed
assignments only once. Internet students will For enrollment, shipping, grading, or
receive notification when they have failed an completion letter questions
assignment--they may then resubmit failed
assignments on the web site. Internet students E-mail: fleetservices@cnet.navy.mil
may view and print results for failed Phone: Toll Free: 877-264-8583
assignments from the web site. Students who Comm: (850) 452-1511/1181/1859
submit by mail will receive a failing result letter DSN: 922-1511/1181/1859
and a new answer sheet for resubmission of each FAX: (850) 452-1370
failed assignment. (Do not fax answer sheets.)
Address: COMMANDING OFFICER
COMPLETION CONFIRMATION NETPDTC (CODE N331)
6490 SAUFLEY FIELD ROAD
After successfully completing this course, you PENSACOLA FL 32559-5000
will receive a letter of completion.
NAVAL RESERVE RETIREMENT CREDIT
ERRATA
If you are a member of the Naval Reserve, you
Errata are used to correct minor errors or delete will receive retirement points if you are
obsolete information in a course. Errata may authorized to receive them under current
also be used to provide instructions to the directives governing retirement of Naval
student. If a course has an errata, it will be Reserve personnel. For Naval Reserve
included as the first page(s) after the front cover. retirement, this course is evaluated at 11 points.
Errata for all courses can be accessed and (Refer to Administrative Procedures for Naval
viewed/downloaded at: Reservists on Inactive Duty, BUPERSINST
1001.39, for more information about retirement
https://www.advancement.cnet.navy.mil points.)

STUDENT FEEDBACK QUESTIONS COURSE OBJECTIVES

We value your suggestions, questions, and In completing this nonresident training course,
criticisms on our courses. If you would like to you will demonstrate a knowledge of the subject
communicate with us regarding this course, we matter by correctly answering questions on the
encourage you, if possible, to use e-mail. If you following: U.S. naval tradition; leadership and
write or fax, please use a copy of the Student administrative responsibilities; programs and
Comment form that follows this page. policies; professional responsibilities; military
requirements; safety and survival; and damage
control.

vi
Student Comments
Course Title: Military Requirements for Petty Officer First Class

NAVEDTRA: 14145 Date:

We need some information about you:

Rate/Rank and Name: SSN: Command/Unit

Street Address: City: State/FPO: Zip

Your comments, suggestions, etc.:

Privacy Act Statement: Under authority of Title 5, USC 301, information regarding your military status is
requested in processing your comments and in preparing a reply. This information will not be divulged without
written authorization to anyone other than those within DOD for official use in determining performance.

NETPDTC 1550/41 (Rev 4-00)

vii
CHAPTER 1

US. NAVAL TRADITION

LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Learning objectives are stated at the beginning of each chapter. These


learning objectives serve as a preview of the information you should learn in
the chapter. By successfully completing the nonresident training course
(NRTC), you indicate you have met the objectives and have learned the
information. The learning objectives for chapter 1 are listed below.

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. Describe the striking forces of the U.S. Navy. 4. Identify the applications of the U.S. Navy
weapons systems.
2. Describe the TRIAD of the strategic nuclear
forces. 5. Describe the types of readiness training and
inspections conducted to maintain the U.S.
3. Identify the U.S. Navys geographic areas of Navys condition of readiness.
concern.

U.S. Navy sea power.

INTRODUCTION TO SEA POWER for this purpose despite any threat created by
rivals or competitors.
A nation can only measure the strength of its The elements of sea power enable a sea
sea power by its ability to use the sea to further its dependent nation to project and maintain its
national objectives. It must be able to use the sea political, economic, and military strengths

1-1
seaward and beyond. Some of these elements are presence; however, their ability to come and go
ships, aircraft, weapons, and trained personnel. at will is a strong symbolic reminder of their
Equally important are the shore establishment, presence. Since World War II, the U.S. Navy has
well-situated bases, commercial shipping, and been instrumental in handling international
international alignments. The following elements incidents that require the use of military force.
determine a nations capacity to exercise sea
power:
The character and number of its NAVAL MARITIME STRATEGY
population

The character of its government The United States seeks to deter war; but when
any country starts hostilities or conflict, the
The soundness of its economy United States defends itself and its allies.
National military strategy rests on three
Its industrial efficiency basic pillars: DETERRENCE, FORWARD
DEFENSE, and ALLIANCE SOLIDARITY.
The development of its internal When deterrence fails to prevent an enemys
communications attack, the United States responds in one of four
forms. It (1) meets force with force at the point
The quality and number of its harbors of attack, (2) increases the intensity of the conflict,
The extent of its coastline; and the location
(3) alters the geographic width of the conflict, or
(4) controls the duration of fighting.
of its homeland, bases, and overseas
Maritime superiority enables us to deny the
territories with respect to sea communica-
enemy any advantage through expansion. It also
tions
allows us to take the conflict to an area where the
The ability to project sea power could be in enemy does not want to fight. The flexibility of
jeopardy, and eventually lost, if any of these sea power permits us to outflank a foe, causing
elements are weak or lacking. an enemy to spread its forces around its perimeter.
This tactic requires the enemy to commit a great
number of personnel and materials to defend its
THE NAVYS ROLE IN THE otherwise secure flank. The enemy must defend
NATIONAL SECURITY POLICY itself against our submarines, surface ships,
aircraft, missiles, mines, and amphibious and
The United States national security policy special forces. With secure sea-lanes the Navy has
strives to preserve our freedom with our the ability to outlast any aggressor.
institutions and values intact. We are a global Any major conflict involves our allies, and we
power with global interests and obligations. The recognize the importance of their contributions.
Navy must be prepared to act at any time to The Navy structures its forces, to the extent
ensure national security while limiting crises, possible, to take advantage of the role allied naval
controlling escalation, or stopping a conflict. We forces play. Allied capabilities in mine warfare,
must be able to deal with a wide range of threats air defense, submarine operations, and maritime
to our freedom. patrol are important elements in maintaining
If the United States is to continue to exist as maritime superiority.
we know it today, it must have a policy that Maritime superiority for the United States is
recognizes its worldwide commitments. Naval a necessity. The Navy must be able in time of
forces underline Americas commitments and emergency to venture into harms way. It must
interests everyday by their presence near friendly, be able to control air, surface, and subsurface
neutral, and hostile shores. This presence asserts areas to assure access to all the oceans of the
and reinforces principles of international law and world. The Navy must ensure that access and meet
freedom of the seas on a continuing basis. its operational requirements despite the
Naval forces can be sent to crisis areas at low requirement for a smaller Navy. To do this, it
cost by comparison with other military forces. maintains the combat readiness of its ships with
Naval forces require no access or overflight rights the most modern technology and with the
and can stay on station indefinitely. Naval forces recruitment of dedicated and well-trained
leave behind no physical reminders of their personnel.

1-2
STRATEGIC NUCLEAR which are deployed in Minuteman silos. SACs
DETERRENCE manned bombers are the most flexible element of
the TRIAD. SAC can use bombers as a manned
Today, the United States deterrent to the penetration, as a cruise missile launch platform,
Soviet Unions threatening array of nuclear capa- or in support of conventional operations. It can use
bilities is a TRIAD of strategic nuclear forces. B-52 G/H and B-1B bombers to penetrate defenses.
These forces consist of BALLISTIC MISSILES,
INTERCONTINENTAL BALLISTIC MISSILES U.S. NAVY ROLE
(ICBMs) and LONG-RANGE BOMBERS.
The unique qualities of each leg of the TRIAD Deterrence of war has been the sole mission
combined provide a level of flexibility that cannot and basic reason for the existence of the fleet
be attained by each alone. The TRIAD enhances ballistic missile submarine since its inception in
our employment options and complicates enemy 1960. The submarine program is the Navys
defensive and offensive planning. It serves as a highest priority program. As an essential
hedge against possible violations of arms control cornerstone of the national security policy, this
limitations and reduces the impact of new program functions as a survivable and dependable
technological advances. The U.S. Air Force, with leg of the strategic deterrent TRIAD. The
its long-range bombers and ICBMs, and the U.S. submarine leg of TRIAD consists of older fleet
Navy, with its sea-launched ballistic missiles, ballistic missile submarines (nuclear propulsion)
provide part of the TRIAD. (SSBNs) armed with Poseidon C-3 or Trident C-4
missiles and new Trident submarines carrying
U.S. AIR FORCE ROLE Trident C-4 missiles. Remaining at sea about 55
percent of the time, these submarines have their
Our land-based intercontinental ballistic missiles targeted at sites in the Soviet Union and
missiles are unsurpassed in readiness and Eastern Europe. Tridents carry 24 submarine-
immediate reaction capability. They can be launched ballistic missiles (SLBMs) compared
launched quickly, and their capability to survive is with 16 in earlier submarines. The United States
very high. The Strategic Air Commands (SAC) now has 20 Trident submarines scheduled for
intercontinental ballistic missile force consists of construction.
Minuteman missiles and Peacekeeper ICBMs,

The carrier task group, and essential element of power projection.


1-3
The chance of a strategic nuclear attack on the is a vital commercial choke point. Whether it is
United States is low. The results of such an attack open or closed, it affects the destiny of nations.
would be catastrophic. The TRIAD has been The Mediterranean also has a side doorthe
developed and maintained to deter nuclear attack. Bosporus and Dardanellesthrough which Soviet
Similarly, the Soviet Union has developed and is ships enter. The Arab-Israeli wars in June 1967
maintaining powerful strategic forces of its own. and November 1973 produced a marked increase
Our objective is to obtain the following conditions in the size of the Soviet Mediterranean force.
of essential equivalence: From a previous high of 23 ships, Soviet naval
strength rose from 35 to 40 vessels. This period
1. Prevent Soviet strategic nuclear forces from was the first time in recent years the Soviets had
becoming effective instruments of political so deliberately used their fleet to support their
leverage or coercion. foreign policy. Since the war in the Middle East,
2. Maintain nuclear stability. a stepped-up program of Mediterranean port visits
3. Offset advantages in force characteristics by Soviet ships seems clearly aimed at increasing
possessed by the Soviets by U.S. Soviet influence in that area. The level of Soviet
advantages in other characteristics. naval activity provides additional reasons for the
4. Ensure U.S. strategic forces are not, nor continued presence of a strong Sixth Fleet. The
are they perceived to be, inferior in Sixth Fleet is built around two attack carriers and
performance to those of the Soviet Union. an amphibious striking force with an embarked
Marine Corps battalion landing team. Since the
The credibility of our TRIAD as perceived by Soviet Union maintains a submarine force in the
potential opponents and allies is very important. Mediterranean, the United States has increased
If they perceive that our TRIAD does not exist the frequency of deployment of its antisubmarine
or is weak, regardless of the facts, it will no longer groups to the Mediterranean from the Atlantic.
serve to deter an attack. Across the world from the Mediterranean, the
This condition of essential equivalence should Commander in Chief, Pacific Fleet (CINCPAC-
produce a mutual deterrence that is so stable it FLT), commands the Third and Seventh Fleets.
will not be upset in a crisis. The United States The Third Fleet, operating off the west coast of
seeks to maintain this stability through a the United States, trains the personnel and shakes
combination of specific, equitable, and verifiable down the ships that rotate to the Seventh Fleet.
arms control agreements. The Seventh Fleet operates in the western Pacific
and Indian Ocean regions.
In recent years Soviet naval forces in the
GEOGRAPHICAL AREAS OF Pacific have grown in size and capability. With
CONCERN IN U.S. FLEET the fall of South Vietnam, the Soviets established
ORGANIZATION a large naval base at Cam Ranh Bay. This base
provides them with the capability to react rapidly
Four American fleets (Second, Third, Sixth, to world events in the western Pacific.
and Seventh) stand worldwide watch. Each serves
the Navy's basic mission of protecting national
security. The Second Fleet, commanded by
Commander in Chief, Atlantic Fleet (CINC- STRIKING FORCES OF THE U.S.
LANTFLT), operates from the worlds largest NAVY
naval base at Norfolk, Virginia. It patrols the
western Atlantic across some of the worlds most A strike is an attack intended to inflict damage
important trade routes. Ships and personnel of to, seize, or destroy an objective. A striking force
the Second Fleet rotate with those of the Sixth is a force composed of appropriate units necessary
Fleet. The Commander in Chief, U.S. Naval to conduct strike, attack, or assault operations.
Forces Europe (CINCUSNAVEUR), commands The mobility and versatile power of naval
the Sixth Fleet, which moves in the nearly striking forces make them ideal instruments for
landlocked Mediterranean Sea. We could describe enforcing national military policy. In peacetime,
the Sixth Fleet as keeper of the doors. unsettled world conditions require the Navys
The Mediterranean has been an influential readiness to instantly apply force. The existence
factor in world affairs since the dawn of history. of a naval striking force may serve as a stabilizing
Gibraltar, the front door of the Mediterranean, influence to inhibit the outbreak of hostilities.

1-4
Our conflict with Iraq is an example of how The United States frequently deploys naval
hostilities sometimes occur in spite of attempts to forces to areas near hostile bases and operating
settle international disputes by other means. As areas far from continental U.S. bases. These
shown by this conflict, our carrier striking force deployments place demanding requirements upon
takes prompt and decisive action to meet national the capabilities of U.S. naval forces. These forces
objectives. must be able to counter air, surface, and
Mobility is one of the striking forces greater submarine threats simultaneously when the
assets. It increases the prospect for surprise enemy selects more than one method of attack.
attacks from any point bordering enemy land The aircraft carrier serves as the key member
areas surrounded by navigable waters. Striking of a powerful and mobile naval task force. It uses
forces provide a wide range of weapons systems for antisubmarine aircraft, attack and fighter aircraft,
close or long-range distances. Task forces and surface and subsurface escorts. These air,
organized primarily for striking force operations surface, and subsurface escorts provide the
are carrier, surface, and submarine strike forces. greatest naval power that can be assembled to
These forces operate independently or together as counter all types of threats at sea.
needed. The carrier battle group has the mobility to
operate where it can be most effective against any
AIRCRAFT CARRIER BATTLE forces threatening the United States free use of
GROUP the seas. It also has the sensors and weapons
needed to defeat these threats. The carrier is a
The aircraft carrier battle group (fig. 1-1) is a completely outfitted and equipped mobile air
vital part of the Navys overall ability to counter operating base for projecting power ashore. This
aggression successfully and to protect vital sea- function requires close air support and
lanes. Geographically, economically, politically, interdiction aircraft. (Interdiction is an attack on
and culturally, the United States is overseas supply lines. It is an attempt to destroy railroads,
oriented. bridges, electric power plants, and so forth, to
Because the United States is essentially an cripple the support of enemy front lines with
island nation, it must have the ability to influence minimum effort.) These aircraft are able to defeat
international affairs favorably. During conflict, all modern aircraft; penetrate missile-defended
the United States must be able to engage and targets; and conduct precision day, night, and all-
defeat any enemy far from American shores. At weather bombing. They perform the demanding
the same time, it must protect the vital lines of tasks of reconnaissance and surveillance.
communications. The United States must maintain a convincing
peacetime presence in trouble spots of the world

Figure 1-1.USS America carrier task group.

1-5
to prevent conflicts that are adverse to U.S. primary mission of the submarines is to seek and
interests. The carrier battle group can quickly destroy enemy submarines. The advent of the
respond to crises in areas where U.S. interests nuclear-powered ballistic missile submarine added
require a military presence. The carrier can an entirely new missionthe delivery of ballistic
remain offshore to show Americas interest in missile attacks against assigned shore targets.
affairs ashore. The carrier battle group and its In 1955 the Chief of Naval Operations ordered
associated naval units have the means to respond the development of a weapons system capable of
to almost any event. launching a missile from a submerged submarine.
Aircraft carrier battle groups contribute The system was to be able to hit any point on the
directly to the United States capability to counter earths surface with a nuclear warheada
a major Warsaw Pact attack against the North complex engineering feat never achieved in
Atlantic Treaty Organization (NATO). These history. The system was envisioned to have three
mobile forces help keep major sea-lanes open basic componentsmissiles, a launching platform,
against potential threats. Together with other and a navigation system that would continuously
services, they provide major offensive initiatives show the ships position under all conditions.
should a NATO/Warsaw pact war or lesser conflict The United States launched its first fleet
occur. Carrier-based tactical aircraft can wage ballistic missile (FBM) submarine, George
concentrated tactical air power in remote areas of Washington, SSBN-598, in June 1959. It contained
the world where the United States does not have 16 launching tubes equipped with Polaris A-1,
land bases. 1200-nautical-mile-range missiles. The submarine
conducted its first successful test on 20 July 1960
SUBMARINE FORCES off Cape Canaveral. In November 1960, the FBM
system became operational when George
Historically, the mission of a submarine has Washington deployed on its first 60-day patrol.
been to seek and destroy both combatant and Since then, several versions have been developed,
noncombatant enemy surface ships. Now the including the Poseidon and the Trident.

Trident I C4 FBM.

1-6
The latest version, and by far the deadliest and Figure 1-2 shows the Trident submarine, USS
most versatile, is the Trident C-4 undersea Ohio, SSBN 726. Trident submarines are
nuclear weapons system. Its longer-range missiles, replacing the aging fleet ballistic missile
larger submarines, and complete U.S. home submarines built during a short period in the
ports, have increased combat readiness and cut 1960s. They will replace Poseidon submarines by
the operating costs of the FBM force. Trident is the late 1990s.
the name of the entire weapons system, including In 1980 the Navy began development of a new
submarines, missiles, and base. The Trident submarine-launched ballistic missile, the Trident
missile can reach enemy targets from both the II (D-5), with improved accuracy, extended range,
Atlantic and Pacific Oceans, thus making and greater payload. Eventually all Trident
expensive overseas ports unnecessary for Trident submarines will be configured to carry Trident II
submarines. In addition, the Trident I missile has missiles.
been adapted for use with our present Poseidon
submarines. This has increased the missile range SURFACE ACTION GROUP (SAG)
to 4,000 nautical miles. All Trident submarines
have exceeded their performance design specifica- Task force or group commanders include in
tions in speed and quietness and have successfully their operation orders provision for SURFACE
launched Trident (C-4) test missiles. Both the ACTION GROUPS (SAGS), which can be detached
Poseidon and Trident missiles have a multiple to perform certain missions. They prepare a battle
warhead capability. plan for these forces to follow

Figure 1-2.USS Ohio (SSBN-726).

1-7
during surface action. However, they normally Amphibious assaults must be conducted in the
use such forces only as one element in a face of certain additional and special difficulties.
coordinated strike by both air and surface units. Natural forces, such as unfavorable weather, seas,
Commanders detach surface action groups in and surf, represent hazards not normally
special situations; for example, to destroy isolated encountered in land warfare. Ships encounter
or crippled enemy surface units, to conduct shore many logistics problems. They must load
bombardment, or for surface reconnaissance thousands of troops and large quantities of
missions. Normally, though, aircraft are the material so that they can be unloaded in the
principal agents for tactical reconnaissance. Air proper sequence. They then must move these
action usually takes place before a surface troops and materials to the objective area and land
engagement or occurs during the engagement. An them on open beaches or landing zones, which
air strike before a surface engagement may may be under enemy fire. All such problems
surprise the enemy forces to such an extent that require special attention to detailed planning.
the surface action becomes a pursuit of dis- The closest cooperation and most detailed
organized enemy forces. It may also slow enemy coordination among all forces taking part in an
forces so that the task force or battle group can amphibious operation are essential to success. The
engage enemy forces with surface-to-surface fire forces must be trained together. Each force must
or missiles outside the enemy surface missile have a clear understanding of its mutual obliga-
envelope. Task force or group commanders may tions, special capabilities, and problems.
also use aircraft for spotting gunfire and ship- Amphibious striking forces normally include
launched missiles. Figure 1-3 shows a surface Navy and Marine Corps forces but may include
action group. personnel from every service of the armed forces.
These forces are integrated into a task
AMPHIBIOUS FORCES
organization to form a single cohesive amphibious
Amphibious operations conducted to establish striking force capable of executing its mission with
a landing force on a hostile shore achieves several utmost efficiency. The keynote of successful
purposes. First, they allow our forces to pursue amphibious operations is the complete coordina-
further combat operations. Second, they allow tion and unity of effort among all the participating
our forces to obtain a site for an advanced naval elements of land, sea, and air forces. This
or air base. And third, they deny the use of an coordination and unity achieved successes in the
area or facilities to the enemy. conduct of amphibious operations during World
AMPHIBIOUS WARFARE has special signi- War II, the Korean conflict, and the Vietnam
ficance for every person in the Navy. It integrates conflict. These successes are direct results of the
nearly all types of ships, aircraft, weapons, and close relationships developed among our armed
landing forces in a concerted military effort forces.
against a hostile shore. The ability to conduct
amphibious operations effectively is a measure of
a nations competence in applying the elements NAVAL WARFARE
of sea power and air power in a coordinated
effort. A nations competence in applying sea NAVAL WARFARE is a conflict in which at
power and air power in a coordinated effort serves least one of the opponents is operating from the
as a measure of its ability to conduct effective sea with surface ships, submarines, or sea-based
amphibious operations. aircraft. Naval warfare involves three major areas:
The usefulness of the amphibious operation SURFACE, SUBSURFACE, and AIR. Each of
stems from the mobility and flexibility of its these areas has its own operating characteristics,
forces; that is, the ability to concentrate balanced and each has its own particular strengths and
forces and to strike with great strength at selected limitations.
points in the hostile defense system. An The art of naval warfare entails a nations use
amphibious operation uses the element of surprise of surface, submarine, and air forces in a manner
and capitalizes upon enemy weaknesses. The mere that exploits the strengths and minimizes the
threat imposed by the existence of powerful weaknesses of each. This objective has led to
amphibious forces may convince the enemy to surface, submarine, and air forces operating
spread out concentrated forces. This may result together in mutual support. Their common
in expensive and wasteful efforts by the enemy objective is to gain advantages over the enemy by
in defending the countrys coastline. working together to improve offensive capabilities

1-9
USS Oliver Hazard Perry (FFG-7).

USS Texas (CGN-39).

1-10
and decrease the weaknesses of each naval The SUPPORTING WARFARE TASKS are
component. Each U.S. naval force has the full as follows:
capacity in all three warfare areas to carry out the
task of meeting a multidimensional threat similar SPECIAL WARFARE. Special warfare
to that of U.S. naval forces. U.S. naval forces involves naval operations generally accepted as
also carry out fundamental tasks and supporting being nonconventional in nature and, in many
tasks. cases, conducted with secrecy. Special warfare,
The FUNDAMENTAL WARFARE TASKS which often accomplishes basic warfare tasks,
are as follows: includes special mobile operations, unconven-
tional warfare, coastal reconnaissance, and certain
ANTIAIR WARFARE (AAW). AAW is technical intelligence operations.
the destruction of enemy aircraft and airborne
weapons, whether launched from air, surface, OCEAN SURVEILLANCE. Ocean
subsurface, or land. AAW consists of all the surveillance is the observation of ocean areas to
measures used in achieving air superiority. detect, locate, and classify selected air, surface,
and subsurface targets. It also involves providing
the information to users in a timely manner. A
ANTISUBMARINE WARFARE (ASW). target may be hostile, neutral, or friendly. Ocean
ASW is the destruction or neutralization of enemy surveillance provides a current operational setting
submarines. The aim of ASW is to prevent the by which Navy commanders can decide whether
effective use of submarines by the enemy. to deploy forces.

ANTISURFACE SHIP WARFARE INTELLIGENCE. Intelligence is the


(ASUW). ASUW is the destruction or assessment and management of information
neutralization of enemy surface combatants and obtained via surveillance, reconnaissance, and
merchant ships. The aim of ASUW is to prevent other means. Intelligence forces use this
the effective use of surface warships and cargo- information to produce timely warnings and to
carrying vessels by the enemy. indicate the location, identification, intentions,
technical capabilities, and tactics of potential
STRIKE WARFARE. Strike warfare is the enemies. Current and complete intelligence,
correctly interpreted, permits military decisions
use of conventional or nuclear weapons in the
destruction or neutralization of enemy targets to be based on accurate knowledge of the enemys
ashore. It includes, but is not limited to, attacks forces and capabilities.
on an enemys strategic nuclear forces and
building yards. It also includes attacks on THE NAVY COMMAND AND
operating bases from which an enemy can conduct CONTROL SYSTEMS (NCCS). NCCS provides
air, surface, or subsurface operations against U.S. the means to exercise the authority and direction
or allied forces. of naval forces in the accomplishment of their
mission. The NCCS coordinates its operations
with the national command, control, and
AMPHIBIOUS WARFARE. Amphibious communications system. NCCS is under the
warfare consists of attacks launched from the sea direction of the national command authority (the
by naval forces and by landing forces embarked President, the Secretary of Defense, and the Joint
in ships or craft. The purpose of these attacks is Chiefs of Staff). These systems ensure the
to allow forces to land on an enemy shore. coordination of all warfare efforts. The Army,
Amphibious warfare includes fire support of Air Force, and naval forces of the United States
troops in contact with enemy forces using close and those of our allies could not fulfill their
air support or shore bombardment. missions without effective and well-organized
command, control, and communications systems.
MINE WARFARE. Mine warfare is the
use of mines and mine countermeasures to control ELECTRONIC WARFARE. Electronic
sea or harbor areas. It involves laying minefield warfare involves electronic support for all warfare
and countering enemy mine warfare through tasks. Electronic warfare ensures the effective use
the destruction or neutralization of enemy mine- of the electromagnetic spectrum by friendly forces
field. while determining, reducing, or preventing its use

1-11
by an enemy. It also assists in the detection and away. The attacks can be coordinated so that
targeting of hostile forces while making detection several missiles arrive almost simultaneously, and
and targeting of friendly forces more difficult for some of the missiles have a nuclear capability.
the enemy. A survivable Navy in the modern world must
have the latest surveillance techniques,
LOGISTICS. Logistics is the resupply of information processing capabilities, and platforms
combat consumables to combatant forces during that can effectively deliver weapons wherever
operations. It may often be a major factor in needed.
determining the success or failure of an operation.
A principal aim of naval logistics is to make the AEGIS
operating forces as independent as possible of
overseas bases. Sealift provides most supplies The shipboard integrated AAW combat weapons
needed to support U.S. naval forces and other U.S. system (Aegis) is the most capable surface-
combatant and allied forces. The U.S. maritime launched missile system the Navy has ever put to
mobility forces consist primarily of ships of the sea. The system was designed as a total weapons
Military Sealift Command, various ships held in system with capabilities that range from detection
reserve, and the U.S. merchant marine. to destruction of enemy targets. The system can
perform search, track, and missile-guidance
U.S. NAVY WEAPONS AND functions simultaneously with a track capacity of
SYSTEMS over 100 targets. It can defeat an extremely wide
range of targets. It can defeat very high- to very
Since the Civil War, when armored, steam- low-altitude antiship cruise missiles and manned
propelled warships first were combat-tested, the aircraft, flying at both supersonic and subsonic
U.S. Navy has used the latest technology in all speeds. Aegis is reliable even in the most severe of
naval warfare applications. environmental conditions, both natural and man-
For more than 40 years, the U.S. Navy has made. Aegis can operate simultaneously in all
developed systems and tactics to protect itself from modes of warfare: antiair, antisubmarine, and
air attacks. Since the end of World War II, several antisurface. The system can also perform force
generations of antiship missiles have emerged as coordination.
an air threat to the fleet. These antiship missiles The surface Navys Aegis provides area defense
can be launched from under the sea, from the for the battle group. It also provides a clear air
surface of the sea, and from aircraft above the sea. picture for more effective deployment of F-14
Many can be launched several hundred miles Tomcat and F/A-18 Hornet aircraft. It

F-14 Tomcat.

1-12
F/A-18A Hornet.

enables fighter aircraft to concentrate more on the edge for the present. It also promises to give
outer air battle while Aegis cruisers and the fleet an extremely capable AAW system
destroyers concentrate on the battle group area through-out the turn of the century. This will
defense. The highly accurate Aegis weapons be done through planned upgrades to the
system reduces the use of other valuable assets. As standard missiles, the introduction of vertical
long as our blue-water Navy must steam into launchers, and evolutionary improvements to
harms way in carrying out assigned missions, it Aegis itself.
will require a formidable antiair warfare Aegis is installed on all Ticonderoga-class
capability. Aegis has given AAW forces a decided cruisers (fig. 1-4). A system compatible with

Figure 1-4.USS Ticonderoga (CC-47).

1-13
destroyers will be installed on new Arleigh Burke- FFG-, DDG-, CG-, and CGN-class ships equipped
class destroyers (fig. 1-5). with Aegis and a Tartar combat system. Standard-
2MR incorporates midcourse guidance, which
SURFACE-LAUNCHED MISSILES allows programming of the missile for radar
search only. The missile is redirected in midflight
The mission of surface-launched missiles, and then again during the terminal homing phase.
shown in figures 1-6 and 1-7, is to engage and SM-2 MR is installed on the DDG- and CGN-type
intercept aircraft, antiship missiles, and surface ships and on Aegis CG-class ships.
ships. Standard-1 (SM-1) and Standard-2 (SM-2), Standard-1 (RIM-67) is an extended-range
medium-range (MR), and extended-range (ER) (ER), surface-launched missile employing passive/
missiles have a cylindrical airframe. The airframe semiactive homing or midcourse command
tapers into a radome, four fixed dorsal fins, and guidance. It is propelled by a detachable rocket
four independently movable steering control booster and an integral sustainer rocket motor.
surfaces. SM-1 ER is installed on CGN-, CG-, and DDG-37-
Standard-1 (RIM-66) is a medium-range (MR), class ships equipped with Terrier combat systems.
surface-launched missile employing passive or Standard-2 ER incorporates the same midcourse
semiactive homing. It is propelled by an integral guidance as the MR version.
dual-thrust rocket motor, SM-1 MR is installed on

Figure 1-5.USS Arleigh A. Burke (DDG-51).

1-14
Figure 1-6.Rim-66 standard surface-to-air missiles.

Figure 1-7.Rim-67A extended-range standard missile.

1-15
HARPOON ANTISHIP CRUISE capsule then floats to the surface, where booster
MISSILE ignition occurs and the missile boosts from the
capsule. Following a surface or an air launch, the
Figure 1-8 shows the HARPOON ANTISHIP Harpoon flies a programmed, low-trajectory path
CRUISE MISSILE, a medium-range, rocket- to the target. An onboard computer provides
boosted, turbo-sustained cruise missile. It can be inflight attitude reference and midcourse
launched from surface ships, submarines, or guidance. Target location is provided by a self-
aircraft (without the booster). It is effective contained active radar seeker. Terminal guidance
against hostile surface targets such as combatants uses the radar seeker, or passive homing, in an
and surfaced submarines. electronic countermeasure (ECM) environment. A
500-pound high-explosive (HE) warhead with a
The Harpoon missile uses a solid-propellant to contact fuse accomplishes target destruction.
launch it from a variety of surface ship launcher
configurations including Tartar rails, PHALANX CLOSE-IN WEAPONS
antisubmarine rocket (ASROC) cells, or deck- SYSTEM
mounted canisters. When launched from
submerged submarines, a sealed capsule protects Figure 1-9 shows the PHALANX CLOSE-IN
the Harpoon missile in the torpedo tube. The WEAPONS SYSTEM. The Phalanx is the Navys

Figure 1-8.RGM-84A Harpoon antiship missile.

1-16
first all-weather, automatic-controlled gun system locate the threat target and the projectiles of the
designed to provide defense against close-in, sea- Phalanx. It then automatically corrects the aim of
skimming cruise missiles that penetrate outer the gun toward the target. The gun fires 20-mm,
defense systems. The main technical achievement high-density penetrating projectiles at 3,000
of Phalanx is its closed-loop radar spotting and rounds per minute. The self-contained system can
tracking ability. With closed-loop spotting, the be readily installed on any ship, from patrol boat
fire-control guidance system can simultaneously to aircraft carrier.

Figure 1-9.Phalanx.

1-17
PHOENIX AIR-TO-AIR MISSILE homing torpedo. It is designed to combat fast,
deep-diving nuclear submarines and high-
The PHOENIX AIR-TO-AIR MISSILE, shown performance surface ships. The Mk-48 can operate
in figure 1-10, was introduced into the fleet with without wire command guidance and can use
the F-14 aircraft in 1974. The missile, along with active or passive homing or both. When launched,
the weapons control system of the F-14, can it executes target search, acquisition, and attack
destroy hostile air targets with conventional procedures. If the Mk-48 misses the target, it will
warheads in all weather. The system can execute multiple reattacks. The Mk-48 is carried
simultaneously track 24 hostile air targets and by all U.S. submarines, including strategic missile
launch six missiles against six different targets. submarines that use it as a self-defense weapon.
The missile has great range and intercept
capability against high-speed, high- and low- The Mk-46 torpedo is designed for launching
altitude maneuvering targets. from surface combatants and fixed- and rotary-
wing aircraft. It is a primary antisubmarine
TORPEDOES weapon used by Navy surface ships. The Mk-46 is
an acoustic homing torpedo operating in either an
The Mk-48 torpedo, shown in figure 1-11, is a active or a passive mode. If a target is not
long-range, deep-depth, wire-guided, acoustic

Figure 1-10.AIM-54A Phoenix

Figure 1-11.Mk-48 torpedo.

1-18
acquired in the passive mode, the torpedo converts propellant rocket booster propels the missile until
to the active mode. a small turbofan engine takes over for the cruise
portion of the flight. The land-attack version of
TOMAHAWK CRUISE MISSILE Tomahawk has an inertial and terrain-matching
guidance system.
The Tomahawk, shown in figure 1-12, is a long-
range, subsonic cruise missile. The Tomahawk can The antiship version has a modified Harpoon
be a conventionally armed antiship version for cruise missile guidance system. This system
antisurface warfare, a conventionally armed land- permits Tomahawk to be fired and to fly at low
attack version, and a nuclear armed land-attack altitude in the general direction of an enemy
version. warship to avoid radar detection. At a
The Tomahawk is an all-weather submarine- programmed distance, the missile begins an active
launched or surface combatant-launched antiship radar search to seek, acquire, and hit the target
or land-attack cruise missile. After launch, a solid- ship.

Figure 1-12.BGM-109 Tomahawk.

1-19
Tomahawk is a highly survivable weapon on hand and in working condition. Drills may
against predicted hostile defense systems. Radar seem repetitive, but this repetitiveness produces
detection is difficult because the missile has a very a set of automatic responses by crew members that
small cross section and flies at low altitude. prepares them for any event. General quarters is
Similarly, infrared detection is difficult because the most important drill held. A general quarters
the turbofan engine emits a low level of heat. The drill covers various bills that provide for exercise
antiship variant of Tomahawk uses a combined of the entire crew. It allows for damage-control,
search radar and passive detection of enemy gun-crew, missile-firing, and medical-team drills
electronic radiation to detect a hostile ship at great all at once. Other frequently held drills are
range. collision, man overboard, abandon ship, and
rescue and assistance. Through routine drills each
person in the crew will be able to perform under
READINESS TRAINING IN THE the most stressful conditions.
U.S. NAVY
INSPECTIONS
Readiness is defined as the ability of a force,
a unit, a weapons system, or an equipment to To ensure ships and crews are prepared to
deliver the output for which it was designed. meet operational commitments, higher authority
Readiness includes the ability to deploy and holds several formal inspections. These
employ without unacceptable delays. inspections ensure the ship is safe to operate and
To meet the sea power challenge, the U.S. administrative procedures are correct. They also
Navy continually conducts readiness training. This ensure the ship is prepared to operate in wartime
readiness training includes refresher training, conditions and in battle. We will briefly cover four
routine drills, exercises, and inspections. of the most important inspections conducted.
REFRESHER TRAINING
Operational Readiness
REFRESHER TRAINING is designed to turn Inspection (ORI)
a materially ready and manned ship into a ship
that is fully capable of performing its assigned One of the most important inspections ships
mission. The Navy operates two refresher training receive is the OPERATIONAL READINESS IN-
groups, one on each coast of the United States. SPECTION (ORI). Unit commanders normally
The Atlantic group is located at Guantanamo Bay, perform these inspections while the ship is
Cuba; the Pacific group is located at San Diego, underway with the crew at battle stations or with
California. Refresher training consists of condition watches set. Type commanders place
inspections, exercises, drills, and battle problems. heavy emphasis on the ORI. This inspection tests
These are designed to test every capability of the the ability of the crew and ship to operate in battle
ship. Refresher training normally takes about 5 under wartime conditions. The most important
weeks to complete under the watchful eye of a exercise is a lengthy and realistic battle problem
refresher training group. A ship must repeat all with the crew at general quarters. Normally the
exercises failed during this period until it receives ship will fire actual weapons during the exercise.
a passing grade. Upon completion of refresher Defense against all forms of attack will be tested
training, the ship is ready for deployment. along with damage-control, collision, and
abandon-ship drills.
ROUTINE DRILLS
Propulsion Examination Board
After refresher training the ship must hold (PEB) Inspection
frequent drills to keep the crew in top shape.
These may be of the operational, emergency, The PROPULSION EXAMINATION BOARD
administrative, or special type. Ships base all drills (PEB) INSPECTION is conducted to ensure the
on the ships bills and the basic bills outlined in propulsion system is safe to operate. It also
Standard Organization and Regulations of the determines the adequacy of the administrative and
U.S. Navy, OPNAVINST 3120.32B. Ships hold operating procedures directly related to the
routine drills to ensure qualified personnel are propulsion plant and the capability of assigned
assigned, bills are correct, and all equipment is personnel to maintain equipment and systems.

1-20
Administrative Inspection we cannot keep our commitment to these treaties.
Conducting military exercises with our allies sends
Type commanders normally perform annual a signal to our adversaries that we can keep these
ADMINISTRATIVE INSPECTIONS. They hold commitments.
these inspections to ensure ships follow correct
record setup and administrative procedures. These
inspections give the greatest attention to the ships SUMMARY
planned maintenance system (PMS).
The mission of our Navy is to be prepared to
Board of Inspection and conduct prompt, sustained combat operations at
Survey (INSURV) sea in support of the national interests of the
United States. Todays Navy must meet any type
Based on Navy Regulations, the BOARD of aggression, from the most primitive to the most
OF INSPECTION AND SURVEY (INSURV) sophisticated.
examines each naval ship at least once every 3 Our basic national security objective is to
years, if practical. The inspection determines the preserve the United States as a free nation with
ships material condition; if found unfit for its basic institutions and values intact. This
continued service, the ship must report to higher objective depends upon our ability to deter
authority. Higher authority schedules these aggression, to prevent coercion, and to influence
inspections without the knowledge of the com- international affairs from a position of recognized
manding officer. However, the commanding strength and credibility. It also depends upon our
officer may request an INSURV through official ability to fight when necessary and to terminate
channels when needed. Other duties of the board conflict on terms compatible with U.S. national
of inspection and survey include the following: security interests.
Fleet ballistic missile submarines (nuclear
1. Conduct acceptance trials and inspections propulsion) must be capable of delivering ballistic
of all ships and service craft before their missile attacks against assigned targets. The SSBN
acceptance for naval service. force, as part of the TRIAD, is a strong deterrent
2. Conduct acceptance trials and inspections against nuclear attack because of its ability to
of one or more aircraft of each type or retaliate with highly capable missiles.
model before final acceptance for naval The ability of U.S. naval forces to survive and
service. accomplish their mission depends on their
3. Perform such other inspections and trials offensive powers. They must be able to destroy
of naval ships, service craft, and aircraft or neutralize hostile forces routinely present in the
as directed by the Chief of Naval Opera- theater of operations or which represent a threat
tions. within that theater. They must be able to project
power ashore by gunfire, missiles, carrier-based
aircraft, and amphibious landings. Our forces
EXERCISES must use each of these elements effectively to
achieve and maintain sea control and to support
Our naval forces conduct various exercises allied forces or U.S. land-based forces ashore.
with our allies throughout the year. These Naval warfare is a conflict in which at least
exercises reinforce and demonstrate the one of the opponents is operating from the sea
professionalism of the various navies to operate with surface ships, submarines, or sea-based
together in a sophisticated environment against aircraft. The objective of naval warfare is to
a three-dimensional threat. They may be large- exploit the strengths and minimize the weaknesses
or small-scale exercises. Some take as long as 2 of air, subsurface, and surface forces. By combin-
years to plan. One recent NATO exercise consisted ing all the elements of our naval forces, the Navy
of more than 160 ships, 250 aircraft, and is fully capable of meeting a multidimensional
approximately 7,000 ground force personnel from threat in all three warfare areas.
10 countries. Through the various treaties and Research, development, test, and evaluation
pacts the United States has entered into, we are programs allow the United States to field
committed to the defense of half the land areas affordable and reliable weapons systems to meet
of the world. Without sea power to keep the lines any threat facing the nation today. Without
of communications open and supply our allies, these programs and the technological superiority

1-21
resulting from them, military superiority would be In the British Navy of King George III and
unachievable. To be survivable, todays Navy must earlier, many sailors wives accompanied them on
have the latest and most modern platforms and long voyages. This practice caused a multitude of
systems available to deliver weapons wherever problems, but some ingenious bosun solved one
needed. problem that tended to make reveille a hazardous
To meet any challenge, the Navy is constantly event: that of distinguishing which bunks held
in a state of readiness training. Forces must males and which held females.
constantly be trained during peacetime so that
they will be prepared for war. Training is a major To avoid dragging the wrong mates out of
factor in the ability of a ship to carry out assigned the rack, the bosun asked all to show a leg, If the
operations. Personnel must be able to operate and leg shown was adorned with silk, the owner was
maintain equipment and function continuously as allowed to continue sleeping. If the leg was hairy
a team. The best weapons and systems are useless and tattooed, the owner was forced to turn-to.
without skilled hands and well-trained minds to
operate them. In todays Navy, showing a leg is a signal to
the reveille petty officer that you have heard the
REFERENCES call and are awake.

Basic Military Requirements, NAVEDTRA,


12043, Naval Education and Training
Program Management Support Activity,
Pensacola, Fla., 1992.

SHOW A LEG

Many of our Navys colorful expressions


originated as practical means of communicating
vital information. One such expression is show a
leg.
Show a leg.

1-22
CHAPTER 2

LEADERSHIP AND ADMINISTRATIVE


RESPONSIBILITIES
LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. Define leadership responsibilities. 6. Describe work center stability and requirements.


2. Describe the procedures to design a work 7. Explain how to write enlisted performance
center schedule. evaluations.
8. Explain the duties and responsibilities of the
3. Explain the responsibilities for completion of
leading petty officer (LPO).
tasks on a work center schedule.
9. Explain the responsibility of signature by
4. Describe various forms of work center tasks. authority.
5. Identify various forms of subordinate develop- 10. Describe the procedure of preparing routine
ment. naval correspondence and messages.

As a first class petty officer, you will use your work center efficiently, you also must have those
leadership skills in carrying out your administra- qualities. You must manage personnel, material, and
tive responsibilities. You will use your ability as a time properly to ensure your work center meets the
leader to motivate and counsel your personnel to deadlines set for the completion of tasks.
ensure they complete work center tasks. Your many
administrative tasks, such as planning, WORK CENTER PERSONNEL AND
managing, and evaluating, will also require your MATERIAL
leadership ability.
This chapter describes your leadership respon- You have many resources to help you accomplish
sibilities as they relate to your administrative tasks; the most important are the personnel and
responsibilities. It explains how to assign tasks, materials within your own division. To use personnel
manage personnel, and complete important docu- and materials to the greatest advantage, you must
ments, such as the enlisted evaluation report. In interact with your people and be familiar with your
addition, it explains the various types of naval material resources. Therefore, do not confine
correspondence you must prepare and the naval yourself to the office. Spend a little time in your
writing standards you should follow. The chapter office in the morning and afternoon to carry out
begins by discussing your work center your administrative duties, but spend the rest of your
responsibilities. time in the work area.

Assessment of Personnel and


MANAGING THE WORK CENTER Material Readiness
The work center that has a high degree of
morale, good maintenance of equipment, and You should assess your divisions personnel and
clean spaces has personnel with good leadership material readiness daily and in more detail
and management qualities. To manage your own weekly. These assessments help you to know your

2-1
personnel better. They also give you an up-to-date the nomenclature, stock number, and price of the
account of task progression, tool and equipment broken part. Also include a check-out and check-
conditions, and the amount of supplies used. in list of power tools in the log.
2. Maintain a daily hand tool log. List the
PERSONNEL. When you assess your name of the tool that is out of commission and
workers performance, you will look at three the nomenclature, stock number, and price of the
areas: broken part. Include a check-out and check-in list
of hand tools in the hand tool log.
1. Attitude 3. Ensure all hand and power tools are
2. Knowledge assigned serial numbers; enter serial numbers into
3. Work habits each log for easier tracking of tools.

When making your rounds in work spaces, Division Damage Control Space Inventory or
assess the knowledge of the personnel working in Inspection. Every division or work center should
each space. Observe the attitude and work habits already have a log on hand that describes
of your people, how they handle their equipment, deficiencies and missing equipment in each of
and the order in which they complete jobs. Ask your spaces. That log is called the equipment
subordinates questions about the job they are deficiency log (EDL). The EDL contains informa-
doing. Knowing your peoples experience in each tion such as (1) the space, (2) space location, (3)
area will allow you to make decisions more the problem or deficiency, (4) when it was
quickly to achieve task accomplishment in case discovered, and (5) action taken. For missing
of personnel setbacks. equipment the EDL will contain information on
To keep abreast of the knowledge and experi- (1) nomenclature of missing equipment, (2) stock
ence of your personnel, randomly review each number, (3) when it was placed on order, and (4)
members training records. Ensure records are all the form or forms used to order the missing
current and ensure each subordinate member is equipment.
afforded the proper path toward advancement.
Work Center Requirements and
MATERIAL. Make a daily inventory of Personnel Deficiencies
each work space to determine the amount of
materials being used so that you will know when For a work center to accomplish its goals and
to draw more supplies. Also make a weekly maintain an effective degree of operational
inventory so that you will know when to order readiness, it must maintain its most valuable
additional supplies for your division. resourceits personnel.
Just as you have a supply inventory for your
Division Supply Inventory. Each division or division, the command maintains an inventory of
department uses the operating target (OPTAR) people available. That inventory is called the
log to make a formal supply inventory. The enlisted distribution verification report (EDVR).
OPTAR log shows all supplies in your division. From this report a division can better enable itself
Log all division orders in your division or to fulfill any TAD requirements without an
department OPTAR log. Also log (1) when an adverse effect on its work force.
item was ordered, (2) its stock number, (3) the
cost, (4) and the OPTAR balance. At the end of MANNING REQUIREMENTS. The
each work week, or on whatever day you EDVR is a computer printout of the number of
designate, prepare an inventory sheet of all personnel in each rate aboard the command. The
materials and supplies in your division. This EDVR lists personnel by order of rank and the
inventory sheet will give you a running account amount of each rate allowable aboard the
of all supplies. command.

Division Tool Inventory. Maintain your tool TAD REQUIREMENTS. Commands have
inventory in much the same fashion as your supply a set amount of personnel it can provide for
inventory with the following exceptions: various TAD requirements and different schools.
The TAD requirements are usually divided
1. Maintain a daily power tool log. List the throughout the various departments based on the
name of the tool that is out of commission and ships overall manpower.

2-2
PAGES 2-8 THROUGH 2-27 WERE INTENTIONALLY DELETED
Prepare written input in the form of a it is easily neglected. You can give different types
memorandum from yourself to the responsible of recognition. You can recognize good
party in your chain of command via your division performance with rewards such as special liberty,
officer and department head. Again, a written permission to sleep late, and more time for noon
input should reflect a sincere interest in the chow. For subordinates who show extra
betterment of the command as a whole. From dedication, you should go that extra mile by
there it will go through your department, to the recommending them for awards or recognition.
command master chief, and then to the executive
officer, all of whom will submit their recommen- TYPE OF RECOGNITION
dations. It will finally go to your commanding
officer, who will give final approval or You can recommend subordinates for five
disapproval. types of recognition:

1. Petty officer and Sailor of the Quarter/


RECOMMENDING SUBORDINATES Year
FOR COLLATERAL DUTIES 2. Letter of Appreciation
3. Letter of Commendation
Recommending personnel for collateral duties 4. Navy Achievement Medal
is one way you can develop your subordinates 5. Meritorious Advancement
ability to function in different skill environments.
That type of development will help your sub- You must recommend subordinates for some
ordinates during all phases of advancement in of these awards in writing. However, just because
their naval career. you exercise the initiative to send in a
You can use two methods of recommending recommendation doesnt mean it will be ap-
subordinates for collateral duties: proved. That is why you must write strong and
convincing recommendations. Your recommenda-
1. Verbal tions must convince other leaders in the chain of
2. Written command that your subordinates truly stand out
from their peers and deserve the award.
VERBAL
WRITTEN FORMAT
Give verbal recommendations for the
assignment of subordinates to duties within the Writing subordinates accomplishments in
command level such as command master-at-arms bullet format can make your recommendation
force or mess decks master-at-arms. The stronger. A bullet format is more effective because
departments involved usually arrange these it cuts out all the colorful phrases and gets to the
collateral duties. point.

WRITTEN
AUTHORITY AND RESPONSIBILITY
Make written recommendations when the OF A LEADING PETTY OFFICER
collateral duty involves a subordinate being (LPO)
temporarily assigned to work in another command
and temporary additional duty (TAD) orders. Authority is granted only to support you in
Send a copy of the members most recent carrying out your assigned duties and responsi-
evaluation to the receiving command as evidence bilities. Authority falls into two categories:
that the person is capable and deserving of a GENERAL and ORGANIZATIONAL. All of-
chance to fill the collateral billet. ficer and petty officers have the general authority
needed to fulfill their duties and responsibilities
by virtue of their positions within the Navy
RECOMMENDING SUBORDINATES organization. Individuals have the organizational
FOR AWARDS AND RECOGNITION authority needed to fulfill their duties and
responsibilities by virtue of assignment to a
One of your easiest and most rewarding tasks specific billet within an organizational subunit of
will be to give rewards for good performance; yet, the Navy (ship, station, staff, and so forth).

2-28
A multiple-address message is sent to two or officer is the releasing officer, but the
more addressees, each of whom is aware of the commanding officer may delegate releasing
other addressee(s). Each addressee is designated authority.
either as action or information.
A book message is sent to two or more DRAFTER. The drafter is the person who
addressees and is of such a nature that no composes the message. Among all personnel
addressee needs to know who the others are. Each involved with message management, the drafter
addressee is informed whether the message is for is the key to an effective program. The drafter
action or information. The station sending a book necessarily must have the most detailed knowl-
message divides addressees into groups according edge and understanding of basic message
tot he relay stations serving them, and a separate procedures. The drafter is responsible for the
message is prepared and transmitted to each relay following:
station.
A general message has a wide standard dis- 1. Proper addressing
tribution to all commands in an area under one
2. Proper application of security classifica-
command or to types of commands and activities.
tion, special handling, and declassification
General messages are of many types, each of
markings required by Department of the Navy
which carries an identifying title and is intended
Information and Personnel Security Program
for a standard set of addressees, such as all
Regulation, OPNAVINST 5510.1H
commands, U.S. Pacific Fleet (ALCOMPAC).
All messages of a given general message title are 3. Selection of appropriate precedence
numbered serially throughout the calendar year;
4. Correct formatting and accuracy of typing
for example, a message numbered ALNAV 12-91
signifies it is the 12th message sent to all Navy 5. Clear, concise composition
activities (ALNAV) during 1991.
Normally you will come in contact only with ADDRESSEE. The addressees responsi-
single-address, multiple-address, and general bilities depend on the type of action required of
messages. When you are drafting messages, you the addressee in response to the message. An
will be writing either a single- or multiple- action addressee may be required take immediate
addressee type of message. action in response to the message. An information
addressee normally is not required to take any
action based on the message. In either case, the
Preparing the Message message may have to be readdressed to another
activity, which will be discussed later.
Your specific responsibilities concerning
messages will depend on your involvement with
each message. You may be the releaser, drafter, Message Precedence
or the addressee (receiver) of the message. Any
command or activity may be an originator. The precedence has different meanings. To the
drafter, it indicates the desired speed of delivery
ORIGINATOR. The originator of a to the addressees. To the telecommunications
message is the authority (command or activity) center, it indicates the relative order of processing
in whose name the message is sent. The originator and delivery. To the addressees, it indicates the
is responsible for the functions of the message relative order in which they should determine
drafter and message releaser. the import ante of the message. The precedence
assigned to a message is determined by the relative
RELEASER. The message releaser is a importance of the subject matter of the text and
designated person authorized to release a message the desired writer-to-reader delivery time.
for transmission in the name of the originator. Although the assignment of the precedence is the
The releaser is responsible for validating the drafters responsibility, the releaser of the message
contents of the message, for affirming the message may change the precedence or mode of
is in compliance with message-drafting transmission.
instructions, and for determining whether the
draft of the message should be released as a mes- CATEGORIES. Messages are divided into
sage or as a NAVGRAM. Usually the commanding four common precedence categories: Routine,

2-31
Priority, Immediate, and Flash. Figure 2-13 shows the acknowledgment of messages. The following
examples of the different types of precedence. factors should be considered when submitting a
complete information concerning message pre- reply to a message:
cedence is contained in Naval Telecommunica-
1. Does the message have a reply due date?
tions Procedures (NTP), Telecommunications
2. Must the reply be forwarded by
Users Manual, NTP 3(H).
telecommunication message, or can it be
sent by naval letter or NAVGRAM?
Routine. Routine is the precedence assigned to
all types of traffic that justify electrical Regardless of the reaction times established
transmission but are not of sufficient urgency to locally, Flash and Emergency Command pre-
require a higher precedence. The Routine pre- cedence messages requiring a reply must always
cedence is identified by the prosign R. be handled as quickly as possible. In some cases,
you may be required to forward a reply to the
Priority. Priority is the precedence reserved originator in less than 30 minutes.
for messages that furnish essential information
Date-Time Group
for the conduct of operations in progress. That
is the highest precedence normally authorized for The date-time group (DTG) is assigned to
administrative messages. Priority precedence is messages for identification purposes only. The
identified by the prosign P. DTG consists of six digits followed by a time-zone
suffix (for example, 021930Z). The first pair of
Immediate. Immediate precedence is digits (02) denotes the day of the month; the
reserved for messages relating to situations that second pair (19) indicates the hour; and the third
gravely affect the national forces or populace and pair (30), the minutes. All DTGs are expressed
require immediate delivery to addressees. Im- in Greenwich Mean Time (Z) unless otherwise
mediate precedence is identified by the prosign O. directed by higher authority. In addition, the
abbreviated month and year of origin are ap-
Flash. Flash precedence is reserved for initial pended to the DTG. Therefore, the DTG 021930Z
enemy contact reports or operational combat JAN 91 would be identified as a message being
messages of extreme urgency. Message brevity is officially released from a communications facility
mandatory in Flash messages. Flash precedence for transmission at 1930 hours, Greenwich Mean
is identified by the prosign Z. Time, on the 2nd of January 1991.
Another precedence is the Emergency Com- Although not considered as part of the date-
mand. The Emergency Command precedence time group, the originators name must be
(ECP) is not commonly used but preempts all included in the identification of a specific
other precedence. Its use is limited to the National message. For example, NETPMSA Pensacola FL
Command Authority, certain designated com- 032115Z MAY 91 indicates a specific message
manders of unified and specified commands, and originated by Naval Education and Training
specifically designated emergency action com- Program Management Support Activity, Pensa-
mand and control messages. When used, ECP is cola, Florida. However, a message identified only
identified by the prosign Y. by the DTG 032115Z MAY 91 is not properly
Messages having both action and information identified since any command in the Navy could
addressees may be assigned a single precedence have released a message with the same DTG.
or a dual precedence. A dual precedence exists
Message Format
when a higher precedence is assigned to action
addressees than to information addressees. The Figure 2-14 shows the Joint Message Form
assignment of a dual precedence must be con- (DD-173/2). Naval Telecommunications Pro-
sidered on all messages with information ad- cedures (NTP), Telecommunications Users
dressees when other than routine precedence is Manual, NTP 3(H), and U.S. Navy Plain
assigned to the action addressee(s). Language Directory, NTP 3, SUPP-1 (K), give the
fundamental format and procedures for preparing
REACTION TIME. -The precedence the naval message.
assigned to a message has no direct effect on the
time by which a reply must be sent or on the ADDRESS COMPONENTS. The address
precedence assigned to that reply. Each activity consists of the plain language address (PLA); the
must establish its own requirements concerning message originator; and the action, information,

2-33
Text. Use the proper choice of words and message as it was originally drafted. This process
good writing techniques to help you write brief is called message readdressal. The originator
messages; however, do not make your message or action addressee of a message may readdress
brief at the cost of accuracy. Limit the use of that message for action or information to another
abbreviations to those that are self-evident or activity. An information addressee may readdress
recognizable because of their long-established use. a message for information purposes only.
You may make exceptions in the case of currently When a readdressal message is prepared, it
authorized abbreviations used in routine admini- must be handled and accounted for as a complete,
strative and technical traffic handled only by unique message. Readdressal messages carry a
persons familiar with the abbreviations. Dont use unique date-time group and supplementary head-
short titles or abbreviations in the text if the ing and must be released by a person authorized
message is addressed to a member of Congress, to release messages.
a commercial concern, or a nonmilitary address.
Do not carry the use of uncommon phrases and Message Cancellations
modes of expression to the point that the meaning
of the message becomes ambiguous or obscure. Only the originator may cancel a message. All
In case of doubt, clarity always takes precedence message directives are automatically canceled 90
over brevity. The following are some punctuation days following the release date, except under the
and symbols you may use to enhance clarity within following circumstances:
the message text:
1. The text of a message provides for an
Hyphen (-) earlier cancellation.
Question mark (?) 2. A subsequent message extends the cancella-
Colon (:) tion date.
Dollar sign ($) 3. A message is reissued, by the originator,
Apostrophe () in standard directive format within 90 days
Ampersand (&) of the release date.
Parentheses (left and right) ( )
Period (.) Minimize Condition
Comma (,)
Virgule (or slant) (/) Minimize is a condition imposed by proper
Quotation mark () authority to reduce and control electrical message
and telephone traffic. The purpose of minimize
You may not use the following punctuation is to clear the telecommunications network of
marks and symbols in a naval message: message and voice traffic in which urgency does
not justify electrical transmission during an actual
Number symbol (#) or simulated crisis. During periods of minimize,
At sign (@) message drafters and releasers must review all
Percent (%) messages to ensure electrical transmission is
Fractions (1/2, 1/4, and so forth) essential and the lowest precedence consistent with
Asterisk (*) speed of service objectives is used. Messages
Underscore ( _ ) prepared for electrical transmission under mini-
Cent sign () mize conditions must have the phrase MINI-
MIZE CONSIDERED located in the special
DOWNGRADING AND DECLASSIFICA-
instructions block.
TION MARKINGS. YOU must apply down-
grading and declassification markings to all
OFFICIAL CORRESPONDENCE
classified messages. These markings are located
on the first line after the last line of the text.
As a senior petty officer, you will be required
OPNAVINST 5510.1H contains specific infor-
to compose correspondence from brief notes and
mation about appropriate markings.
occasionally from oral instructions. You will be
required to prepare a first draft that will need only
Message Readdressals
minor changes before the draft is ready for
Frequently, a message must be transmitted to smooth typing. You must master the writing of
an activity that was not an addressee of the short, routine correspondence to the point that

2-36
Unless they are closely related, do not cover two person have difficulty in understanding it, make
subjects in one letter. changes, even if you must take out your favorite
Next, write a rough draft. At this point, dont sentence. That happens occasionally even to the
worry too much about spelling, punctuation, or best of writers. Be glad you found those areas and
other aspects of a finished style. Concentrate on had the opportunity to clarify them.
getting all the necessary information in writing. Review the draft for useless words. Take out
Express your ideas as clearly and effectively as words you dont need and words that add nothing
possible. If you cant immediately think of the to the meaning of your sentence. Change long
right word to use, put down the best one you can words to shorter ones and take out intensives
think of. Then mark the spot and come back to (extremely, undoubtedly, very much). Take out
it later to see if you can find another word that overworked introductory phrases (it is to be noted,
expresses your idea more clearly. it is a well-known fact that, in accordance with,
As you become more experienced, you will we call your attention to the fact that). Sometimes
develop your own writing style. As a beginner, you may need one of these phrases; however, if
you should concentrate on simply getting your you dont need it, you should delete it.
thoughts into writing. While reviewing the rough draft, look for
words used repeatedly; replace them wit h different
REVIEWING THE DRAFT. -If possible, words having the same meaning. Likewise, omit
allow a little time to elapse after finishing the repetition of ideas. Although you may sometimes
rough draft before going over it again. If time repeat words and ideas for emphasis, most repeti-
permits, put the it aside for a while and work on tion results from carelessness. Unless you have
something else. When you resume work on the repeated words or ideas deliberately and for a
draft, you will be more objective and see ways purpose, either change or delete them.
of improving it. While reviewing the draft, keep in mind the
When you first reread the draft, go through preferred style of the person who will sign the
it from start to finish; stop only to make brief correspondence. Most people who sign corre-
notes about how the text can be improved. Read spondence have certain words and phrases they
the rough draft with a critical eye to determine prefer and certain ones they do not allow.
if what you have written is correct, clear, and Learning those words and phrases as quickly as
stated as effectively as possible. Then go through possible will eliminate the inconvenience of having
the draft again, referring to your notes and to add or delete them each time.
rewriting as needed.
Ensure the accuracy of any information, such ACCEPTING CRITICISM. -Once you have
as numbers and dates, cited from the references completed the smooth draft, you will probably
listed at the beginning of your letter. Correct any feel a certain pride in your accomplishment.
inaccuracies. Be sure you mention references However, dont let yourself become fond of the
shown in the heading of the letter in chronological way you have expressed something. If the draft
order within the text at least once. Do not cover must go through several reviewers before it is
two subjects in one letter unless they are very signed, you should accept the fact that changes
closely related. That practice can result in will be made. The minute you permit yourself to
administrative confusion when replies are become fond of your writing, you become
required. reluctant to change, which can mean trouble in
Often material does not fit smoothly with what two ways. First, most writing can be improved;
comes next. To correct that problem, first check therefore, instead of allowing criticism to hurt
the organization of your ideas. Be sure your ideas your feelings, use it to improve your writing.
follow a logical order. If your organization is Second, someone else will sign most Navy
good, then you may need to use transitional words correspondence; so dont feel distressed if the
or expressions to show the relation between one signer insists on changing the wording before
thought and the next. For example, you could use signing. After all, the signer assumes responsibility
the transitional word however to show contrast for the content of the correspondence.
between one idea and another. You might use the If your wording is misunderstood or your
phrases to begin with or in conclusion to show reasoning is overlooked, bring it to the signers
a sequence of ideas. attention. In such cases, you would be justified
If you think a passage may be unclear to the in defending what you have written. However, if
reader, have someone else read it. Should that the signer still doesnt accept your changes, you

2-38
Remember to keep ideas orderly; state requests ideas. Next, we will talk about four ways to avoid
before justifications, answers before explana- sentences that mumble.
tions, conclusions before discussions, summaries
before details, and the general before the 1. Subordinate, or reemphasize, minor ideas.
specific. In other words, place them in dependent clauses
rather than in the main (or required) part of the
Delay your main point to soften bad news or sentence. Besides clarifying the relationship
to introduce a controversial proposal, but dont between ideas, subordination prevents the overuse
delay routinely. Readers, like listeners, are put of and, the weakest of all conjunctions.
off by people who take forever to get to the point.
To end most letters, just stop. Example: The naval station exchange uses a
Reading slows with every glance from the text similar contractor service and saves
to a reference citation. Use only those references its patrons about 15 percent. (Two
that bear directly on the subject at hand. Avoid ideas presented in two independent
unnecessary or complicated references. Reading clauses as equally important.)
letters that overuse references is like driving Better: By using a similar contractor
in reverse through alphabet soup. If you do use service, the naval station exchange
references, be sure to mention in the text any saves its patrons about 15 percent.
reference cited in the reference block. List (One ideausing a similar con-
references in the reference block by following the tractor servicepresented in de-
order of their appearance in the text. pendent clause as less important
When writing a response to an earlier com- than the idea presented in main
munication, subordinate it to your main point. part of the sentence.)
Dont waste the openingthe strongest place in
a letterby merely summarizing a reference or 2. Place ideas deliberately. Start and finish a
saying you received or reviewed something. sentence any way you like, but keep in mind that
ideas gain emphasis when they appear at either
Example: Reference (a) recommended the re- end. Putting an idea in the middle causes it to lose
establishment of training in the emphasis.
field of transportation manage-
Example: We have determined that moving
ment. Reinstitution of this train-
the computer as shown in enclosure
ing is strongly supported.
(1) would allow room for another
Better: We strongly support the recom-
cabinet to be installed.
mendation in reference (a) to
re-establish transportation manage- Better: Moving the computer as shown in
ment training. enclosure (1) would allow room for
another cabinet.
When writing, use short paragraphs; long
paragraphs cause main ideas to get lost. Cover 3. Use more parallelism. Express two or more
one topic completely before starting another; but equally important ideas in similar words and
keep paragraphs short, roughly four or five similar constructions. Parallelism saves words,
sentences. Now and then, you may use a one- clarifies ideas, and provides balance. Parallelism
sentence paragraph to highlight an important idea. means that when you use a coordinating con-
Short paragraphs are especially important at the junction (and, but, nor, yet), nouns, adjectives,
start of letters because readers become dis- dependent clauses, and so on, should match in
couraged if you start out with long paragraphs. each part of the sentence. They should have the
A paragraph may need a topic sentence, or it same grammatical form and structure.
may not. The topic sentence of a paragraph is like
Example: A good writer must be precise and
the main point of a letter; both are general have originality. (Precise is an
statements that you develop later. Even though adjective; originality is a noun.)
you could write a short and simple letter as one
unbroken paragraph, divide it for ease of reading. Better: A good writer must be precise and
So far we have talked about structuring letters original. (Both precise and original
and paragraphs to call attention to important are adjectives.)

2-47
4. Use some mini-sentences. Sentences should Sentences that give directions lead with verbs;
generally be 20 words or less. However, you is simply implied. This direct approach
occasionally using sentences of six words or less requires imagination more than technical skill.
slows down the reader and emphasizes ideas. Think of writing not as words on a page but as
speaking from a distance.
Example: I can get more information if each Multiplied across an entire letter, roundabout
of you gives me less. Heres why. sentences like those in the next examples do severe
In a week, about 110 staff actions damage. We would be laughed out of the room
show up in my in-box. I could if we talked that way. Ordinary English is
handle that in a week if all I did shorter, clearer, and just as official:
was work the in-box. Yet 70
percent of my time in the head- Example: It is necessary that the material be
quarters goes not to the in-box but received in this office by 10 June.
to briefings. I could handle that
dilemma, tooby listening to Better: We need the material by 10 June.
briefings and thinking about staff (or) The material must reach us by
papers at the same time. 10 June.

Make your writing as formal or informal as It is and this command complicate the next
the situation requires, but do so with language you example. They force readers to put back the
might use in speaking. The most readable writing pronouns the writer took out. To make matters
sounds like people talking to people. worse, the first it is refers to the reader while the
To make your writing more like speaking, be- second refers to the sender.
gin by imagining your reader is sitting across from
Example: If it is desired that Marines be
you. Write with personal pronouns, every-
allowed to compete for positions
day words, and short sentences. Dont go out of
on the pistol team, this command
your way to use personal pronouns, but dont
would be happy to establish and
avoid them. Speak of your activity, command,
manage team tryouts. It is recom-
or office as we, us, and our. When you are writing
mended that tryouts be conducted
to many addresses, speak directly to one reader;
soon to ensure . . . .
only one person reads your writing at any one
time. Better: If you allow Marines to compete
for - positions on the pistol team, we
Example: All addressees are requested to
would be happy to establish and
provide inputs of desired course
manage the tryouts. We recom-
content.
mend that tryouts start soon to
Better: Please send us your recommenda- ensure . . . .
tions for course content.
Can you overdo personal pronouns? Yes you
When you write directives, look for can. You can use so many pronouns that you
opportunities to talk directly to a user. obscure the subject, and no number of them will
Procedures, checklists, or other how-to overcome confused thinking. Besides, some
instructions lend themselves to this cookbook subjects dont lend themselves to pronouns. The
approach. Imagine someone has walked up to you description of a ships structure, for example, isnt
and asked what to do. The following example is likely to include people. Also, criticism hurts
from a notice that repeated the duty officer dozens fewer feelings if delivered impersonally. "Nothing
of times: has been done" avoids the direct attack of "You
have done nothing."
Example: The duty officer will verify that If we or I opens more than two sentences in
security responsibilities have been a row, the writing becomes monotonous and may
completed by putting his/her suggest self-centeredness. Sometimes a single
initials in the checklist. sentence can call too much attention to the sender:
I would like to extend my congratulations for
Better: When you complete the inspection, a job well done. Praise should stress the reader:
initial the checklist. "Congratulations on the fine job you did."

2-48
Stressing the readers interests is a matter of Be concrete in your writing. Dont use a
attitude more than pronouns, but pronouns general word if the context allows for a specific
contribute. The help you receive suggests more one. Be as definite as the situation permits.
concern for readers than the help we provide. If you write, The solution to low morale and
By being sensitive to the difference, you are more poor discipline is good leadership, your readers
likely to meet your readers needs. may feel warm all over. But until you point out
Dont use big words when little ones will do. some specific behavior meant by low morale, poor
(See table 2-1.) Rely on everyday words. People discipline, and good leadership, neither you nor
who speak with small words often think they must your readers can tackle the problem. Similarly,
burden their writing with needlessly large words. dont use a general word if the context allows for
Do you remember the city dude in those old a specific one. Be as definite as the situation
Western movies who overdressed to impress the permits.
folks at the ranch? Overdressed writing fails just Performance evaluations suffer when writers
as foolishly. All writers try to impress readers. The make extravagant, unsupported claims. Effective
best do it through language that doesnt call atten- evaluations show what a person did and how well
tion to itself. Size of vocabulary is less impor- it was done. They are concrete enough to inspire
tant than skill in using the words you already know. confidence in the writers judgment about the
Normally, use short, commonly spoken transi- ratees performance and potential. Break long
tional words instead of long, bookish ones. Use sentences into manageable units. Then prune
long transitional words occasionally for variety. needless words and ideas.
By using short ones, you help set an ordinary tone
for the whole sentence. Example: It is requested that attendees be
divided between the two briefing
BOOKISH SPOKEN dates with the understanding that
any necessary final adjustments
consequently so will be made by OP-96 to facili-
tate equitable distribution. (29
however but words)

in addition also Improved: It is requested that attendees be


divided between the two briefing
nevertheless still dates. Any necessary final adjust-
ments will be made by OP-96 to
Avoid the needless complications of legalistic facilitate equitable distribution.
lingo. Let a directives number or a letters signa- (12 and 13 words)
ture carry the authority. You risk being wordy and
pompous by trying to put that authority in your Better: Send half your people on one dav
language. Write to express not to impress. and half on the other. OP-96 will
make final adjustments. (12 and
LEGALISTIC NORMAL 5 words)

aforesaid the, that A request gains emphasis when it ends with


a question mark. Look for opportunities to reach
heretofore until now out to your reader:

herewith is here is Example: Request this command be notified


as to whether the conference has
notwithstanding in spite of been rescheduled.

the undersigned I Better: Has the conference been


rescheduled?
Dont be afraid to use some contractions in
your writing. If you are comfortable with Without generalizations and abstractions, lots
contractions, your writing is likely to read easily, of them, we would drown in detail. We sum up
for you will be speaking on paper. vast amounts of experience when we speak of

2-51
dedication, programs, hardware, and lines of isnt whether the group should exist but what it
authority. But such broad language isnt likely to should discuss.
evoke in a readers mind the same experiences it
evokes in a writers. Lazy writing overuses such The person who signed the letter improved the
vague terms. Often it weakens them further by passage by dropping the second sentence and
substituting adjectives; for example: immense making the first one do more work:
dedication, enhanced programs, viable hardware,
and responsive lines of authority. As you requested, I am submitting some
agenda topics for the meeting of the
FOR TRY Committee on Atmosphere and Oceans.

aircraft plane Now imagine you have asked for more time
to complete a correspondence course. Here is
plane F-18 the last sentence of the letter that turns you
down:
improved costs lower costs
If we can be of further assistance, please
enhanced method faster method; cheaper do not hesitate to write.
method
Beware of such rubber-stamp endings. They
Tone a writers attitude toward the subject dont improve good letters or save bad ones. To
or readerscauses relatively few problems in the reader whose request has been denied, further
routine letters. The rules are straight forward. assistance promises further disappointment. The
Subordinates may suggest, request, or recom- closing sentence should be dropped entirely or tied
mend, but only superiors may direct. Although to the rest of the letter:
pronouns are acceptable, dont get personal.
Courtesy is required; warmth is not. This setback aside, we hope you will take
Because much of our writing is routine, tone advantage of other correspondence courses
causes problems when the subject matter is available to you.
delicate. The more sensitive the reader or issue,
the more careful we must be to promote good will. Most no answers need some explanation. Yes
Tactlessness in writing suggests clumsiness in answers need little explanation because readers get
general. When feelings are involved, one misused what they want.
word can make an enemy.
What do you think of an organization that Finally, imagine you are a reservist who has
would send a letter containing the following asked to stay on active duty even though you have
sentences? a serious illness. How would the following answer
strike you?
At our last meeting you requested agenda
topics for a meeting of the Committee on Because you have failed to pass the
Atmosphere and Oceans. I certainly sup- prescribed physical examination, you will
port this interagency grouping as it be removed from active duty.
may serve as an appropriate forum for
addressing our marine technology needs Failed? Removed? Those words hint at crime
and concerns. and punishment. To avoid such tactlessness, the
writer should have used positive wording.
The first sentence is just lazy, for it does no
more than repeat the request. The real trouble NEGATIVE POSITIVE
comes from the second sentence, whose attempt
Opportunity is limited. Competition is keen.
at good will backfires. Certainly is a needless
intensifier, like many words ending in /y. Stop writing badly. Start writing well.
Interagency grouping is pompous for group.
Needs and concerns add bulk; only one of the Dont use the small
hoist. Use the big hoist.
words is needed. Certainly support this is
undermined by it may serve. May serve? The issue The cup is half empty. The cup is half full.

2-52
The positive approach would remove some of Better: All active-duty personnel must
the sting from the reservists answer. Here are two receive flu vaccinations.
possibilities:
Example: There will be a meeting of the
Better: Given the results of your physical Human Relations Council at 1000
examination, we must transfer you to on 26 July in the main conference
the Retired Reserve. room.
Better: The Human Relations Council will
Better: In light of your physical examination meet at 1000 on 26 July in the main
and the need to administer the conference room.
examination program fairly, we have
decided in favor of your transfer to Wordy expressions dont give writing
the Retired Reserve. impressive bulk; they clutter it by getting in the
way of the words that carry meaning. Here are
When writing a letter to inform someone of some repeat offenders:
negative information, stress some positive aspects
about the person or the situation. For example, NOT BUT
the writer of the preceding letter to the reservist for the purpose of for, to
could have opened by acknowledging the favor-
able endorsements that accompanied the request in accordance with by, following, per,
to stay on active duty. The writer could have under
closed by thanking the reservist for his or her time
of service. This tactful arrangement would have in order to to
helped to soften the bad news.
in the event that if
In writing, give your ideas no more words than
they deserve. The longer you take to say things, in the near future soon
the weaker you come across and the more you risk
blurring important ideas. You must suspect Wordy expressions dilute the meaning of the
wordiness in everything you write. When you sentences in the next examples:
revise, tighten paragraphs to sentences, sentences
to clauses, clauses to phrases, phrases to words, Example: In accordance with reference (b),
words to pictures, or strike the ideas entirely. To you may pay the claim with a check
be easy on your readers, you must be hard on in the amount of $300.
yourself.
Better: Under reference (b), you may pay
No phrases hurt naval writing more than it is the claim with a check for $300.
and there is or there are. They stretch sen-
tences, delay meaning, hide responsibility, and Words ending in -ion and -ment are verbs
encourage passive verbs. Avoid using these turned into nouns. Whenever the context permits,
phrases. change these words to verb forms. By favoring
verb forms, your sentences will be shorter and
NOT BUT livelier.
It is requested We request, please Example: Use that format for the prepara-
tion of your command history.
It is my intention I intend
Better: Use that format to prepare your
It is necessary that you You need to; you must command history.
There is a serial number A serial number is on Example: The development of an effective
on the letter. the letter. system depends on three factors.
There are several files Several files are Improved: Developing an effective system
missing. missing. depends on three factors.

Example: It is mandatory that all active-duty Better: An effective system depends on


personnel receive flu vaccinations. three factors.

2-53
As the writer, you may see some differences A verb in the passive voice uses any form of
between advise and assist, interest and concern, to be (am, is, are, was, were, be, being, been) plus
or thanks and gratitude. But your readers wont. the past participle of a main verb, such as driven
Repeating a general idea cant make it any more or inspected. Unlike sentences with active verbs,
precise. Simple subtraction will overcome the use sentences with passives dont need to show who
of similar words such as these: or what has done the verbs action. Most passives
just imply the "doer, which can sometimes make
Example: We must comply with the standards the sentence unclear. Use one of three cures for
and criteria for controlling and passive verbs.
reducing environmental pollution.
1. Put a doer before the verb:
Better: We must comply with the stan-
dards for reducing environmental Example: Appropriate clothing will be worn
pollution. by all personnel.

Avoid hut-2-3-4 phraseslong chains of Improved: All personnel will wear appro-
nouns and modifiers. Readers cant tell what priate clothing.
adjective modifies what noun or where the
modifiers end. We must live with some official Better: Wear appropriate clothing.
hut-2-3-4 phrases, such as fleet-oriented
consolidated stock list, but you can avoid forming 2. Drop part of the verb:
unofficial phrases. Rearrange modifiers or rewrite
Example: Then he was transferred to Nor-
such phrases entirely:
folk.
Example: The Board of Inspection and
Better: Then he transferred to Norfolk.
Survey service acceptance trials
requirements
3. Change the verb:
Better: requirements by the Board of
Example: Personnel are prohibited from do-
Inspection and Survey for service
ing so.
acceptance trials
Better: Personnel must not do so.
Excessive abbreviating is false economy. Use
abbreviations no more than you must with insiders Write passively if you have good reason to
and avoid them entirely with outsiders. Spell out avoid saying who or what has done the verbs
an unfamiliar abbreviation the first time it
action. You might do that when the doer is
appears. If it appears only twice or infrequently,
unknown, unimportant, obvious, or better left
spell out the term each time and avoid the unsaid. When in doubt, write actively, even
abbreviation entirely. Put clarity before economy. though the doer may seem obvious. You will write
livelier sentences (not, livelier sentences will be
Example: Marine Corps Development and written by you).
Education Command (MCDEC)

Passive verbs cause problems. They make


SUMMARY
writing wordy, roundabout, and sometimes
downright confusing. Learn how to spot passive In this chapter we discussed the work center
verbs and make them active. Most sentences schedule, how to manage your time, and the
should use a who-does-what order. By leading importance of a smoothly run work center.
with the doer, you automatically avoid a passive You must seek self-improvement through
verb. leadership self-assessment to become a leader of
Navy men and women. While assessing your
Passive: The ship was inspected by the leadership skills, keep in mind that no best
skipper. leadership method exists. You may have to change
your leadership behavior to fit your changing
Active: The skipper inspected the ship. work environment.

2-54
CHAPTER 3

PROGRAMS AND POLICIES

LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. Describe the Navys Command Managed Equal 6. Identify various types and classes of drugs.
Opportunity (CMEO) Program.
7. Describe some of the common identifiable signs of
2. Describe the duties of the command assessment drug and alcohol abuse.
team (CAT) and command training team (CTT). 8. Describe the difference between problem drinking
3. Describe the procedures for the conduct of mast. and alcohol abuse.
4. Describe the programs and policies for identifying 9. Identify the rehabilitation services available for
and providing treatment for drug and alcohol drug and alcohol abusers.
abusers.
5. Describe your responsibilities in support of the
Navys Drug and Alcohol Abuse Program in
achieving zero tolerance.

Todays Navy emphasizes equal opportunity. We COMMAND MANAGED EQUAL


will discuss the Command Managed Equal Opportunity OPPORTUNITY
program including the command assessment team and
Command Managed Equal Opportunity (CMEO)
command training teams. We will discuss conduct of
ensures that commands do not wait for discriminatory
mast in relationship to equal opportunity and will close
incidents to occur before taking corrective action.
with programs and policies for drug and alcohol abuse.
Commands must assess themselves as often as possible
A command must have an environment of equal
to problem-solve and to develop their own plans of
opportunity to attain and maintain high morale,
action to correct any deficiencies. Equal opportunity is
discipline, and effectiveness. Positive actions to counter
an integral part of each commands leadership and
discrimination will help achieve that environment. The
management activities.
policy of the Navy is to ensure equal opportunity and
treatment for all military and civilian personnel of the As a supervisor you must lead the way by
Department of the Navy, regardless of race, religion, demonstrating those behaviors you require of
color, gender, age, or national origin. The prevention of subordinates. You must show a general respect for all
discrimination based on educational, cultural, and ethnic people through what you say and what you
differences and the promotion of sexual equity within do-especially with respect to equal opportunity.
the Navy are command responsibilities. The Navy will All Navy units must have a CMEO program. CMEO
not tolerate discrimination resulting in the denial of was preceded by Phase I and Phase II of the equal
equal opportunity to any individual. Persistent opportunity program. Phase I was a race relations
discrimination is cause for disciplinary action and education program; Phase II was designed to translate
ultimately may result in dismissal or discharge from the the awareness generated by Phase I into positive
Navy. affirmative actions.

3-1
CMEO redefines the self-sustaining aspects of Responsibility to Subordinates
Phase II and reestablishes minimum program
requirements. The purpose of CMEO is as follows: Your subordinates should never doubt that you fully
support the Navys equal opportunity program. To
1. To emphasize the commanding officers accomplish that, lead by example; that will set a standard
responsibility for creating and maintaining a for them to follow.
positive equal opportunity climate within the
ENSURE SUBORDINATES' KNOWLEDGE
command
OF YOUR SUPPORT OF EQUAL
2. To underscore the chain of commands OPPORTUNITY. -Clearly state to subordinates that
responsibility for identifying and resolving you support and require them to support equal
equal opportunity and sexual harassment opportunity. Deal positively and directly with all your
problems and concerns people equally, and consider each one individually.
3. To provide commands with the capability to You can recognize poor supervisors easily. They
monitor equal opportunity issues, maintain the typically are unable to understand any point of view but
flexibility to address their own needs, and their own. They often make derogatory remarks about
allocate resources as the situation demands groups of people, frequently stereotype people, and feel
free to harass or intimidate members of particular
4, To provide commands with a system for groups.
monitoring all personnel issues that affect
MAINTAIN CLEAR COMMUNICATIONS
individual promotion; duty assignments; or
WITH SUBORDINATES. You must communicate
other actions emphasizing merit, ability,
clearly with your people if you are to manage them
performance, and potential effectively. One of the barriers of supervising people
CMEO is an equal opportunity management system who arc different from you is dealing with unknowns.
controlled primarily at the command level. If you do not understand how people think, feel, and act,
Command-level control makes equal opportunity a you might avoid them. You might substitute what you
reality in each command. dont know with generalized ideas and stereotypes.
Therefore, your equal opportunity skills should include
the ability to listen and understand what people say.
SUPERVISORS RESPONSIBILITIES
Responsibility to Command
One of the trademarks of a good supervisor is the
ability to develop subordinates by helping them grow As a senior petty officer, you have a responsibility
both personally and professionally. To develop to communicate your support of equal opportunity
subordinates, first identify their strengths and throughout the command. Your support of equal
weaknesses. Then counsel, coach, and provide opportunity does not end with responsibility for your
on-the-job training. Last, give timely feedback on their division; you are the example throughout your
performance as well as fair and constructive command. Every time you venture into other areas,
evaluations. others learn a lot about your support of equal
opportunity simply by the way you handle yourself
Conflict is inevitable in any group of people who outside your divisional spaces.
work or live closely together. Racial, sexual, ethnic, and
PROJECT YOUR SUPPORT. -As a senior petty
religious differences among people can be irritants that
officer within your command, you may be called upon
cause conflict. Accept the fact that your people will have
to give command lectures regarding the responsibilities
conflicts; then concentrate on managing the conflict of equal opportunity. When giving lectures, project your
rather than ignoring or suppressing it. support as strongly as possible. After all, your view may
Support the Navys equal opportunity program at be the first intensive look at equal opportunity
your own command by evaluating and resolving subordinates have had since entering the naval service.
discrimination complaints at the lowest level possible. ENFORCE EQUAL OPPORTUNITY. -An equal
Never suppress legitimate equal opportunity complaints opportunity program can succeed only if the command
or retaliate against personnel who express a sincere identifies, weighs, and corrects insensitive practices.
grievance in this area. Any person, military or civilian, who directly or

3-2
COMMAND RECORDS. -Command records 2. Counseling through the use of locally prepared
contain information relevant to equal opportunity such counseling sheets
as training, sailor of the month/quarter/year, awards,
3. A letter of Instruction (LOI)
meritorious mast, and discrimination complaints.
4. A page 13
INTERVIEWS. Interviews provide information
that is not available in command records. Interviews 5. A special evaluation
reveal not only what is actually happening at a In some cases you may be required to document
command, but also what people perceive to be facts by entering them as a page 13 service record entry
happening and how they feel about it. In a sensitive area or as a special evaluation. Since page 13 entries and
like equal opportunity, information about what people special evaluations become a permanent part of a
think and feel is often as important as documented facts. members record, you should use the less severe
OBSERVATIONS. -Observations are a means of counseling methods first.
determining what people actually door how they behave
and interact. They are also an indirect way of collecting Nonjudicial Punishment
data on what people think and feel. As an unbiased
observer, the CAT must be able to distinguish between The Navy awards nonjudicial punishment in equal
facts, opinions, and judgments. To avoid bias, the team opportunist y cases involving repeat offenders. You will
must also use other data sources from which to draw be put on report and must appear before the
conclusions. commanding officer (captains mast). Some of the
punishments that may be given at captains mast are:
USE OF DATA COLLECTED. Information
collected from records, interviews, observations, and Restriction
surveys provides managers with CMEO-related data Correctional Custody
about specific groups of people within the command. As
a minimum, commands maintain specific data on Confinement on diminished rations
retention, advancement, and discipline of the crew. If the Extra duty
data shows the existence of disproportionate numbers
of minorities, commands investigate and take Forfeiture of pay
precautions to ensure they are not the result of Reduction in grade
discriminatory practices.
Recommendation for Separation
COMMAND ENFORCEMENT
A members command must recommend a member
Commands may use three methods to enforce equal for separation in cases of equal opportunity
opportunity: discrimination as well as misconduct.
1. Warning (counseling)
CONDUCT OF MAST
2. Nonjudicial punishment (NJP), commonly
called captains mast Nonjudicial punishment is better known in the Navy
3. Separation from the Navy as captains mast. The term derived from the early
sailing days when the usual setting for this type of naval
With warning being the lesser and separation the justice was held on the weather deck at the front of the
higher extreme. ships main mast.
Based on article 15 of the Uniform Code of Military
Warning (Counseling)
Justice (UCMJ), commanding officers may award
punishment for minor offenses without the intervention
Commands may use a variety of counseling
of a court-martial. They may award that punishment to
methods to instill in a subordinate the serious nature of both officer and enlisted members. The article likewise
the Navys equal opportunity program. The following empowers officers in charge to impose nonjudicial
are some of those methods, listed in the order of their punishment upon enlisted members assigned to the unit
severity: of which the officer is in charge. Similarly, the
1. Verbal counseling commander of a multiservice command, to whose

3-4
command members of the naval service are assigned, Reviewing the Report Chit
may designate one or more naval units for the purpose
of administering NJP. For each such unit, the Regardless of how the commission of a minor
commander must designate in writing a commissioned offense is brought to your attention, you will probably
naval officer as commanding officer for the need to prepare a rough NAVPERS 1626/7. (The legal
administration of discipline under article 15. In addition, office or administration office normally prepares the
a flag or general officer in command may delegate all or smooth.) Always address the report to the officer in
part of his or her powers under article 15 to a senior charge or the commanding officer of the accused. If the
officer on the staff. However, the senior officer must be offender has violated more than one article of the
eligible to succeed to command in the absence of the UCMJ, identify the separate offenses by Arabic
flag or general officer. In addition, those powers can numerals in the section entitled Details of the Offense.
only be delegated with the express approval of the Chief If the offender has violated a single article more than
of Naval Personnel or the Commandant of the Marine once, identify successive violations by Arabic numerals
Corps, as appropriate. Punishment must be imposed in parentheses. In each instance, be sure to give enough
within 2 years of the offense. If it is not imposed within details to describe the offense fully and give the UCMJ
that period the offender may not later be punished for article number violated. Use numerals in the blocks
the offense. marked Place of Offense(s) and Date of Offense(s) that
correspond to those used in identifying the offenses in
Details of Offense(s).
MAST PROCEDURES
List military witnesses to the offense in the order of
their seniority, followed by civilian witnesses, if any.
You can receive notification that someone has Include the command or address of all witnesses. If a
committed an offense in a variety of waysa shore patrol witness is attached to the same command as the
report a verbal complaint by a victim, or a local report offender, give only his or her division or department. If
chit, to name a few. Except when serious crimes are attached to another command, identify that command
involved, document charges on the Report and completely. Give civilian witnesses complete business
Disposition of Offense(s), NAVPERS 1626/7. Then and home addresses if available. Finally, be sure to
process the form in the manner prescribed by the form obtain the signature of the person placing the accused
itself. on report.
The NAVPERS 1626/7 is a one-sheet (back and
front) form. It serves several functions; among them are Reading of Rights
the following:
1. It reports the offense(s). The officer contemplating imposing NJP must
ensure the accused is fully advised concerning all legal
2. It records that the accused has been advised of rights associated with the possible imposition of NJP.
his or her rights under article 31. The accused must be advised within a reasonable time
3. It records any pre-mast restraint. of the report of an offense. Failure to advise the accused
properly may render any subsequent nonjudicial
4. It serves as a preliminary inquiry report.
punishment invalid.
5. It records the action of the executive officer The Judge Advocate General (JAG) Manual
(XO) at screening mast.
contains details concerning required premast advice to
6. It records that the accused has been advised of an accused. The advice must include the following as a
his or her rights to refuse NJP (if he or she has minimum:
the right under the circumstances of the case). 1. The offense(s) the accused is suspected of
7. It shows the action of the CO at mast. having committed
8. It records that the accuseds appeal rights have 2. That the commanding officer is contemplating
been explained. mast for the alleged offense(s)
Remember, however, that NAVPERS 1626/7 does 3. That, if the accused is not attached to or
not include all of the required premast advice you must embarked in a vessel, he or she has a right to
give the accused. demand court-martial in lieu of mast

3-5
4. That, if the accused will attend mast, he or she using someone as a witness who has no connection with
will receive a hearing at which time he or she the issuing of discipline would probably be a good
will be accorded the following rights: procedure.
a. To be present before the officer conducting
the hearing Premast Screenings

b. To have the rights of the accused under Before the commanding officer hears a persons
article 31 of the UCMJ explained to him or case, it is referred to an officer for a preliminary inquiry
her after which it will be screened by the executive officer
c. To be advised of the offense(s) of which he at executive officers investigation (XOI).
or she is suspected At small commands, cases will be referred almost
d. To be present at the presentation of all automatically to division officers for the preliminary
information against him or her either by inquiry. At large commands, the disciplinary officer or
testimony of a witness or by the receipt of the legal officer will be delegated authority to appoint
copies of the witnesss written statement(s) the preliminary inquiry officer (PIO). The job of the PIO
is not to develop a case against the accused. Rather, the
e. To have available for his or her inspection all PIO must collect all available facts concerning the
physical information or documentary offense itself and the background of the accused. The
evidence to be considered by the hearing PIO completes Section E of the NAVPERS 1626/7 as
officer follows:
f. To have full opportunity to present any 1. Inserts a short resume of the division officer's
matter in mitigation, extenuation, or defense opinion of the accused.
of the offense(s) of which he or she is
suspected 2. Lists the names of the witnesses whose presence
the PIO thinks is necessary to dispose of the case
g. To be accompanied at the hearing by a at mast.
personal representative (provided by the
accused) to speak in his or her behalf, who 3. Recommends disposition of the case.
may, but need not, be a lawyer 4. Summarizes the evidence that supports the
5. That, if punishment is imposed, the accused has recommendation.
the right of appeal The recommendation of the PIO is not binding. The
6. That, if the accused demands trial by commanding officer will evaluate each
court-martial, the charges against him or her recommendation separately.
may be referred to court-martial The XO may screen the case by holding an informal
No preset forms exist for the accused to use to hearing or may merely review the record of the accused
acknowledge receipt of the above premast advice. and the report chit. If given the power by the
However some commands may design their own forms commanding officer, the XO may dismiss the case, but
for local use. In addition, the first page of the NAVPERS may NEVER impose punishment.
1626/7 reflects acknowledgement of some of the above At XO's screening mast, the accused is advised
premast advice. For example, it contains a place for the again of the right to refuse NJP and to demand a trial by
accused to acknowledge he or she has been advised of court-martial. Article 15 does not give that right to
the nature of the offense(s) charged against him or her persons attached to vessels. The accused may elect not
and of his or her right to remain silent under article 3 lb. to be tried by court-martial at XO's mast, but then
In any event, when provisions are made for demand trial by court-martial at captains mast. The only
acknowledgment in writing by an accused of premast requirement is that the accused make the demand before
advice, the accused should acknowledge in writing, punishment is imposed. Case law requires that a suspect
when available, the receipt of premast advice and make be provided the opportunity to discuss with counsel the
sure someone witnesses the acknowledgement. If the legal consequences of accepting or refusing NJP. If he
accused refuses to sign an acknowledgment, have the or she is not provided that opportunity, the record of any
witness attest to the giving of the warnings and the punishment imposed will not be admissible in any
refusal of the accused to acknowledge. In such cases, subsequent court-martial proceeding.

3-6
Punishment However, the member may only be reduced one grade
as a result of a single mast appearance.
If the commanding officer is convinced by the
7. EXTRA DUTY -Extra duty means offenders
evidence that the accused is guilty of the offense and
must perform duties in addition to their normal duties.
deems punishment appropriate, article 15 provides wide
Only enlisted members may receive this type of
latitude. punishment. Extra duty normally may not exceed 2
The rank of the commanding officer and the status hours a day, after which offenders are granted
of the offender limit the type of punishment the CO can libertyunless, of course, their liberty has been
impose. However, under appropriate circumstances, the curtailed. Personnel may not perform extra duty on
commanding officer may impose nine types of Sundays, although Sundays count in the computation of
punishment: the number of days worked. However, they may perform
extra duty on holidays.
1. RESTRICTION -Restriction is the least severe
form of denying liberty. It involves moral rather than 8. FORFEITURE OF PAY A forfeiture of pay is
physical restraint. Generally, while restricted, the the permanent loss of entitlement to a specific amount
member will continue to perform his or her military of pay. Only basic pay, sea pay, or foreign duty pay is
duties but may be required to report to a specified place subject to forfeiture.
for muster during the period of restriction. The 9. DETENTION OF PAY A detention of pay is
commanding officer may restrict both officers and much less severe than the forfeiture, because the
enlisted members. member will get the detained money back at the end of
2. ARREST IN QUARTERS -Arrest in quarters the detention period. The detention period may not
also involves moral rather than physical restraint. An exceed 1 year and may not extend beyond the expiration
arrest in quarters restricts the offender to his or her living of the members current enlistment. Only sea pay,
quarters unless the restriction is specifically broadened. foreign duty pay, and basic pay may be detained. The
Although this punishment may require the offender to maximum amount subject to detention is computed in
perform certain duties, article 1020 of Navy Regulations the same fashion as that for a forfeiture.
prohibits that person from exercising military authority FINES. -A fine is not an authorized punishment at
over subordinates. Flag or general officers in command NJP and cannot be awarded.
or an officer exercising general court-martial (GCM)
EFFECTIVE DATES OF PUNISHMENTS. -As
authority may impose this type of punishment on
a general rule, punishments awarded at mast take effect
commissioned or warrant officers only.
immediately upon imposition, unless they are
3. CORRECTIONAL CUSTODY Correctional suspended, stayed, or otherwise deferred. An offender
custody is the physical restraint of persons during duty may receive a new nonjudicial punishment while
or nonduty hours, or both. It may be awarded only to serving a nonjudicial punishment of restraint. In such
nonrated persons. It could include extra duty, fatigue cases, the offender interrupts the original punishment of
duty, or hard labor. restraint to begin serving the new punishment. After the
4. CONFINEMENT ON BREAD AND completion of the new punishment, the person will
complete the remainder of the original punishment.
WATER -Confinement on bread and water may be
Before a second forfeiture or detention of pay may take
imposed only on nonrated personnel attached to or
effect, the offender must complete all previous
embarked in vessels. Maximum duration is 3 days.
forfeitures. Commanders may defer confinement on
5. ADMONITION AND REPRIMAND -The two bread and water or correctional custody for a period of
degrees of punitive censure, in their increasing order of up to 15 days if the needs of the naval service dictate
severity, are admonition and reprimand. The such deferment. For example, the commanding officer
commanding officer may impose punitive censure on may award a person confinement on bread and water
enlisted personnel either orally or in writing but must while the ship is at sea if the ship has no confinement
impose it on commissioned and warrant officers in facility. Therefore, the commanding officer may defer
writing. the sentence until an ashore confinement facility
becomes available, but not for more than 15 days.
6. REDUCTION IN GRADE A reduction in
grade, or bust, is considered the most severe form of APPEALS PROCEDURE. -A member awarded
NJP. It means a member may be reduced one grade. NJP who believes the punishment unjust or

3-7
disproportionate to the offense has the right to appeal marijuana, cocaine, amphetamines, barbiturates, FCP,
the award to higher authority. The member must submit and opiates. They tested each sample three times-twice
the appeal in writing and include the reasons he or she using radio immunoassay and once using highly specific
considers the punishment unjust or disproportionate. gas chromatography or mass spectrometry. These
Normally, members must submit the appeal to the area technical procedures are designed to protect the
coordinator having GCM authority. individual. They are standardized at all laboratories and
centrally monitored through a blind sample quality
Article 15 requires the appeal to be made
control program. Facilities using these procedures are
promptly, which means within 5 days of
subject to frequent inspections. These inspections are
impositionexcept under the most unusual
one part of the Navys care and expense in ensuring the
circumstances. Appeals not brought within this period
credibility of the urinalysis program.
may be rejected on that basis.

DRUG ABUSE EDUCATION


DRUG AND ALCOHOL ABUSE
Drug abuse is incompatible with naval service. It is The Navy emphasizes drug abuse prevention.
costly in lost man-hours and unnecessary administrative Education programs make up the largest segment of
and judicial processing and is a critical drawdown on prevention. General military training on drug abuse
morale and esprit de corps. It undermines the very fiber prevention and control is annually delivered to over
of combat readiness, safety, discipline, judgment, and 500,000 enlisted personnel. Other specific education
loyalty. For those reasons, the United States Navy has programs include the Navy Alcohol and Drug Safety
taken a zero tolerance stand on drug abuse. Zero Action Program (36 hours of prevention and remedial
tolerance is a compassionate policy that offers help to instruction) with an average annual attendance of
drug abusers who want help. However, it is also a tough 53,000. Supervisory personnel attend an 8-hour policy,
policy that separates from the naval service those who identification, and referral seminar. In addition to
defy authority through continued abuse. providing general drug abuse education to every person
in the Navy, the Navy trains its own command drug and
The Department of Defense authorizes the use of
alcohol program advisors, aftercare program
urinalysis for disciplinary purposes. Urinalysis has
coordinators, drug and alcohol counselors, and program
become the most valuable detection and deterrence tool managers.
used by the Navy. New technology enables wide-scale
testing for the use of drugs. Today, recruits are tested Results from the Department of Defense worldwide
within 48 hours of arrival at basic training. Those testing surveys of drug and alcohol use among military
positive for any drug other than marijuana (THC) are personnel have shown a gratifying decrease in the use
immediate y discharged. Those testing positive for THC of illicit drugs among naval personnel. Drug use among
are charged with a first drug offense, which is all personnel within the 30 days before each survey was
documented in their record. They are randomly retested reduced from 33% in 1980, to 16% in 1982, to 10% in
for the next 6 months; if found positive again, they are 1985.
discharged. The recruits are tested again as they report Because drug abuse is incompatible with naval
to their first technical school and then tested three times service, the Navy will always maintain its zero tolerance
annually throughout their naval service. Knowledge of stand and will continue to wage war on drugs.
the certainty of this testing and the severe personal and
career consequences for drug abuse act as a powerful
deterrent. TYPES OF DRUGS AND THEIR EFFECTS

The Navy has taken a firm stand against drug abuse.


This section describes different types of drugs and
It processes for immediate separation from service any
how they affect the user. There are medicinal drugs used
officer, chief petty officer, or petty officer identified as
to treat illness or to relieve pain. Without them there
a drug abuser or as drug dependent.
would be a lot of pain and suffering. These drugs include
The Navys five drug screening laboratories are aspirin, antihistamines, antacids, penicillins, and a
located at Norfolk, Virginia; Jacksonville, Florida; variety of others. Drugs have a definite purpose in our
Great Lakes, Illinois; Oakland, California; and San society especially when they are prescribed by
Diego, California. In fiscal year 1986, these laboratories physicians to cure illness. When used as prescribed by
tested close to 2 million urine samples for six drugs: physicians, drugs are legal.

3-8
Then there are illicit drugs, DRUGS PROHIBITED of cotton, syringes, eyedroppers, and hypodermic
BY LAW. Illicit drugs and some legal dregs normally needles. Abusers use them all in the injection process.
available only by a doctors prescription are Spoons or bottle caps hold the narcotic in a little water
manufactured by unscrupulous individuals for sale to for heating over a match or lighter; cotton falters the
underground buyers. These drugs are usually inferior narcotic as it is drawn through the needle into a syringe
products prepared in unsanitary laboratories for future or an eyedropper. Abusers usually keep the used cotton
marketing on our nations streets. because it retains a small amount of the narcotic. They
can then extract it if unable to obtain additional drugs.
Some types of drugs that are used legally and
You can easily identify a bent spoon or bottle cap used
illegally are narcotics, stimulants, depressants,
to heat the narcotic because it becomes blackened by the
hallucinogens, and deliriant. These drugs are described
heating process.
as follows:
Under federal law, some preparations containing
NARCOTICS. -Narcotic drugs include some of the
small amounts of narcotic drugs maybe sold without a
most valuable medicines known, as well as some of the
prescription; for example, cough mixtures containing
most abused. The term narcotics original] y referred to
codeine. Although these preparations are relatively free
opium and the drugs made from opium, such as heroin,
of addiction potential when used as directed, they have
codeine, and morphine. Opium is obtained from the
been abused.
opium poppy plant; morphine and codeine are extracted
from opium. Medical science has developed Opiates. -Natural and synthetic morphine-like
synthesized drugs, called opiates, that have properties drugs derived from opiates are the most effective pain
similar to heroin, codeine, or morphine. Those drugs are relievers known. Physicians often prescribe them for
also classified as narcotic drugs. short-term acute pain resulting from surgery, fractures,
burns, and the latter stages of terminal illnesses such as
A drug abuser under the influence of narcotics
cancer.
usually appears lethargic and drowsy or displays
symptoms of deep intoxication. The pupils of the eyes Since opiates depress the central nervous system,
are often constricted and fail to respond to light. they produce a marked reduction in sensitivity to pain,
create drowsiness, and reduce physical activity. Side
Some abusers may drink paregoric or cough
effects can include nausea and vomiting, constipation,
medicines containing narcotics. The persons breath
itching, flushing, constriction of pupils, and respiratory
often has the medicinal odor of these preparations. Other
depression.
beginner narcotic abusers inhale narcotic drugs, such
as heroin. They sometimes have traces of this white Heroin. Heroin is a white or brown powder known
powder around their nostrils. Constant inhaling of to the addict as H, horse, caballo, white stuff, white lade,
narcotic drugs makes their nostrils red and raw. Harry, joy powder, doojee, sugar, stag, or smack. It
produces an intense euphoria resulting in an easing of
The drug addict usually injects narcotics directly
fears and relief from worry; however, a state of
into a vein. The most common site of the injection is the
inactivity bordering on stupor often follows. Since
inner surface of the arm at the elbow. After repeated
abusers rapidly develop a tolerance for the drug, they
injections, scar tissue (tracks) develops along the veins.
must ingest increasingly large quantities to get a kick.
Because of the easy identification of these marks,
narcotic abusers usually wear long sleeves at odd times. Abusers ingest heroin in a variety of ways, including
Females sometimes use makeup to cover the marks. sniffing (snorting), smoking, or injecting it into a vein
Some males get tattooed at injection sites. Abusers who (mainlining) or just under the skin (joy popping). The
inject narcotics under unsterile conditions often get latter two methods require the abuser to liquify the
blood poisoning. They often contract diseases such as powder before using it.
hepatitis and acquired immune deficiency syndrome
Heroin is manufactured from morphine and, weight
(AIDS) and tropical diseases such as malaria.
for weight, is up to 10 times more potent than morphine.
Those who inject drugs must keep the equipment Users cut or dilute pure heroin with other substances
they used to inject the drugs handy. Therefore, they may such as milk sugar (lactose) or quinine, or both. The drug
hide the equipment on themselves or in a place where sold to the addict as heroin usually contains one part
they will have temporary privacy, such as a nearby heroin plus nine parts or more of other substances. Since
locker or washroom. Some commonly used instruments those other substances are quite often toxic to the human
and accessories are bent spoons, bottle caps, small balls system, they can result in the death of the user.

3-9
Morphine. -For many years morphine was the drug Crack. -Crack is a relatively new form of cocaine.
of choice for the relief of pain. The street addict calls it Crack is a street cocaine mixed with baking soda and
white stuff, M, hard stuff, morpho, untie, and Miss water to remove impurities. It is about 50 to 60 percent
Emma. Addicts use it when they have difficulty getting pure, while street cocaine is 20 to 40 percent pure. Users
heroin. Small doses produce euphoria. The bodys can smoke crack without the fire hazard involved in
tolerance for the drug and physical dependence on it free-basing. Crack produces a feeling of euphoria more
build rapidly. quickly and with more intensity than cocaine snorted
into the nasal passages. The high comes in 4 to 6 seconds
Codeine. -More commonly abused in the form of
versus 6 to 8 minutes from snorting.
cough preparations, codeine is less addictive than
morphine or heroin. It is also less potent in inducing Crack causes blood vessels to constrict and the heart
euphoria. When withdrawal symptoms occur, they are rate to rapidly increase, which leads to high blood
less severe than with more potent drugs. pressure. Those changes can cause the heart or arteries
to burst and can cause massive heart attacks.
Methadone. Methadone was invented by German
chemists in 1941 when the supply of morphine to In the brain, crack triggers the release of
Germany ran low. It has many properties similar to those neurotransmitters, causing the euphoric effect. Cocaine
of morphine-it relieves pain and produces physical and blocks the reuse of the neurotransmitters by the brain,
psychological dependence. Methadone has one major thus leaving the brain in a depressed state. The more a
difference from morphine and heroinwhen methadone person gets high, the more their supply of
is taken orally, under medical supervision, it prevents neurotransmitters is depleted, and the deeper the
withdrawal symptoms for approximately 24 hours. depression that follows the euphoria. That rapidly
progresses to a psychological dependence on the drug
STIMULANTS. -Stimulants are drugs that
just for the person to feel normal.
stimulate the central nervous system. The most widely
known stimulant in this country is caffeine, an One reaction to crack is called excited delirium. In
ingredient of coffee, tea, cola, and other beverages. this state, a person becomes paranoid and starts shouting
Since the effects of caffeine are relatively mild, its use and thrashing. The person also becomes violent, with
is socially acceptable and not an abuse problem. unexpected strength, often breaking mirrors, glass, and
However, the use of the more potent synthetic stimulants other objects. The pupils in the eyes dilate. The body
such as amphetamines, methyl phenidate, and also undergoes hyperthermia (overheating), causing the
phenmetrazine can result in abuse problems. Stimulants person to disrobe to cool off. Such episodes last about
produce excitation, increased activity, and an ability to an hour. Sudden tranquility or a transition to a depressed
go without sleep for extended periods. state may follow, which can lead to respiratory arrest
followed by death.
The main trait of stimulant abusers is excessive
activity. They are irritable and argumentative, appear Amphetamines. Amphetamines are often called
extremely nervous, and have difficulty sitting. In some uppers or pep pills. Amphetamine and
cases, the pupils of their eyes will be dilated even in a methamphetamine drugs provide help for various
brightly lit place. disorders. They help overweight patients reduce their
appetites and provide relief for patients with narcolepsy,
Stimulant abusers often go for long periods without
a disorder characterized by an overwhelming need for
sleeping or eating and usually cannot resist letting others
sleep. They also benefit selected patients with
know about it.
aggressive psychiatric or neurological disorders.
Cocaine. -Cocaine is a white or colorless crystalline
Amphetamines have a drying effect on the mucous
powder. Persons who abuse cocaine either inhale the
membranes of the mouth and nose and cause bad breath
powder or inject it directly into the bloodstream. It can
that is unidentifiable as to a specific odor such as onion,
induce euphoria, excitation, anxiety, a sense of
garlic, or alcohol. Because of the dryness of mouth,
increased muscular strength, and talkativeness; it can
amphetamine abusers lick their lips to keep them moist.
also reduce the feeling of fatigue. It causes the pupils to
That often results in chapped and reddened lips, which,
become dilated and the heart rate and blood pressure to
in severe cases, may become cracked and raw.
increase. In larger doses, cocaine can produce fever,
vomiting, convulsions, hallucinations, and paranoid Abusers may rub and scratch their nose vigorously
delusions. An overdose can depress the heart and and frequently to relieve the itching sensation caused by
breathing functions so much that death results. dryness of the mucous membrane in the nose. They often

3-10
talk incessantly about any subject at hand and often hallucinogens. Although openly and irresponsibly
chain-smoke. promoted as a means of expanding consciousness,
hallucinogens have yet to be proved valuable medically.
Because the body develops a tolerance to
amphetamines, abusers must increase their dosages to Hence, neither standard dosage forms nor markings
obtain the psychic effects they desire. Tolerance to all exist that make visual identification possible.
the effects does not develop uniformly. Even a tolerant Illicit labs produce hallucinogens in the form of
abuser can experience high blood pressure, abnormal capsules, tablets, powders, or liquids; peddlers and users
heart rhythms, loss of appetite, excitability, use many methods to transport or hide the drugs. For
talkativeness, trembling hands, enlarged pupils, heavy example, LSD has been found in sugar cubes, candy,
perspiration, and stereotypic compulsive behavior. In paper, aspirin, jewelry, liquor, cloth, and even on the
serious cases, a drug psychosis resembling paranoid back of postage stamps.
psychosis develops. In addition, violent behavior may
follow the use of amphetamines because of Persons who use hallucinogenic drugs (such as
unpredictable mood changes. LSD) are highly unlikely to do so while at work. They
usually use such drugs in a group situation under special
Amphetamines for medical purposes are available conditions designed to enhance their effect.
by prescription under a variety of trade names. They are Hallucinogens distort the users perception of objective
also manufactured in clandestine laboratories as reality. They produce illusions involving the various
crystalline powder, as tablets, and in a variety of liquid senses and, if taken in large doses, can produce
forms; they are then sold through illicit channels. hallucinations. Persons under the influence of
DEPRESSANTS. The drugs depress the central hallucinogens usually sit or recline quietly in a
nervous system. Abusers of depressants, such as trance-like state. On occasion, users become fearful and
barbiturates and certain tranquilizers, exhibit most of the experience a degree of terror that may cause them to
symptoms of alcohol intoxication with one important attempt to escape from the group situation. An important
exception: no odor of alcohol is detected on their breath. point to remember is that the effects of LSD may recur
Depressant abusers may stagger or stumble and days, or even months, after someone has taken it.
frequently fall into a deep sleep. In general, depressant
The effects of hallucinogens are not solely related
abusers lack interest in activity, are drowsy, and may
appear to be disoriented. to the drug. They are modified by the mood, mental
attitude, and environment of the user. Hallucinogens
Since depressants depress the central nervous usually distort or intensify the sense of perception and
system, they are prescribed in small doses to reduce lessen the users ability to discriminate between fact and
restlessness and emotional tension and to induce sleep. fantasy. Users may speak of seeing sounds and
Some are valuable in the treatment of certain types of hearing colors. Their judgment of direction and
epilepsy. distance is generally out of proportion. Their pupils
Continued and excessive dosages of depressants dilate and their eyes become extremely sensitive to light.
result in slurred speech, faulty judgment, a quick temper, They commonly experience restlessness and
and a quarrelsome disposition. Overdoses, particularly sleeplessness until the drug wears off. The drugs have
when taken in conjunction with alcohol, result in an unpredictable mental effect on persons each time they
unconsciousness and death unless the user receives take them. As with stimulants and depressants, the user
proper medical treatment. of hallucinogens may develop a psychological
Therapeutic doses cause minimal amounts of dependence. However, unlike depressants,
psychological dependence, whereas excessive doses hallucinogens have not been shown to produce a
taken over a period of time result in both physical and physical dependence.
psychological dependence. Abrupt withdrawal, VOLATILE CHEMICALS. -The volatile
particularly from barbiturates, can produce convulsions. chemicals include model airplane glue, lacquer thinner,
Depressants are exceedingly dangerous. gasoline, fingernail polish remover, and lighter fluid.
HALLUCINOGENS. -Hallucinogens are The substances contain xylol, creosol, naphtha, benzol,
chemicals extracted from plants or synthesized in tetraethyl lead, and other chemicals that can cause
laboratories. LSD, mescaline, psilocybin and psilocin, severe damage to the body by attacking the oxygen
and PCP (phencyclidine) are all examples of level.

3-11
Abusers usually retain the odor of the substance that an odor similar to that of burnt rope. You can readily
they have inhaled on their breath and in their clothes. detect the odor on the persons breath and clothing.
Irritation of the mucous membranes in the mouth and
When smoked, marijuana appears to enter the
nose may result in excessive nasal secretions. Redness
bloodstream quickly because the onset of symptoms is
and watering of the eyes commonly occur. The user may
rapid. It affects the users mood and thinking. The
appear intoxicated or lack muscular control and may
effects of the drug on the emotions and senses vary
complain of double vision, ringing in the ears, vivid widely, depending on the amount and strength of the
dreams, and even hallucinations. Drowsiness, stupor, marijuana used. The social setting in which it is taken
and unconsciousness may follow excessive use of the
and the effects anticipated by the user also influence the
substance.
persons reaction to the drug.
Abusers usually inhale these drugs from the
You probably will not recognize marijuana (pot)
container or from plastic or paper bags. Therefore,
users unless they are heavily under the influence. In
discovery of plastic or paper bags or handkerchiefs
early stages, when the drug acts as a stimulant, users
containing dried plastic cement is a telltale sign of this may be very animated and appear almost hysterical.
form of drug abuse.
They commonly talk loudly and rapidly and easily burst
MARIJUANA. Marijuana is a greenish, into laughter.
tobacco-like material consisting of the leaves, flowers,
Usually, the effects of the drug start about 15
small stems, and seeds of the plant Cannabis Sativa L,
minutes after the person inhales the smoke of the
which grows throughout the world. Its fibers have been
cigarette. The effects can last from 2 to 4 hours. At low
used to manufacture twine, rope, bags, clothing, and
doses of one or two cigarettes, persons who become
paper. The sterilized seeds are used in various feed intoxicated may experience an increased sense of
mixtures, particularly bird seed. Traffic in, and use of,
well-being, initial restlessness, and hilarity. That stage
drugs from the cannabis plant are now restricted by law is followed by a dreamy, carefree state of relaxation and
in most countries, including the United States.
an alteration of sensory perceptions, including
Although known to exist for nearly 5,000 years, we expansion of space and time. Users also experience a
probably know less about marijuana than any other more vivid sense of touch, sight, smell, taste, and sound;
natural drug. In the past, it has been used in the treatment a feeling of hunger, especially a craving for sweets; and
of a variety of clinical disorders. Very early in Chinas subtle changes in thought formation and expression. To
history, it was used to relieve pain during surgery. In an unknowing observer, a person in this state of
India it was used as medicine; in the United States it was consciousness would not appear noticeably different
used as an analgesic, a poultice for corns, and a from a normal state.
component in a variety of patented medicines. At higher but moderate doses, the user experiences
You can identify marijuana smokers by their the same reactions experienced with the use of low
possession of such cigarettes, often called sticks, doses, only they are intensified. Still, you would
reefers, or joints. A marijuana cigarette is often rolled in scarcely notice the changes. The person may also
a double thickness of brownish or off-white cigarette experience altered thought formation and expression,
paper. Smaller than a regular cigarette, with the paper such as fragmented thoughts, sudden loss of ideas,
twisted or tucked in on both ends, the marijuana impaired immediate memory, disturbed associations,
cigarette often contains seeds and stems and is greener and an altered sense of self-identity. Some perceive a
in color than regular tobacco. feeling of enhanced insight. Such distortions can
produce feelings of panic and anxiety in those who have
Another clue to the presence of reefers is the way
little experience with drugs. The panic and anxiety can
in which they are often smoked. Typically, such smoking
occurs in a group situation. Because of the rapid burning cause persons to fear they are dying or going crazy. That
panic reaction usually disappears as the effects of the
and harshness of the marijuana cigarette, it is generally
drug wear off. Low to moderate doses of the drug
passed rapidly, after one or two puffs, to another person.
produce minimal changes in body functions.
Users inhale the smoke deeply and hold it in the lungs
as long as possible. When inhaling, persons often cup At very high doses, effects may include distortions
the cigarette in the palms of both hands to save all the of body images, loss of personal identity, fantasies, and
smoke possible. An additional clue to marijuana use is hallucinations. In addition, toxic psychoses can occur

3-12
after extremely high doses. This state clears as the user become indifferent to their appearance and health
eliminates the drug from the body. habits.
A person under the influence of marijuana has a Other more specific signs should also arouse
harder time making decisions that require clear thinking; suspicion, especially if a person exhibits more than one
therefore, the user becomes more open to other people's of these signs. Among them is secretive behavior
suggestions. Since marijuana affects peoples reflexes regarding actions and possessions (fear of discovery).
and thinking, their performance of some tasks while For example, abusers may wear sunglasses at
under the influence of the drug is dangerous, such as inappropriate times and places to hide dilated or
driving. constricted pupils; they may also wear long-sleeve
garments, even on hot days, to hide needle marks. Of
ABUSER IDENTIFICATION course, when a person associates with known drug
abusers, that is a sign of potential trouble.
Drug abuse in its various forms can produce
identifiable effects. However, persons taking drugs Because of the expense of supporting a drug habit,
under a physicians instructions may sometimes abusers may try to borrow money from a number of
experience side effects that may be mistaken as signs of people. If they fail to get money that way, abusers will
drug abuse. For example, such disorders as epilepsy, often steal items, such as cameras, radios, or jewelry,
diabetes, or asthma may require maintenance drug that can easily be converted to cash.
therapy that will produce low-level side effects; or a Persons with a severe habit will use drugs while on
person might be drowsy from taking a nonprescription duty. In such cases, you may find them at odd times in
product, such as an antihistamine. Many people use places such as closets or storage rooms.
legitimate drugs following a physicians
instructionsbut without the knowledge of their Generally, drugs have indirect harmful effects.
associates. Therefore, finding tablets, capsules, or other Because abusers may not feel hungry, they often suffer
forms of drugs on a person suspected of being an abuser from malnutrition; and because they are so involved
does not necessarily mean the drugs are narcotics or with taking the drug, they usually neglect themselves.
some other dangerous drug. A clue to the possibility of They are more likely to contract infections because of
drug abuse comes with seeing the same symptoms over their poor nutrition and because they may inject
and over again. contaminated drugs intravenously. They are also likely
No instant tests exist for identification of most to use poor or unsterile injection techniques. That may
drugs. The only way many drugs can be identified is result in serious or fatal septicemia (blood-poisoning),
through a series of complicated laboratory procedures hepatitis, and abscesses at the point of injection as well
performed by a trained technician. Simple visual as in internal organs. Contaminated needles are also
inspection cannot be relied upon for drug identification. known to spread AIDS.
Many potent drugs that are misused arc identical in Although you may have difficulty recognizing drug
appearance to relatively harmless drugs-many of which abusers, you should take the steps needed to provide
people can easily get without a prescription. them with help when you realize they have a drug
Not all drug abuse-related character changes appear problem. Spotting drug abuse in its early stages (when
harmful in the initial stages. For example, a person who professional help can be effective) can result in the
is normally bored and sleepy may, while using rehabilitation of many potential hard-core addicts.
amphetamines, become more alert and thereby improve
performance. A nervous, high-strung person may, while Urinalysis Testing
using barbiturates, be more imperative and easier to
manage. Consequent y, you must not look only for The Navy has adopted the use of urinalysis testing
changes for the worse, but you must look for any sudden as a major means of detecting and deterring drug abuse.
changes in behavior. The cause could be drug abuse. The main objective of urinalysis testing programs is to
Signs that may suggest drug abuse include sudden detect and deter abuse. This ensures the continued
and dramatic changes in discipline and job performance, visibility of the commands drug abuse program. The
unusual degrees of activity or inactivity, and sudden term random sampling applies to any command
displays of emotion. Abusers may show significant urinalysis testing program in which the individuals to be
changes for the worse in personal appearance; they often tested are selected at random. All members, regardless

3-13
of rank or age, are subject to participation in the them to become involved in constructive activities such
urinalysis testing program. as volunteer work, sports, clubs, divisional outings,
The urinalysis program uses a system of divisional tours, off-duty education, community service
biochemical testing of urine samples to achieve the activities, part-time jobs, and hobbies.
following: For nonusers who have never used drugs or who
1. Establish a valid and reliable means for the have merely experimented with them, drug abuse
detection of drug abuse education can highlight valid reasons for not using
drugs. This type of education also offers alternative
2. Serve as a strong deterrent against drug abuse
ways of achieving satisfaction. Use the basic alternative
3. Monitor the status of personnel in drug and appeal to turn on to life.
alcohol abuse rehabilitation programs
One former user who is a recognized antidrug
4. Provide statistical data on the prevalence and authority suggests four basic steps in dealing with
demographics of drug abuse people who already may be using drugs regularly:

Drug Detection Dogs 1. Develop a sympathetic and an honest attitude.


2. Provide accurate information.
Commands can request, through the security
department, the use of drug detection dog (DDD) teams 3. Provide information from sources that are
to help identify drug abusers. Dogs are effective, and the credible to the user, such as ex-users.
possibility of their repeated use increases their 4. Give people alternatives to the use of drugs.
effectiveness as a deterrent. The only persons needing
prior knowledge of a DDD inspection or an authorized The young member, particularly on board ship, may
search are the commanding officer and the dog handler. need special counseling. When members walk up the
DDDs may conduct inspections anywhere under naval gangplank upon reporting for duty, they are
jurisdiction at any time. apprehensive and have a strong desire to be accepted.
They may alter their beliefs and actions in an effort to
Dogs are trained to inspect for controlled substances be accepted by their peers, even if acceptance includes
and will not harm humans unless provoked. No matter
using drugs.
how effective a dog-and-handler team is in detecting
drugs, the physical presence of the team alone is often You can control this situation and eliminate many
the best deterrent to drug abuse. Abusers can seldom fool of the problems that may occur by providing proper
dogs; they rarely succeed in their efforts to mask the guidance at this crucial time. When you receive new
trace odors the dogs are capable of detecting. members in your division, assign one of your most
competent division personnel to help them adapt to their
DRUG ABUSE PREVENTION new environment. That person will encourage and guide
the young members to develop acceptable values and
Today, the basic approach to drug abuse prevention specific goals.
calls for understanding that goes beyond information
about drugs. You need to understand people, their
ALCOHOL ABUSE
feelings, their needs, their goals, and their reasons for
taking drugs. You also need to understand the effects of
a family or group situation upon human behavior. Alcohol is the number one drug problem in the
Showing people you care about them is the most United States today. The leading causes of death for the
important tool of all for preventing the abuse of drugs. 17- to 25-year age group are alcohol-related driving
accidents, suicides, and homicides. About 55 percent of
Learn how to recognize the potential drug abuser all fatal auto accidents are alcohol related, and 60
and the situations that might contribute to a persons percent of all motorcycle deaths involve alcohol.
choice to abuse drugs. Offer the abuser or potential
abuser alternatives to drugs. Help your people to Historically, alcohol has had widespread use in our
develop attitudes and value that oppose the acceptance society. Throughout history, alcoholic drinks have been
of drug abuse. Help them to see that drugs provide only used with meals, at social gatherings, in religious
transitory, counterfeit experiences that can never change ceremonies, and at celebrations. Alcohol does have
the real world, but constructive activity can. Encourage some acceptable uses, but it also can be abused.

3-14
Small amounts of alcohol produce a feeIing of required. In each case, the appropriate action will
well-being and light headedness. However, since depend upon the facts and circumstances.
alcohol is a depressant that slows down the central
The Navy recognizes. that society has often
nervous system, those good feelings quickly wear off.
associated a stigma with alcoholism that has little basis
Large amounts of alcohol over a long period of time
in fact and is counterproductive to successful
cause anxiety. Just as with other dangerous drugs,
rehabilitation. The effects of this stigma have reinforced
alcohol may cause physical and psychological
the alcoholics or alcohol abusers denial of any
dependence. This dependence is an illness called
problem. The effects of this stigma have also
alcoholism.
encouraged supervisory and medical personnel to cover
The Navys age-old problem with alcohol is up in an attempt to protect the members career. To bring
epitomized in the lyrics of an old drinking song, What the alcohol problem into the open where it can be
do you do with a drunken sailor? Until the last few treated, the Navy must reduce the effects of the stigma
years, the answer was, You let him go down the hatch to the minimum.
or down the tubes. For a long time we have contributed
Members who have undergo successful alcohol
to the career demise of the alcohol abuser because of our
treatment and recovery have the same job security and
own traditional involvement in alcohol use. We have not
opportunities for continued service and promotion as
accepted the evidence that alcohol, although legal, is a
other Navy members. However, any misconduct,
drug that some people cannot handle. Until recently,
misbehavior, or reduction in performance caused by
alcoholism was considered a disciplinary or
alcohol will affect performance evaluations, duty
administrative problem, which, if unresolved, could
assignments, continued service, job security, and
only lead to a discharge from the Navy.
promotion opportunity.
Because alcohol abuse involves the family of the
Navy Policy Regarding Alcoholism abuser, the Navy encourages the development of
programs and activities that contribute to a healthy
Various SECNAV and OPNAV instructions set forth family life. The Navy also encourages the development
Navy policy regarding alcoholism. Alcohol and Drug of programs to help restore to a healthy state those
Abuse Prevention and Control OPNAVINST 5350.4B, families who are suffering from the effects of
provides the Navys policy on drug and alcohol abuse. alcoholism. Immediate members of the family of the
The Navy Alcohol and Drug Abuse Program (NADAP) alcohol-dependent person may receive those
uses this instruction as a guide. rehabilitation services available at their command.

The Navy acknowledges its responsibility for Persons must make their own decision to use or not
counseling all members regarding the dangers of to use alcoholic beverages lawfully. Department of the
alcohol by providing information to help alcoholics Navy policy toward alcohol consists of three courses of
recover. The Navy meets its responsibility by providing action. The first is to promote responsible attitudes about
alcoholism treatment centers and specialized alcohol in those who choose to drink. The second is to
counseling. You share the responsibility of assisting the promote the social acceptance of those who choose not
command in referring those who are alcoholic to to drink. The third is to provide both drinkers and
treatment facilities. nondrinkers with realistic information about alcohol and
alcoholism.
Military members are responsible for their own
drinking habits; if they believe they have an alcohol
problem, they are responsible for seeking treatment. Understanding Alcohol and Its Effects
Each member remains accountable for any deterioration
of performance caused by his or her own alcoholism. Surprisingly, many experienced drinkers are
relatively ignorant of the way their favorite beverages
Firmly maintain and affirm the Navys drug and
affect them, for better or worse. The same applies to their
alcohol abuse policies as they relate to standards of
nondrinking families and friends who may be concerned
behavior, performance, and discipline. Do not consider
about why drinkers behave as they do.
alcoholism, in itself, as grounds for disciplinary action;
however, do evaluate a members demonstrated conduct Until recent years, when drinking problems forced
resulting from the use or abuse of alcohol. Then, if public concern, little factual alcohol- and health-related
needed, take disciplinary or administrative action as information was available. Although people could find

3-15
a library of information on how to mix exotic drinks, carefree. The person feels a release from many ordinary
they could find little about what happens after the tensions and inhibitions; in other words, the person
drinking starts. loosens up. Most people drink in moderation mainly to
The person who wants to drink responsible y must achieve this relaxed state.
know the short-term and long-term effects of alcohol on As more alcohol enters the blood, the depressant
the body. Those who want to understand the social action of alcohol involves more functions of the brain.
custom of drinking, problem drinking, and alcoholism At a level of 0.10 percent (1 part to 1,000), voluntary
must also know these effects. motor actions-hand and arm movements, walking, and
SHORT-TERM EFFECTS. Most people drink sometimes speech-become clumsy.
alcoholic beverages to get feelings of pleasure as well A level of 0.20 percent (1 part to 500) measurably
as to relieve tension. No doubt that is the reason for the impairs the controls of the entire motor area of the brain
popularity of alcohol as a social beverage. Drinking has as well as that part of the brain that guides emotional
become such a familiar part of our society that we do behavior. At this stage the person will stagger and may
not think of alcohol as a drug. However, it is as much a want to lie down. The person may also become easily
drug as one prescribed in carefully regulated dosages by angered, may become boisterous, or may weep. The
a physician.
person is drunk.
Alcohol affects the whole body through the central
A concentration of 0.30 percent (1 part to 300) dulls
nervous systemthe brain. Alcohol does not act directly
the persons response to stimulus and understanding
on the tongue or legs to cause the familiar signs of
controlled by the deeper areas of the brain. At this level
slurred speech and an unsteady gait connected with
a person may be confused or may lapse into a stupor.
drunkenness. Instead, it affects the parts of the brain that
Although aware of surrounding sights and sounds, the
control those parts of the body.
person has poor understanding of what he or she sees or
Alcohol can act as a stimulant at low doses and as a hears.
brain depressant at higher doses. The speed with which
alcohol brings on drunkenness and drunken behavior With 0.40 to 0.50 percent alcohol in the blood (1
depends upon the rate of its absorption into the part to 250 or 200), the person becomes unconscious and
bloodstream and a person's tolerance for alcohol. may go into a coma. Still higher levels of alcohol block
the center portions of the lower brain that control
Although the body must digest food before it can breathing and heartbeat, causing death to occur.
enter the bloodstream, it does not have to digest alcohol.
Alcohol immediately passes directly through the wall of This progression of effects is not unique to alcohol.
the stomach and small intestines into the bloodstream. Other hypnotic-sedative drugs, such as barbiturates,
Then the blood rapidly carries it to the brain. ether, and chloral hydrate, can also produce this
progression of effects.
Even the first few sips of an alcoholic beverage may
cause changes in mood and behavior. These changes Blood-alcohol levels have important legal
may be influenced by what the person has learned to implications. In most states, a person with a
expect from previous drink experiences. blood-alcohol level of 0.05 percent or less is legally
presumed sober and in condition to drive a motor
Alcohol is metabolized (burned and broken down)
in the body at a fairly constant rate. As a person drinks vehicle. However, in some states, a person with a level
faster than the alcohol can be burned, the drug of 0.10 percent or 0.08 percent is legally presumed
accumulates in the body. That results in higher and intoxicated or under the influence; in others, the
higher levels of alcohol in the blood. 0.15-percent level means legal impairment.

BLOOD-ALCOHOL LEVELS AND CHRONIC HEAVY DRINKING. Drinking large


BEHAVIOR. The first consistent changes in mood and amounts of alcohol for an extended length of time
behavior appear at blood-alcohol levels of reduces the brains sensitivity to the alcohol. Therefore,
approximately 0.05 percent; that is, 1 part alcohol to a person must drink greater amounts of alcohol to feel
2,000 parts blood. That level would result if a 150-pound its effects. This change in the sensitivity of the brain is
person took two drinks in succession. A blood-alcohol called tolerance. Increased tolerance is a symptom of all
level of 0.05 percent can affect a persons thought, chronic users of addictive drugs and is believed to be the
judgment, and restraint and cause the person to feel basis of addiction or dependence.

3-16
Since alcohol-dependent persons have an increased metabolismthe way our bodies chemically process
tolerance for alcohol, they react differently than what we consume.
moderate or heavy drinkers to the effects of alcohol. If drugs were not metabolized within the body, their
They can drink large quantities of alcohol without losing effect would continue for the remainder of a persons
control of their actions, while the moderate or heavy life. In the metabolic process, our bodies transform
drinker cannot. Instead of becoming more pleasant and drugs into other substances and eventually eliminate
relaxed as do the moderate or heavy drinkers, alcoholics them through normal bodily functions. The more rapid
may become progressively more tense and anxious the rate of metabolism, the lower the impact of the drug.
while drinking. They may accurately perform complex When drugs are forced to compete with alcohol for
tasks at blood-alcohol levels several times as great as processing by the body, alcohol is metabolized first; the
those that would incapacitate moderate to heavy other drug then remains active in the blood for an
drinkers. At one stage of their alcoholism, they may extended time. As a result, the effect of the drug on the
drink a fifth of whiskey a day without showing signs of body is exaggerated since its metabolism is slowed
drunkenness. Later, in the chronic stage, their tolerance down by the bodys tendency to take care of the alcohol
decreases to the point that they may become drunk on first. When added to the normal depressant consequence
relatively small amounts of alcohol. of alcohol, further depression of the nervous system,
Alcoholics also differ from moderate to heavy which regulates vital body functions, occurs. That
drinkers in their reactions to the abrupt removal of serious condition can result in death.
alcohol. The normal drinker may only experience the Although anyones body metabolizes drugs more
prosing misery of the hangover. Alcoholics may suffer slowly when the blood contains alcohol, the alcoholics
severe mental and bodily distress, such as severe [or heavy drinkers] body metabolizes drugs more
trembling, hallucinations, confusion, convulsions, rapidly during sober periods. Therefore, heavy drinkers
delirium (the alcohol withdrawal syndrome), and commonly take even larger doses of drugs. The usual
delirium tremens. Both the alcohol withdrawal quantities taken by nondrinkers or moderate drinkers
syndrome and delirium tremens involve shaking, would have little effect on the heavy drinker. The results
sweating, nausea, and anxiety. However, delirium of taking large doses of drugs and then drinking can
tremens can cause death. The average person would place these persons in even greater jeopardy; the results
have difficulty distinguishing between the alcohol can be fatal.
withdrawal syndrome and the delirium tremens. Both
require immediate medical attention. LONG-TERM EFFECTS. Drinking alcohol in
moderation apparently does the body little permanent
At present, no one knows the reason for the harm. But when taken in large doses over long periods,
increased tolerance of the alcohol-dependent person to alcohol can prove disastrous; it can reduce both the
alcohol. At one time tolerance levels were thought to quality and length of life. Damage to the heart, brain,
depend on differences in peoples rates of alcohol liver, and other major organs may result.
metabolism. However, overall rates of alcohol
metabolism were later found not to differ much in Prolonged heavy drinking has long been known to
normal drinkers and alcoholics. That fact indicated be connected with various types of muscle diseases and
changes in tolerance levels must occur in the brain rather tremors. One essential muscle affected by alcohol is the
than in the liver. heart. Some recent research suggests that alcohol may
be toxic to the heart and to the lungs as well. Liver
DRUG INTERACTIONS WITH ALCOHOL.
damage especially may result from heavy drinking.
Alcohol works on the same brain areas as some other
Cirrhosis of the liver occurs about eight times more
drugs. Drinking alcohol within a short time before or often among alcoholics as among nonalcoholics.
after t aking those drugs can multipl y the normal effects
of either the drug or the alcohol taken alone. For Heavy drinkers have long been known to have
example, alcohol and barbiturates taken in combination lowered resistance to pneumonia and other infectious
increase the effects of each other on the central nervous diseases, usually because of malnutrition. However,
system, which can be particularly dangerous. Alcohol recent research showing well-nourished heavy drinkers
taken in combination with any drug that has a depressant may also have lowered resistance indicates that alcohol
effect on the central nervous system is likewise directly interferes with the immunity system. People
dangerous. These dangerous reactions are the result of with blood-alcohol levels of 0.15 to 0.25 percent have a

3-17
reduced white blood cell mobilization as great as that in drinking. Some heavy drinkers experience blackouts.
people suffering from severe shock. During a blackout, drinkers do not pass out (or become
unconscious) but are able to walk, talk, and perform
Heavy drinking over many years may result in
other actions. However, afterwards they have no
serious mental disorders or permanent, irreversible
memory of that period. Such blackouts may be one of
damage to the brain or peripheral nervous system. It can
the early signs of the more serious form of alcoholism.
severely diminish mental functions, such as memory,
judgment, and learning ability, as well as a persons At present no definition of alcoholism satisfies all;
personality structure and grasp on reality. however, the following one is widely accepted:

PROBLEM DRINKING AND ALCOHOLISM Alcoholism is a chronic disease, or disorder of


behavior, characterized by the repeated
A nationwide survey of American drinking drinking of alcoholic beverages to an extent that
practices showed that more than two-thirds of the adult exceeds compliance with the social drinking
population drink alcoholic beverages at least customs of the community and which interferes
occasionally. Adding the number of younger drinkers to with the drinkers health, interpersonal
that population gives a total of about 100 million people relations, or economic functioning.
who drink. The overwhelming majority of those who
drink do so responsibly. But what of the others, far too OPNAVINST 5350.4B defines alcoholism as a
many, whose drinking gets out of hand and endangers disease characterized by psychological and/or
others and themselves? physical/physiological dependence on alcohol.

Distinctions are sometimes made between people That instruction defines alcohol abuse as the use of
with drinking problems and those suffering from alcohol to an extent that it has an adverse effect on the
alcoholism-alcoholic persons being considered the users health or behavior, family, community, or the
more uncontrollable group. However, since Navy, or leads to unacceptable behavior as evidenced by
distinguishing between the two is difficult, we seldom one or more alcohol-induced incidents.
use hard-and-fast labels. Whichever definition you agree with, you will find
Society usually labels persons as problem drinkers that all alcoholics have one trait in common: they are
when they drink to such an excess that they lose the alcohol dependent.
ability to control their actions and maintain a socially
acceptable lifestyle. One authority describes problem Diagnosing Alcoholism
drinkers as follows:
Those who could refer people for help with alcohol
1. Anyone who must drink to function or cope with problems often dont recognize the symptoms until the
life illness is in its advanced stages. By that time the disease
2. Persons who, by their own personal definition or may have advanced to the point that victims are unable
that of their family and friends, frequently drink to control their drinking. They may no longer have an
to a state of intoxication established family life or may be unable to hold a job.
In addition, the alcohol may have caused malnutrition
3. Anyone who goes to work intoxicated
or organic damage.
4. Anyone who drives a car while intoxicated
Unfortunately, no simple diagnostic procedure
5. Anyone who sustains bodily injury requiring exists for detecting alcoholism. Some of the factors
medical attention as a consequence of an involved in diagnosing an alcoholic person include the
intoxicated state following:
6. Persons who, under the influence of alcohol, do 1. The quantity of alcohol consumed. However,
something they contend they would never do quantity alone is an insufficient measure.
without alcohol
2. The rate of consumption. One pint of distilled
Other warning signs also indicate problem drinking. spirits consumed during a 10-hour period causes
They include a persons need (to drink before facing different behavior than that caused by a pint consumed
certain situations, frequent drinking sprees, a steady in 1 hour. Drunkenness depends on the rate of
increase in intake, solitary drinking, and early morning consumption as well as the quantity consumed.

3-18
practices and customs that encourage personnel to drink. Level I. Local command programs. These
Old naval customs encouraged members to drink programs consist of both prevention and intervention
excessive quantities of alcohol as a badge of courage or efforts. The programs involve discipline, inspections,
a mark of respect. Those customs also encouraged awareness education, leadership by positive role
young sailors to engage in that practice to prove their modeling, administrative screening, referral, and
adulthood and virility. Todays Navy tries to develop medical identification and intervention. The Navy
customs contrary to those beliefs. It recognizes that an Alcohol and Drug Safety Action Program (NADSAP)
increasing tolerance for alcohol in large amounts is a is available at some local commands.
positive symptom of alcoholism. Consequently,
Level II. Counseling and Assistance Center
commands should emphasize drinking in moderation at
(CAAC) programs. This level of therapeutic
such functions as ships parties and picnics,
nonresidential counseling and referral is designed for
advancement celebrations, initiations, hail and fare well
those personnel whose degree of abuse or denial
parties, and graduations. Commands should ensure
requires attention beyond the capacity of Level I
functions that serve alcoholic beverages also offer
programs. This level maybe used for referral of persons
nonalcoholic and low-calorie beverages for those who
to Level III and for persons waiting for space at a Level
choose not to drink. Educational programs, as well as
III facility. The length of the program at Level II is
leadership and example set by officers and petty
determined by the members commanding officer after
officers, are essential to changing attitudes about alcohol
recommendation from the local counseling staff. The
consumption.
maximum time allotted to a Level II counseling
program, however, will not exceed 4 weeks in length.
Helping Resources for Drug and Alcohol Programs at this level consist of clinical screening and
Problems referral at all program levels; therapeutic nonresidential
counseling; outreach assistance; and education.
Specialized alcoholism clinics and programs reach Level III. Residential rehabilitation programs.
some of those in need of help. However, many more Residential rehabilitation is designed for those members
people with alcohol problems are already in contact with who have been formally evaluated and diagnosed as
other agencies. Although those agencies are not alcohol dependent and who require rehabilitation on a
primarily devoted to caring for alcoholics, they do or full-time, live-in basis. They must, in the opinion of their
could offer important services to these persons. These commanding officers, show potential for continued
agencies include hospitals, welfare agencies, family and naval service. Four Navy alcohol rehabilitation centers
community services, legal aid, employment, and other (NAVALREHCENs) and 27 naval hospital alcohol
care-giving service organizations. General hospitals, for rehabilitation departments (ARDs) provide Level III
example, admit many alcoholics for conditions care. Residential rehabilitation involves a
unrelated to alcoholism-or for alcohol-related problems multidisciplinary therapeutic approach that normally
covered by other diagnoses. Similarly, many patients in lasts 6 weeks.
tuberculosis hospitals have alcohol problems. The
prison system holds many men and women with In general, persons may take part in Level I and II
drinking problems. An estimated 10 to 25 percent of programs on more than one occasion, as long as they
welfare cases involve alcoholism. meet the basic criteria for admittance. However, they
normally have only one opportunity per Navy career to
Recognition of the alcoholism problems of patients,
take part in the Level III program. Sometimes the Navy
clients, and inmates and referral to treatment resources may have a great investment in a person who has a
would bring help to many more who need it. relapse. In those cases, the commanding officer may
DEPARTMENT OF THE NAVY recommend the person for a second period in the Level
PROGRAMS. The Navy recognizes that drug and III program, not to exceed 3 weeks.
alcohol abuse is preventable and treatable through For personnel to complete recovery following
education, identification, counseling, and rehabilitation residential treatment, the Level II program recommends
programs. These are cost-effective ways to retain they abstain from alcohol and attend Alcoholics
personnel with potential for continued useful service but
Anonymous meetings. The Navy views a persons abuse
whose continued abuse would render them unfit. of alcohol after residential treatment as a failure at
The Navy provides alcohol abuse prevention and rehabilitation or as a failure to complete an alcoholism
rehabilitation programs on three levels. treatment program.

3-20
Aftercare. Following successful completion of a assists in monitoring aftercare when required and serves
Level II or III alcohol abuse program and return to their as the commands self-referral agent. The DAPA is
command, persons remain in an "aftercare" status for assisted by a Navy aftercare coordinator (NAC) who
180 days. The nature of the aftercare program varies helps establish and monitor aftercare programs for
from case to case. Most programs require close recovering individuals.
observation of the persons during the 180-day period.
COUNSELING AND ASSISTANCE CENTER
They also require the persons to attend Alcoholics
(CAAC). The CAAC is a nonresidential facility
Anonymous meetings and, if medically authorized, to
providing counseling services, clinical
take part in Antiabuse (disulfiram) therapy.
screebubg/referral, and local outreach programs for
The Navys Alcohol and Drug Abuse Prevention commands in the immediate geographic area. The Navy
and Control Program includes education and Alcohol and Drug Safety Action Program (NADSAP)
rehabilitation. It takes a preventative educational office is located at the CAAC. NADSAP is a command
approach by providing information on the effects of prevention/remedial education tool, providing 36 hours
alcohol and alcohol addiction through multimedia of education about alcohol and drug abuse. The
presentations. Through this program, every naval NADSAP office also provides civilian court liaison for
hospital provides evaluation, detoxification, and personnel accused of DWI and similar offenses.
primary rehabilitation. The alcohol rehabilitation NADSAP supports and coordinates alcohol and drug
centers and the smaller alcohol rehabilitation units abuse prevention programs for local and afloat
conduct more extensive treatment and rehabilitation. commands. The CAAC sends a representative to the
These centers and units are strategically located in areas regional Navy Drug and Alcohol Advisory Council
with a large concentration of Navy personnel. (NDAAC).
The Navys Alcohol and Drug Abuse Prevention NAVAL ALCOHOL REHABILITATION
and Control Program has a referral network of voluntary CENTERS (NAVALREHCEN). Alcohol rehabili-
collateral duty counselors. These counselors try to tation centers (NAVALREHCEN) provide a program of
identify specific cases of problem drinking in the early intense and comprehensive rehabilitation for
stages. If a counselor spots persons whose performance active-duty Navy and Marine Corps personnel suffering
or health indicates a drinking problem, a medical officer from alcoholism. These centers, located at Norfolk,
examines them. After drying out in a hospital, if needed, Virginia; Miramar, California; Jacksonville, Florida;
they are admitted to a rehabilitation facility. and Pearl Harbor, Hawaii, are under the command of a
medical officer.
NAVY DRUG AND ALCOHOL COUN-
SELOR. Drug and alcohol counselors are graduates of ALCOHOL REHABILITATION DEPART-
the Navy Drug and Alcohol Counselor School. The MENT (ARDs). Alcohol rehabilitation departments
counselors have successfully completed a 1-year (ARDs) have been established at different Navy
supervised internship and have earned a secondary hospitals in the United States and some foreign
Navy Enlisted Classification (SNEC) 9519 through countries. These departments are staffed by a drug and
successful completion of the certification examination. alcohol abuse treatment specialist in addition to medical
They provide evaluation and referral services at the local personnel. The ARD is available to active-duty
CAAC to assist local commands in the processing of personnel of the Navy and Marine Corps.
persons identified as drug or alcohol abusers. They also
OTHER HELPING RESOURCES. Other
provide individual and group counseling services to
helping resources available to you arc the senior Navy
drug and alcohol abusers. Commands and individuals
people around you. Your division chief, command
seeking help or information concerning alcohol or drug
master chief, or chaplain has the experience, seniority,
abuse and abuse control programs may contact these
and knowledge necessary to give you the proper
counselors.
guidance. That doesnt mean you should jump the chain
DRUG AND ALCOHOL PROGRAM of command; you should know that is never a good
ADVISOR (DAPA). The DAPA is the command practice. However, if you find yourself in a situation in
representative responsible to the commanding officer which your experience or knowledge will not permit you
for carrying out the NADAP. The DAPA conducts to make an informed decision, you should inform your
onboard administrative screening as directed by the seniors of the problem and request their assistance.
commanding officer and coordinates or assists in Unless the situation requires complete confidentiality,
conducting command awareness education. The DAPA dont keep your senior petty officer out of the picture. If

3-21
the problem is serious enough, such as an incident that Over 800,000 die annually from heart disease and
could be a violation of the UCMJ, inform your strokes, nearly one-fourth of which are caused by
supervisor even if the situation requires confidentiality. alcohol. Over 50,000 die each year in automobile
Then ensure the problem gets to the proper level within accidents, over half of which are caused by drunk
the chain of command for proper action. driving. Why build up similar statistics on drugs too?
Apply common sense in the handling of any Why not be smarter and seek to have along, healthy life?
problem, whether your own problem or a subordinates How can anyone defend marijuana by saying it is
problem. You can then reach a proper solution that is no worse than alcohol? Alcohol is now the nations
best for all concerned. number one drug problem. Why develop another drug
problem that is equally as bad as alcoholism?
SUMMARY One argument in favor of drugs is that hallucinogens
expand the mind. Actually they produce illusions and
In this chapter we discussed some of the Navys distortions. They cause the senses to distort reality so
programs in support of equal opportunity and drug and that mental work becomes more difficult-or even
alcohol abuse prevention, treatment, and rehabilitation. impossible. Why not face reality so that problems can
The thousands of hours and millions of dollars be solved?
invested in the pursuit of equal opportunity over the past Some have said that stimulants increase your mental
decade reflect the Navys total commitment to equal
abilities-more alert for tests, more zip for athletics, and
opportunity (EO). During that time, the Navy has
so forth. Actually, they draw on the bodys reserve
focused firmly on the principle that individual
energy. Using stimulants too much will exhaust your
achievement should be limited only by ability and
mind and body. Why not find your capabilities by
aspiration.
natural means? That way, what you do will really be
New Navy programs make EO a more integral part your own accomplishment.
of leadership and management. Command managed
Some have said that depressants slow the world
equal opportunity focuses on the prevention of
down and make problems smaller. Actually, they slow
discriminatory incidents before they occur. Commands
the abuser down, not the world. They dull the abusers
assess themselves as often as needed to problem-solve
and to develop their own plans of action to correct any senses and make the abuser less effective-less able to
deficiencies. Commanding officers have the respond to normal demands and emergencies. Isnt it
responsibility to ensure their commands take the silly to think that by not caring, you will either solve
initiative to make equal opportunity a reality for all naval problems or make them go away?
personnel. Many people say that trying just once never hurt
As a senior petty officer, you have the responsibility anyone. That is not so. The law makes few exceptions
to maintain good order and discipline. Therefore, you for the first error. Most addicts started by trying just
must know the possible punishments for discriminatory once. Why should you think you are smarter or luckier
practices. Since you will complete and file investigative than those other poor souls who got hooked?
report chits, you must also know the rights of the Is drug use in your command none of your business?
accused. How can that be so when it involves criminals and
The history of drug abuse proves that it has a criminal acts and affects the security, safety, and good
destructive effect on society. However, some people health of you and your shipmates? Are you concerned
defend the use of drugs, even if they have decided not that your life may be endangered by some drunk or
to try drugs themselves. They say people have a right doped-up person the next time you drive your car on the
to use drugs if they wish, regardless of the law. Others street? The Constitution does not give lawbreakers the
look the other way, saying it is none of their business. right to deprive law-abiding citizens of their health and
Some are afraid to say anything about it at all. happiness.
What about the older generation that warns about Remember this too-the consequences of drug abuse
drugs but then uses alcohol? Those people may wish may greatly affect your career in the Navy. Under
the y had never started using alcohol and want to save military law, drug abuse is conduct prejudicial to good
the younger generation from the pain and anguish they order and discipline. Abusers will be disciplined at
have experienced. Captains mast or tried by courts-martial. Such cases

3-22
CHAPTER 4

PROFESSIONAL RESPONSIBILITIES
LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. Identify the petty officer responsibilities. 6. Describe the personnel advancement require-
ments system.
2. Explain how to supervise personnel awarded
extra military instruction (EMI), extension of 7. Describe the application procedures for the
work hours, or withholding of privileges. limited duty officer (LDO) and chief warrant
officer (CWO) programs.
3. Describe the various watch organizations.
8. Identify the duties of the training petty
4. Identify the personnel qualification stand- officer.
ards and organization.
9. Describe the procedures for presenting per-
5. Explain how to review an enlisted service sonnel for quarters, inspections, and cere-
record. monies.

leadership areas the Navy has entrusted to all its


Any man who may be asked in this century petty officers. Most of the information will focus
what he did to make his life worthwhile, on the leading petty officer (LPO).
I think he can respond with a good deal
TYPES OF AUTHORITY
of pride and satisfaction . . . I served in
the United States Navy.
There are two distinct types of authority:
John F. Kennedy
35th President of the 1. General
United States 2. Organizational

In the following paragraphs we will show you


In this chapter we will give you a brief how these two types of authority are used to give
overview of the duties of a petty officer first class. you a better idea of how you fit into the Navys
As a senior petty officer, you should have a leadership structure.
thorough knowledge of the various programs that
pertain to the responsibilities of that position. General

General responsibilities and duties of all


PETTY OFFICER RESPONSIBILITIES officers and petty officers in the Navy are listed
in article 141.4 of the Standard Organization and
To make you aware of your responsibility as Regulations of the United States Navy,
a petty officer, we will cover in-depth the OPNAVINST 3120.32B.

4-1
their personnel. They should have the freedom of at fault either were not aware of their duties and
making changes concerning their personnel and responsibilities or they did not think they had the
work stations and have the authority to train their authority to act. On the other hand, serious
personnel. They should also be able to make damage and loss of life have been averted by the
recommendations to training schedules. timely action of watch standers working together
as a coordinated team.

Replacement Personnel
WATCH, QUARTER, AND
A fact of life in the Navy is the transfer of STATION BILL
trained personnel. The secret to trained personnel
is cross-training your people. Make sure each The watch, quarter, and station (WQS) bill is
person knows the other persons job. If you cross- the commanding officers summary of personnel
train replacements for a particular job, they will duty assignments and stations. This bill displays
be qualified to do the job. If the individual is not your duties for each emergency and watch
qualified, he or she should be assigned to a condition. It also shows your duty requirements
qualified person and remain with that individual in administrative and operational bills. The
until the job is understood. You and your division primary purpose of the WQS bill is to inform all
officer can then be confident of that persons division personnel of their assignments. Division
abilities if a plan of action is used to train your officers prepare, complete, and detail WQS bills.
division personnel. Once approved, these bills are posted in a
prominent place within the division. The WQS bill
shows name, rate, billet number, bunk, and locker
number of each person in the division. In
WATCH ORGANIZATION addition, it indicates each persons battle station
(conditions 1, 2, 3), fire station, fire and rescue
The term duty has been defined in many station, collision station, abandon ship station
different ways, with most definitions centering (with equipment to be provided), special station
around an assigned task or place of service. The for getting underway and anchoring, sea watch
best definition of a duty is something that a person station, in-port watch station, and cleaning
is expected or required to do by moral or legal station.
obligationan action or task required by ones
position. Most of us are familiar with duty Based on the battle bill, the details of duties
because we stand duty in addition to our regular performed by the divisions are found in the
work. But duty includes much more than simply general WQS bill. Watches, quarters for berthing
standing a watch. Basically, we could divide duties and messing, and stations for battle emergencies,
into two categories, MILITARY (watches and so as well as routine work, are some of the duties
forth) and ADMINISTRATIVE (making watch included in the bill.
bills, writing evals, giving work assignments,
and so forth). A petty officer first class must Based on the general WQS bill, the assign-
be qualified to perform the duties in both cate- ments of stations and duties to all individuals,
gories. by name, are set forth in appropriate bills
for each division of the ship. These bills
A ships watch organization is second in should be conspicuously posted and kept up to
importance only to the organization for battle. date.
Great care is exercised in establishing the watch
organization and in making sure all crew members The executive officer is responsible for
understand their duties, responsibilities, and maintaining a master WQS bill for the ship.
authority to make decisions. Division officers are responsible for detailed WQS
bills for the personnel in their division. These bills
Personnel on watch are entrusted with the must be approved by the executive officer. Since
safety of the ship, its equipment, and its the ships master WQS bill must accurately reflect
personnel. Confusion or conflict among watch all division assignments, any changes to the
standers can result in serious casualties or the loss WQS bill must also be approved by the executive
of the ship. In many naval disasters the people officer.

4-5
individuals aboard ship should be instructed in destruction under the plan without waiting for
the action they should take if they see someone specific orders.
fall overboard. They should also understand what The order in which classified material is to be
action they can expect the ship to take to rescue destroyed under emergency conditions should be
the person. Frequent drills and instructions in determined in advance and the material so marked
watch sections are held to ensure the successful and stored. Classified matter is destroyed in order
rescue of personnel lost overboard. of classificationhighest classification first.
When the word is passed that a person has Destruction by fire is the traditional method
fallen overboard, you should immediately muster for all combustible materials. Oil or chemicals
your division and report it to the division officer, may be used to aid in burning. Classified
who reports it to the department head. equipment must be smashed beyond recognition,
Anyone who sights a person overboard should and unclassified equipment should be demolished
immediately beyond repair.
A sufficient number of destruction tools
1. call out, MAN OVERBOARD, PORT including sledgehammers, screwdrivers, axes, and
(or STARBOARD) SIDE; wire cuttersare always kept in equipment spaces
2. notify the OOD in the quickest manner for use in emergency destruction.
possible; and The priorities for emergency destruction are
3. if near a life ring or other life saving as follows:
equipment, t brow or release the equipment
as near to the person as possible. 1. Priority One. Top Secret material in the
following order: (1) COMSEC material, (2)
CBR Defense Bill special access material, (3) other material
2. Priority Two. Secret material in the follow-
The purpose of the CBR defense bill is to ing order: (1) COMSEC material, (2)
prescribe procedures and responsibilities for special access material, (3) other material
defensive measures against CBR (or any 3. Priority Three. Confidential material in the
combination of the CBR) attack. This bill following order: (1) COMSEC material, (2)
describes procedures to minimize the effects of special access material, (3) other material
a CBR attack so that the ships mission can still
be accomplished. The damage control assistant
(DCA) is responsible for administering the bill.
As the division LPO, you should make sure your PERSONNEL QUALIFICATION
personnel know where their battle, ready shelter, STANDARDS
deep shelter, and decontamination stations are
and the routes to them. You will assist the division The Personnel Qualification Standards (PQS)
officer in CBR training matters and evaluate the Program is a qualification system for personnel
abilities of your personnel in CBR defense to perform certain duties. A PQS lists the
procedures. minimum knowledge and skills required to qualify
for a specific watch station, maintain specific
Emergency Destruction Bill equipment, or perform as a team member within
a unit. The PQS Program is not a training
All commands located outside the United program, but it does provide objectives to be met
States and its territories, all deployable through training. A PQS is most effective when
commands, and all commands holding Com- it is used as a key element of a well-structured and
munications Security (COMSEC) material must dynamic unit training program
have an emergency destruction bill. The PQS program is established in units
Emergency destruction of classified material throughout the Navy. It is used by the air, surface
is necessary to prevent its capture by an enemy. communities, and the Coast Guard. It provides
Destruction plans call for the highest degree of qualification standards and a method of
individual initiative in preparing for and in recordkeeping for training. PQS use is required
actually commencing the required destruction. All in units to which it is applicable, unless suspended
personnel must realize that in emergencies by fleet commanders in chief. It is not applicable
subjecting classified material to compromise to nuclear propulsion or the fleet ballistic missile
through capture, they must start necessary (FBM) weapons systems.

4-8
to trainees with no further assistance, the PQS officers for each qualification requirement. Time
program can be counterproductive. The Personnel limits assigned should consider the deployment
Qualification Standards Catalog, NAVEDTRA schedule and allow appropriate time to become
43100-5E, issued annually in October, contains a qualified. The time limit also provides a means for
listing of PQS products. Quarterly updates are the department head, division officer, and other
issued that contain new, revised, and deleted supervisory personnel to check individual
documents; PQS workshops scheduled; and other progress. A time limit can serve as a goal to instill
pertinent information affecting the development of motivation in each individual and the spirit of
production of PQS. Quarterly updates are competition within the work center.
distributed in February, May, and August. Figure
4-3 illustrates a maintained PQS chart. Qualification Process
When you assign qualification requirements,
PQS Indoctrination you must ensure prerequisite and concurrent
The division officer or leading CPO/LPO items are completed in the proper sequence. When
should conduct individual interviews with newly assigning more than one watch
reporting personnel to evaluate their past station/maintenance action or section for
experiences, qualifications, and general completion, specify which should be completed
background. After the PQS program and first.
commands policy have been explained, a PQS
package is provided along with expected As a supervisor, you must instill safety into
completion dates for fundamentals, systems, and the very fabric of the qualification process. Keep in
qualification goals. Trainees must also be advised mind that all safety requirements must be
as to how much time they should spend each week completed before performing any of the required
on training to accomplish the established goals. qualification tasks.
This procedure will ensure they know what they
are qualifying for and when they are required to Interim Qualification
have their qualification completed.
Situations may arise when watch standers
Establishing Time Limits must be qualified on an interim basis before the
Specific time limits for qualification should be
established by department heads and division

Figure 4-3.PQS progress record.

4-10
Programs are the primary enlisted-to-officer has been, and will continue to be, particularly keen.
programs sponsored by the Navy that do not require If you are interested in applying for these programs,
a college education. Figure 4-5 shows the CWO/LDO you should begin preparing early in your career. To
category to which each enlisted rating may advance. better prepare to become an officer, you should
Competition for entrance into both of the programs increase your

NORMAL PATH OF ADVANCEMENT


TO CHIEF WARRANT OFFICER AND LIMITED DUTY OFFICER

CWO CATEGORY AND LDO CATEGORY AND


ENLISTED RATING OFFICER DESIGNATOR OFFICER DESIGNATOR
Surf/Sub Surf/sub
BM, QM, SM BOATSWAIN (711X/721X) DECK (611X 621X)

OS/EW/OT OPERATION TECH (712X) OPERATIONS (612X)
BT, IC, EN, MM, GS, EM ENGINEERING TECH (713X/723X) ENGINEERING/REPAIR (613X/623X)
ML, PM, HT, DC, OM, IM, MR REPAIR TECH (714X/724X)

GMG, GMM, GM, FTB , ORDNANCE TECH (716X/726X)

WT, FC , MT, FTG , TM , FT ORDINANCE (616X/626X)

MN, TM % UNDERWATER ORDNANCE TECH (717X/727X)

ST, DS , FTG , FTB , ELECTRONICS TECH (718X/728X) ELECTRONICS (618X/628X)

FC , OT , ET, FT
RM COMMUNICATION TECH (719X/729X) COMMUNICATIONS (619X/629X)

AVIATION AVIATION
ALL RATINGS $ N/A LDO AVIATOR (630X)
ABE, ABE, ABH, AB AVIATION BOATSWAIN (731X) AVIATION DECK (631X)
AW AVIATION OPERATIONS TECH (732X) AVIATION OPERATIONS (632X)
AD, AME, AMH, AMS, AM, PR, AVIATION MAINTENANCE TECH (734X) AVIATION MAINTENANCE (634X)
AS, AZ, AFCM

AO, WT AVIATION ORDNANCE TECH (736X) AVIATION ORDANANCE (636X)
AT, AE, AVCM AVIATION ELECTRONICS TECH (738X) AVIATION ELECTRONICS (638X)
AC AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL TECH (739X) AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL (639X)

GENERAL SERIES GENERAL SERIES


MM, EM, ET, IC NUCLEAR POWER TECH (740X) NUCLEAR POWER (640X)

LI, JO , PC, PN, YN, LN , RP SHIPS CLERK (741X) ADMINISTRATION (641X)

DP, DS DATA PROCESSING TECH (742X) DATA PROCESSING (642X)
MU N/A BANDMASTER (643X)
CT@ CRYPTOLOGIC TECH (744X) CRYPTOLOGY (644X)

IS INTELLIGENCE TECH (745X) INTELLIGENCE (645X)
AG AEROGRAPHER (746X) METEOROLOGY/OCEANOGRAPHY (646X)

PH, IS , JO , DM PHOTOGRAPHER (747X) PHOTOGRAPHY (647X)
ANY RATING QUALIFIED EXPLOSIVE ORDNANCE (748X) EXPLOSIVE ORDNANCE (648X)
IN EOD DISPOSAL TECH DISPOSAL
MA SECURITY TECH (749X) SECURITY (649X)

STAFF CORPS STAFF CORPS



DK, SK, SH, AJ MS SUPPLY CORPS WARRANT (SC) (751X)
SUPPLY (SC) (651X)

MS FOOD SERVICE WARRANT (SC) (752X)

DM , BU, CE, CM, UT, EA, EO CIVIL ENGINEER CORPS (753X)
SW, CUCM, EQCM, UCCM WARRANT (CEC) CIVIL ENGINEER (653X)
HM$ PHYSICIANS ASSISTANT (PA) (754X) N/A

LN N/A LAW (655X)

NOTES: Normal path is more than one category


@ Only CT personnel may apply
Exclusive path of advancement for personnel in these raing who hold a valid nuclear
power program NEC
Less personnel holding valid nuclear power program NEC
$ Application procedures published separately
% 717X-MN Path of Advancement; 727-TM Path of Advancement
MA & NC may apply under previous rating or any designator for which qualified.

Figure 4-5.Normal path of advancement to chief warrant officer and limited duty officer.

4-16
TRAINING PETTY OFFICER

The training petty officer (TPO), one of the


most important petty officers in a work center,
is the backbone for all divisional personnel
qualification programs. The TPO ensures training
of personnel to operate and maintain their
equipment and related systems. This is the prime
factor affecting the operational readiness and
performance of the command. Significant impor-
tance to readiness are operator and maintenance
personnel, in rate and Navy enlisted classification
code (NEC) training, watch station qualification,
This space intentionally left blank
and maintaining watch station proficiency. TPOs
administer training within the division by
planning, developing, and coordinating the
division training program to include general
military training (GMT), individual watch station
qualification, and operator and team proficiency
in subsystems.

TRAINING SCHEDULE

TPOs develop annual, monthly, and weekly


training schedules to help implement daily
training. All training is recorded when held and
entered in divisional training records, PQS books,
PQS charts, and source records. Training should
not conflict with daily work schedules and should
be scheduled so that all personnel are present for
training.

SCHEDULE TRAINING EVENTS


AND LECTURES

Great care and thought should go into drafting


a training schedule. Schedules should be made out
using times that will not conflict with your
scheduled work assignments. Most TPOs schedule

4-21
CHAPTER 5

MILITARY REQUIREMENTS
LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. State the requirements for standing a proper 5. State the security procedures to be followed
military watch. for casual visitors.
6. State the security procedures for personnel with
2. Describe the procedures for setting and and without visitor clearance.
relieving the watch.
7. Describe the security procedures for un-
authorized visitors.
3. Describe the procedures for keeping and
correcting the deck log. 8. Describe the security watches required in U.S.
and foreign ports.
4. State the duties and responsibilities for the 9. State the duties and responsibilities of the
junior officer of the deck (JOOD) in port. senior section leader and-the section leader.

authority of command. The in-port OOD should


continually supervise, inspect, control, make
The OOD (in-port) is that officer or petty
timely and sound decisions, and be ready to
officer on watch designated by the respond quickly to a variety of situations. The
commanding officer to be in charge of the OOD should be ever mindful of the weather when
unit. He/she is primarily responsible for
the ship is anchored, moored, or secured to a pier.
the safety and proper operation of the unit.
Security of the ship is one of the most important
duties of the ODD in port.
Standard Organization and
As a senior petty officer, knowing the duties
Regulations of the U.S. Navy,
and responsibilities of the OOD is as important
OPNAVINST 3120.32B.
as knowing the duties and responsibilities of your
division officer. The following information will
help you in your personnel qualification standards
This chapter will give you an overview of the
(PQS) for in-port OOD. (Two other excellent
duties, responsibilities, and organizational sources of information are Boatswains Mate 1
relationship of the officer of the deck (OOD) in
& C, NAVEDTRA 10122-E, and the Watch
port and the junior officer of the deck (JOOD)
Officer, NAVEDTRA 10719-C.)
in port.
In the following paragraphs, we will cover
One of the most important watches you will some of the general duties of OOD and JOOD
stand as a senior petty officer is the in-port OOD. watch standers; how to prepare for a watch;
The in-port OOD, next to the captain and the relieving procedures; and duties, responsibilities,
executive officer, is the most important person and authority.
aboard ship. As a direct representative of the Although the following paragraphs cover
commanding officer, the OOD has all the standing watch aboard ship (in port), the

5-1
principles involved also apply to watches Some of the most important aspects of the
ashore. watch that the in-port OOD should consider are
listed below. Based on the experience of the OOD
or under special circumstances, the OOD should
PERFORMANCE OF DUTY ON also consider other aspects not listed below.
WATCH
1. Anchor in use and scope of chain
The following instructions paraphrase the 2. Depth of water and type of bottom
Standard Organization and Regulations of the 3. Lines in use, if alongside
U.S. Navy (SORN), OPNAVINST3120.32B. The 4. Anchorage bearings, if at anchor
SORN should be used as a general guide for 5. Weather conditions expected and
standards met by all watch standers, As a watch preparations for them
stander, you are responsible for the following: 6. State of tide
7. Boiler and auxiliaries in use
1. Proper performance of all duties prescribed 8. SOPA and other ships present
or your watch. All persons in your charge 9. Location of the flag officer (if any),
will be subject to your orders. captain, executive officer, and depart-
2. Remain responsible for your watch and ment heads
remain on station until properly relieved. 10. Senior officer aboard and senior duty
You should require the same of all persons officer
on watch with you. You should instruct them 11. Number of boats in the water, their
as necessary in the performance of their locations, and boat officers available
duties. Ensure that they are at their stations 12. Absentees, prisoners, and duty lists
and are attentive, alert, and ready for duty. 13. General appearance of the ship
You should train yourself and your subor- 14. Orders for the day and special orders
dinates to foresee situations that may arise 15. Liberty sections, time liberty expires,
and take corrective actions as required. and approximate number of personnel
3. Conduct yourself in a smart and military ashore
manner at all times. 16. Guard ships
4. Use phraseology that is customary to naval 17. Status of planes, if any
personnel when issuing orders and making 18. Work or drills in progress or scheduled
reports. 19. Visitors on board or expected and any
5. Demand of yourself and others formality orders concerning them
in all relationships while on watch. 20. Workers or other authorized civilians on
6. Promptly inform appropriate persons of board
matters concerning your watch so they can 21. If at night, designated ready lifeboat and
properly perform their duties. any morning orders for the anchor watch
7. Make all required inspections and any 22. Boat schedule
additional inspections necessary to ensure
that the duties of the watch are properly SETTING THE WATCH
performed.
Setting the watch occurs with a change of
watch conditions within the ship. A watch is set
PREPARATION FOR THE WATCH upon getting underway, mooring, and changing
the conditions of readiness. Personnel assigned
There is a good deal of preparation required to watch stations are responsible for setting the
before the OOD assumes a deck watch in port. watch and for making the watch station ready to
As a matter of routine, the relieving OOD should function as rapidly as possible. They are also
review the Plan of the Day and local command responsible for ensuring that necessary equipment,
instructions. This includes those of the senior material, and personnel are on station.
officer present afloat (SOPA); and unit policy
concerning existing or special situations. RELIEVING THE WATCH
Generally, all basic information needed by the
OOD is contained in a folder that is kept on the Relieving the watch is a controlled and precise
quarterdeck. function. Experience has shown that the ability

5-2
to handle casualties and tactical decisions is smooth transition from watch to watch. The
significantly reduced during the transition period oncoming OOD should be aware of the current
between watches. The following guidelines should status of the watch bill, such as authorized
be followed when relieving the watch: changes, special watches, or conditions that are
different from those stated in the Plan of the Day.
1. The relieving watch should be on station
in enough time to become familiar with equipment
conditions and the overall situation.
2. The relieving watch should make an THE OOD IN PORT
inspection of all spaces and equipment, as
required by the commanding officer, before As stated in OPNAVINST 3120.32B, the in-
relieving the watch. port officer of the deck is an officer or petty
3. The relieving watch should read the officer on watch designated by the commanding
commentary sections of the ships deck log from officer to be in charge of the unit. The OOD is
the last time he or she was on watch. If continuity primarily responsible for the safety and proper
has been interrupted, the preceding three watches operation of the unit.
are reviewed. The relieving watch should carefully A petty officer assigned as the in-port officer
note unusual conditions, deviations from normal of the deck has the same status as a commissioned
conditions, and other matters of importance and or chief warrant officer; therefore, the orders of
discuss them with the person being relieved. a petty officer assigned as OOD have the same
4. Both the relieved watch and the relieving enforcement powers. The OOD is designated in
watch are responsible for seeing that the relieving writing by the commanding officer. On most ships
watch is aware of all unusual conditions. These the OOD is required to complete the section of
include tactical situations, equipment out of the surface warfare officers PQS that relates to
commission, outstanding orders, deviations from the OOD in port.
normal plant or equipment lineup, forthcoming
evolutions, and any other matters pertinent to the
watch. ORGANIZATIONAL RELATIONSHIP
5. The relief should be exercised smartly in OF THE OFFICER OF THE DECK
each case under the following guidelines:
a. The relief reports, I am ready to relieve The in-port officer of the deck reports directly
you, sir or maam. to the commanding officer for the safety and
b. The person being relieved gives a status general duties of the ship. He or she reports to
report of the watch section. the command duty officer in port (executive
c. The relief makes a tour of the watch officer when a command duty officer [CDO] is
station. not assigned) for carrying out the ships routine.
6. The person being relieved completes The CDO has the authority to relieve the officer
briefing of relief (including unexecuted orders and of the deck when necessary for the safety of the
anticipated evolutions) and answers any questions. ship.
7. The relief, when fully satisfied that The following personnel report to the in-port
complete information on the watch has been officer of the deck:
passed, relieves the watch by saying, I relieve
you, sir/maam. The junior officer of the watch (JOOW) for
8. At this time responsibility for the watch assigned duties and watch training.
stations shifts to the oncoming watch; and the
person being relieved will state, I stand The communications watch officer for the
relieved. expeditious transmission and receipt of
9. The log is completed and signed by the operational and general messages.
offgoing OOD before leaving the watch station.
The quartermaster of the watch for assigned
Another important aspect of relieving the duties.
watch is determining what watches are being
manned, who is manning them, and who they The boat coxswains, or boat officers when
report to. Since watches are dispersed throughout assigned, for the safe and proper operation of
the ship, this information is very important in the ships boats.

5-3
The officer, petty officer, or JOOD (in port) in charge DUTIES, RESPONSIBILITIES, AND
of the gangway watch for the maintenance of a AUTHORITY OF THE OFFICER
properly posted and alert watch on the crews brow or OF THE DECK
accommodation ladder.
Your OOD duties will vary from ship to ship and
The petty officer of the watch supervises the station to station. The type of command and your
quarterdeck watch, anchor watch, fog look-outs, brow commanding officer will dictate modifications to the
and dock sentries. When there is no Marine OOD orders. The following duties, responsibilities,
Detachment assigned, and security watches and and authorities are listed from the SORN. The OOD
patrols are also under the control of the in-port OOD. (in port) shall:

The duty Master-At-Arms for maintenance of good (1) Keep continually informed of the units
order and discipline and the security and processing position, mooring lines or ground tackle in use,
of prisoners. tide and weather information, the status of the
engineering plant, the status of the units
The sergeant of the guard for direction of the guard boats, and all other matters affecting the safety
in performing their duties (in ships having a Marine and security of the unit; and take appropriate
Detachment). action to prevent grounding, collision,
dragging, or other danger in accordance with
The in-port watch organization chart, shown in the U.S. Coast Guard navigation rules of the
figure 5-1, shows the relationship of the OOD to the road and the orders of the commanding officer
in-port watch. and other proper authority.

1 Reports directly to the OOD on general


information signals, absentee pennants,
honors, ship movements, and other sight-
ings. COMMANDING OFFICER

2 Report to the corporal of the guard on


ships having a Marine detachment. EXECUTIVE OFFICER

3 Those posted within a single department


report to cognizant department duty COMMAND DUTY OFFICER SENIOR WATCH OFFICER
officer or pety officer of the watch
as specified in orders of the watch.
OFFICER OF THE DECK

COMMAND
- - - - ADMINISTRATIVE JUNIOR OFFICER OF THE WATCH JUNIOR OFFICER OF THE DECK

COMMUNICATIONS WATCH OFFICER DEPARTMENT DUTY OFFICERS

1
MESSAGE CENTER SIGNAL-BRIDGE WATCH RADIO WATCH DEPARTMENT WATCHES
(Traffic)

BOAT COXSWAINS PETTY OFFICER QUARTERMASTER SGT. OF THE GUARD


(boat off, when assigned) GANGWAY WATCH OF THE WATCH OF THE WATCH DUTY MAA (Marine department)

2
QUARTERDECK WATCH BROW AND PIER ANCHOR WATCH SECURITY WATCHES BRIG SENTRIES,
(Messengers, Talkers, and SIDE BOYS SENTRIES AND FOG LOOKOUTS AND PATROLS 3 GUARD, ORDERLIES
Buglers)

Figure 5-1.Watch Organization chart (in port).

5-4
(2) Ensure that required reports to the (11) Display required absentee
OOD (in port) concerning tests and pennants, colors, and general information
inspections and the routine reports of signals, and supervise the rendering of
patrols, watches, and sentries are promptly honors.
originated and that the quarterdeck watch, (12) Make all required reports to the
lookouts, anchor watch, and other sentries CDO (in port), executive officer, and
or patrols are properly posted and alert. commanding officer as directed by stand-
(3) Ensure all required entries are ing orders to the OOD.
made in the deck log, and sign the log at (13) Supervise and conduct on-the-job
the conclusion of the watch. training for the JOOW, the JOOD, and
(4) Carry out the routine as published enlisted personnel of the quarterdeck
in the Plan of the Day, ensuring the watch.
executive officer, CDO (in port), and (14) Assume other responsibilities as
department heads are informed of circum- the commanding officer may assign.
stances which require changes in routine (15) Supervise striking of the ships
or other action on their part. bell to denote the hours and half-hours
(5) Initiate and supervise units evolu- from reveille to taps, requesting permission
tions or operations as necessary. of the commanding officer to strike eight
(6) Attend one of the units gang- bells at 0800, 1200, and 2000.
ways, and supervise watch personnel
assigned to attend other gangways. Apprehension and Restraint
(7) Supervise the operations of the
units boats in accordance with the boat As the officer of the deck, you need to know
schedule published by the executive officer the difference between APPREHENSION and
and the orders of the commanding officer the three degrees of RESTRAINTS: (1) restriction
and other proper authority. instead of arrest, (2) arrest, or (3) confinement.
(8) Ensure that boats are operated At any time during the watch, you may have to
safely and all boat safety regulations are take custody of personnel charged with mis-
observed. Give particular attention to conduct. All officers, petty officers, and
changes in wind or sea conditions and noncommissioned officers of any service have
notify the in-port CDO when the suspen- authority to apprehend offenders who are subject
sion of boating is advisable. Ensure that to the Uniform Code of Military Justice.
boats are not overloaded, and reduce the
APPREHENSION. Apprehension is the
allowed loading capacity when weather
equivalent of an arrest in civilian life. It is the
conditions require caution. Recommend
taking of a person into custody. An apprehension
use of boat officers to the CDO when
is made by clearly notifying the person being
weather or other conditions warrant.
apprehended that he or she is in custody. The
Require boat passengers to wear life
notice can be given orally or in writing. The
jackets when conditions are hazardous;
person making the apprehension may only use
ensure that all boats assigned trips are fully
such force and means as is reasonably necessary
equipped, manned, fueled, and in working
to affect the apprehension. Apprehension con-
order; provide harbor charts to boat
tinues until the person is delivered to proper
coxswains; give boat coxswains trip orders
authority. Aboard ship, the authority is the OOD.
and orders to shove off.
(9) Supervise the general announcing RESTRAINT. Restraint is the moral or
system, the general and chemical alarms, physical restraint on a persons liberty. It may
and the whistle, gong, and bell in consist of restriction in lieu of arrest, arrest, or
accordance with the orders of the confinement.
commanding officer and U.S. Coast
Guard navigation rules of the road. Restriction in Lieu of Arrest. Restriction in
(10) Permit no person to go aloft on lieu of arrest is the restraint of a person by an oral
masts or stacks or to work over the side or written order directing the person to remain
of the ship except when wind and sea within specified limits of an area. A restricted
conditions permit, and then only when all person, unless otherwise directed, performs full
safety precautions are observed. military duties while restricted.

5-5
Arrest. Arrest is the restraint of a person by The person should be afforded every reasonable
an oral or written order, not imposed as care and protection permitted by the
punishment, directing the person to remain within circumstances.
the specified limits of an area. A person in the
status of arrest may not be required to perform FOREIGN TERRITORIES. In territories
full military duties. The person may be relieved under foreign jurisdiction, refuge should be
of such duties as supervising personnel, serving granted for humanitarian reasons only in extreme
as a guard, or bearing arms. A person in arrest or exceptional circumstances where life or safety
may do ordinary cleaning or policing or take part of the person is in imminent danger. When refuge
in routine training and duties. is granted, such protection should only be
terminated when directed by the Secretary of the
Confinement. Confinement is the physical Navy or higher authority. If foreign authorities
restraint, imposed by order of competent autho- request return of the person, it should be reported
rity, depriving a person of his or her freedom to the Chief of Naval Operations (CNO). The
pending the disposition of offenses. No person foreign authorities should be informed that the
may be ordered into confinement except for case has been referred to higher authorities.
probable cause. Probable cause exists when there If temporary refuge is terminated by higher
is a reasonable belief that authority, the person should be released only to
the authority designated in the message
1. an offense triable by court-martial has been authorizing release.
committed, Permanent asylum cannot be granted. Foreign
2. the person confined committed it, and nationals requesting political asylum in the United
confinement is required by the circum- States should be advised to contact the nearest
stances. American Embassy or Consulate. You should
never directly or indirectly invite persons to seek
Only a commanding officer to whose asylum or temporary refuge.
authority a civilian or an officer is subject may
order restraint of the civilian or officer. When a
person is placed under restraint, that person The Deck Log (In Port)
should be informed of the nature of the offense
that is the basis for such restraint. The basic requirements for maintaining the
ships deck logs are contained in the SORN and
U.S. Navy Regulations. OPNAVINST 3100.7B,
Granting Asylum and Temporary Preparing, Maintaining and Submitting the Ships
Refuge Deck Log, provides detailed guidance in preparing
the ships deck log.
As the in-port OOD, you may be the first All U.S. Navy ships in commission and other
person contacted by someone seeking asylum or designated craft are required to maintain a ships
temporary refuge aboard your commend. You deck log. The deck log is the official daily record
should be aware of your authority to provide of a ship, by watches. Every circumstance and
assistance and protection to these people. You occurrence of importance or interest that concerns
should also know what your responsibilities are the crew and the operation and safety of the ship
if foreign authorities request their return. Be sure or that may be of historical value is described in
to check your commands instructions on pro- the deck log.
cedures to follow if someone seeks asylum or The deck log is a chronological record of
temporary refuge. The following is paraphrased events occurring during the watch. Accuracy in
from article 0939 of United States Navy describing events recorded in a ships deck log is
Regulations. essential. Deck log entries often constitute
important legal evidence in judicial and
HIGH SEAS AND U.S. TERRITORIES. administrative fact-finding proceedings arising
On the high seas or territories under exclusive from incidents involving the ship or its personnel.
United States jurisdiction, persons should be Information in the ships deck log is For
received on board at their request. Under no Official Use Only. The ships deck log is prepared
circumstances should the person be surrendered in duplicate. The original copy is submitted
to foreign jurisdiction or control, unless directed monthly to the Chief of Naval Operations for
by the Secretary of the Navy or higher authority. permanent retention. The copy is retained on

5-6
board for 6 months and then destroyed. All entries in correct entry in such a manner as to ensure clarity
the ships deck log are made in black ink with a ball- and legibility, and place your initials in the margin.
point pen. All remarks should be neat and legible. Corrections, additions, or changes are made only by
Only standard Navy phraseology should be used. the person required to sign the record for the watch.
No erasures are permitted in the deck log. If you Figures 5-2 and 5-3
make a mistake, draw a single line through the
original entry (so that it remains legible). Insert the

SHIPS DECK LOG TITLE PAGE IF CLASSIFIED STAMP


OPNAV 3100/98 (Rev 7-84) S/N 0107LF-031-0498 SECURITY MARKING HERE

FOR OFFICIAL USE ONLY

SHIPS DECK LOG


OF THE

U.S.S.
(hull number)

{
DIVISION
SQUADRON
ATTACHED TO GROUP
FLEET
COMMENCING ,19
(zone time and date)
AT
(location)
ENDING ,19
(zone time and date)
AT
(location)
EXAMINED AND
CERTIFIED TO BE CORRECT
(name, grade and signature) NAVIGATOR

APPROVED BY
(name, grade and signature) COMMANDING

TO BE COMPLETED FOLLOWING CHANGE OF COMMAND


DATE OF CHANGE
OF COMMAND
APPROVED BY

name, grade and signature of Relieving Commanding Officer) COMMANDING

FORWARD DIRECT TO THE CHIEF OF NAVAL OPERATIONS AT THE END OF EACH MONTH

REPORT SYMBOL IF CLASSIFED STAMP REVIEW/DECLASSIFICATION DATE HERE IF CLASSIFIED STAMP


OPNAV 3100 10 SECURITY MARKING HERE

Figure 5-2.Ships Deck Log.


5-7
2. Other members of the watch as the in-port danger. The security of the ship is always
OOD directs. paramount and should be of constant concern to
the in-port OOD. No matter how quiet and
uneventful a watch may seem to be, the OOD
DUTIES, RESPONSIBILITIES, AND
should never allow security of the ship to be
AUTHORITY OF THE JOOD relaxed.
As the JOOD, you are responsible to the
VISITOR CONTROL
OOD, and duties may vary from ship to ship and
station to station. The JOOD has the following All Navy ships are required to have a general
duties and responsibilities as outlined in the visiting bill, which provides for the control,
SORN:
identification, and supervision of visitors. A
VISITOR is any person who is not a member of
(1) Be in charge of the crews brow or the units company or is not a member of a staff
gangway. using a ship as a flagship.
(2) Maintain a properly posted and alert
watch at the brow or gangway.
Casual Visiting
(3) Ensure that all personnel leaving the unit
have the authority to leave and are properly
CASUAL VISITING refers to visits on board
attired. by individuals or specific groups, as differentiated
(4) Maintain a record of all personnel
from the general public. In general, casual visits
departing or returning from leave.
should be approved in advance by the
(5) Keep the OOD (in port) informed of any commanding officer. Persons included in such
actions and decisions. visits include specifically invited guests, members
(6) Perform other duties as the OOD (in port)
of the U.S. Armed Forces, close relatives of the
directs. units personnel, and other persons on legitimate
business.

General Visiting
Commanding officers are responsible for
the control of visitors to their commands
GENERAL VISITING refers to specifically
and shall comply with the relevant
authorized occasions when the unit acts as host
provisions of the Information and
to the general public, which will normally be
Personnel Security Program Regulation,
conducted between the hours of 1300 and 1600.
OPNAVINST 5510.1H, and other
An important point to keep in mind when visitors
pertinent directives.
are aboard is that visiting is done on an
unclassified basis. This means that no classified
United States Navy
areas or information should be shown or given
Regulations
to the general public. The visiting bill shows the
areas that are open for general visiting and
describes the safeguards that must be observed.
Any visitor who is authorized access to
SHIPS SECURITY classified information should present adequate
identification at the time of the visit. In briefing
One of the primary responsibilities of the escorts, the OOD should ensure they understand
OOD and the watch is to ensure the security and what spaces are not open to visitors. The OOD
safety of the ship. In port a ship can be threatened should ensure access to spaces containing
in many ways. Threats to the ship may be natural, classified or sensitive equipment is denied, unless
in the form of storms, or accidental, in the case such equipment has been concealed or adequately
of fire or collision. A ship may also be threatened protected. Personnel from each department
from an almost limitless range of deliberate should be detailed to act as guides to conduct
human actions. tours. One person should be assigned to each
The security of the ship is the responsibility group of visitors (15 people per group). Sentries
of all hands. Everyone aboard ship should be should be stationed to assist visitors and to keep
aware of security and be alert for any signs of them from tampering with equipment.

5-10
One-half hour before the scheduled com- Enlisted members may entertain members of
mencement of general visiting, sentries and guides their families in the crews lounge and messing
should be mustered, inspected, and instructed by spaces when general visiting is permitted. They
the chief master-at-arms. Additional messengers are not permitted in other areas of the ship except
and qualified swimmers should be stationed at those authorized for general visiting. Enlisted
gangways, if necessary, to assist visitors in and members may, with permission of the OOD,
out of boats and onto accommodation ladders. entertain guests in designated areas outside of
The medical officer should provide first-aid working hours and at times other than general
personnel during general visiting. Visitors visiting hours.
requiring first aid should be escorted to sick bay.
The command duty officer should be notified Visits by Foreign Nationals
whenever a visitor is injured or requires first aid.
Visitors requiring first aid should be escorted to Unclassified controlled visits by foreign
sick bay. The command duty officer should be nationals may be authorized by the commanding
notified whenever a visitor is injured or requires officer, subject to local restrictions established by
first aid. Personnel should be detailed to maintain higher authority. Classified visits should be
a count of general visitors coming aboard and authorized by the CNO, and then only with the
leaving the ship. At the conclusion of visiting approval of the commanding officer. When
hours, a search of the ship should be made to foreign nationals are approved for visiting, they
ensure all visitors have departed. should be constantly escorted and only allowed
The general visitor bill is based on the probable to visit those parts of the ship specifically
presence of foreign agents among the visitors. You authorized.
should be on the alert for any visitor who
expresses an unusual interest in unauthorized VISITORS WITH AND WITHOUT
information. You should also be suspicious of any VISIT CLEARANCE
visitor who expresses feelings that are hostile,
unfriendly, or not in the best interest of the United Visits by individuals who have access to
States. All suspicious actions should be reported classified information should be preceded by
immediately to the security officer or security approval of the visit request by the commanding
manager or, if necessary, directly to the officer unless a day-to-day working relationship
commanding officer. has been established and the visitors clearance
Visitors with a legitimate reason to board the status is personally known to members of the unit.
ship should be received politely. Every visitor Shipyard personnel are allowed on board
coming on board, including those in uniform or during assigned availabilities without receiving
on official business, should present proper duty officer approval provided an authorized
identification at the time of each visit. access list is available and appropriate
identification is presented and checked against the
Entertaining Guests
access list. At all other times, the visit clearance
Officers are permitted to have personal guests procedures should be followed.
during visiting hours, between the hours of 1600 The number of uncleared visitors allowed on
and 2200 daily, and at other times with the board should be held to a minimum. When on
approval of the executive officer. The guests board, uncleared visitors should be constantly
should be escorted at all times, and it is the escorted by a member of the unit. The following
individual officers responsibility to ensure they uncleared visitors are authorized to visit after
are not shown spaces that might embarrass approval of the duty officer:
personnel attached or endanger the security
classification of any material on board. 1. Close relatives of unit personnel.
Chief petty officers are permitted to entertain 2. Service personnel of the U.S. Armed
guests in their messroom and lounge after 1100 Forces desiring to visit the unit on a not-
and until the expiration of visiting hours on to-interfere basis. Such personnel should
Sundays and during general visiting. Guests be accompanied by a member of the unit.
should be escorted by the OOD messenger from 3. Any exceptions to the preceding should be
the quarterdeck to the CPO messroom if not approved in advance by the commanding
accompanied by a chief. Guests are not permitted officer or executive officer. Should the duty
in any part of the CPO quarters. officer be unable to obtain this authorization

5-11
Forecastle and Fantail Security assigned duties. They are in charge of their duty
Watch sections and are responsible for the conduct of
the duty section. Because of their position, duty
When these watches are posted, they are section leaders can demonstrate and develop their
armed with a rifle, a belt, 30 rounds of abilities as leaders. This opportunity is especially
ammunition, a police whistle, and a flashlight. valuable for senior petty officers who would not
They should not leave their posts until properly otherwise have the chance to display or develop
relieved. Upon being relieved they should report these skills. The most important job section
this fact to the OOD. They should prevent leaders perform is seeing that the members of their
unauthorized persons from approaching or sections are able to do any job that may be
coming on board the ship. Should any boat or required of them. This will involve a great deal
person closely approach the ship, they should of work from everyone concerned to attain the
challenge the boat or person and positively necessary degree of proficiency.
identify them before directing them to pro-
ceed to the gangway. The boat or person Depending upon the size or class of ship, each
should be kept under surveillance until the division has a duty section leader who is the senior
OOD at the gangway has been notified and petty officer in each duty section. Therefore, being
taken charge. If the challenge is not answered, assigned as a section leader depends upon the size
it should be repeated; and then if no answer of the command and the number of personnel in
is received, the whistle should be sounded to your duty section.
call for assistance. The watch should be pre-
pared to use the rifle as necessary to prevent As a section leader you will have things to
the approach. report. Always use the chain of command. During
normal working hours you should report to your
If the watch believes that the advancing leading petty officer (LPO).
person or boat is going to cause serious
bodily harm or death, and all other means The LPO will in turn report to the leading
fail or cannot be reasonably exhausted in chief petty officer (LCPO) or the division officer.
time, the use of deadly force becomes neces- After normal working hours you report to your
sary. The use of deadly force should be department duty officer, who reports to the
thoroughly understood by all personnel under command duty officer.
arms as outlined in SECNAVINST 5500.29A
(Use of Force by Personnel Engaged in Law When you are assigned as a section leader, you
Enforcement and Security Duties). assume additional responsibilities for the work,
conduct, appearance, and welfare of the per-
sonnel in your section. Along with these
additional responsibilities, you are granted
SECTION LEADERS additional authority to properly carry out your
duties.
The senior section leader in the division usually
directs duty section policy implementation and The section leader is the first step up the ladder
sees that everyone is treated fairly on the division of naval authority. You may be the supervisor for
watch bill. The senior section leader makes all the routine and special activities of the people
decisions involving the operation of the divisions in your section, including reveille, quarters for
duty sections and evaluates, supervises, and trains muster, observance of the proper uniform of the
the divisions section leaders. day, and for items listed in the Plan of the Day.
Also, you are responsible for the damage control
The duty section leader is the divisions functions of your duty section after normal
ranking representative while in a duty status (after working hours.
normal working hours) and is thus senior to
all other members of the division (except the When your duty section is being relieved,
division officer and the senior section leader). In you should pass on to your relief any in-
order for section leaders to carry out their military formation regarding the section. This could
and professional responsibilities, they must be range from safety hazards to the cleanliness of
given authority that is commensurate with their the ship.

5-13
CHAPTER 6

SAFETY AND SURVIVAL


LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. Identify the responsibilities of the division 8. Describe the safety precautions used when
safety petty officer. working with industrial equipment and
hazardous materials.
2. Explain mishap prevention education and
training. 9. Describe the types of respirators and their
uses.
3. Describe the three types of safety observations
and when to use them. 10. Describe the Navys Hearing Conservation,
Noise Abatement, and Sight Protection
4. Describe the purpose of a job safety analysis. Programs.

5. Explain the purpose of the enlisted safety com- 11. Describe the Navys Equipment Tag-Out
mittee. Program (tag-out log audit).

6. Explain the Navys Occupational Safety and 12. State the different types of survival situations
Health (NAOSH) Program. and the responsibility of the senior petty
officer.
7. Identify the responsibilities of the Hazardous
Waste/Material petty officer. 13. State the methods of survival.

Mishaps are unplanned events. However,


The object of the safety program is to the potential for a mishap is predictable.
enhance operational readiness by reducing The event or sequence of events that lead
the number of deaths and injuries to per- to an unplanned event can be anticipated
sonnel and losses and damage to material through safety awareness. Proper safety knowl-
from accidental cause. edge and corrective action can prevent the
unplanned mishap. Since people cause mishaps,
OPNAVINST 3120.32B such preventive actions must be directed at
individuals.

As a junior petty officer, your role in the com- Studies conducted by the National Safety
mand safety program involved practicing safe Council, based upon 60 years of data, reveal
work habits and reporting safety discrepancies to that the basis of fundamental mishap preven-
your leading petty officer. As a senior petty of- tion is to eliminate the small mishap. A
ficer, you still have these primary responsibilities; definite relationship exists between mishaps
however, you also have the task of ensuring that involving minor property damage or minor
your division is safety conscious. injury and major damage or severe injury

6-1
pause in whatever you are doing to see if a per- nullify, or prevent them. A JSA serves as a special
son does some part of a job safely. You watch tool for making jobs safer. The basic principles
strictly from a safety standpoint. of mishap prevention are (1) to spot potential
You may make a deliberate safety observation mishap causes and (2) eliminate potential mishap
for a number of reasons. You may want to check causes.
the work of a new person, the job may be a par- The four basic steps of a JSA are as follows:
ticularly hazardous one, or the worker may have
a reputation for unsafe work. Whatever the 1. Select the job to be analyzed.
reason, your observation is deliberate; it is more 2. Break down the job into steps.
than a casual glance at a person doing a job. 3. Identify the hazards or potential mishaps.
4. Develop solutions to prevent hazards or
THE PLANNED SAFETY potential mishaps.
OBSERVATION
You gain the maximum benefits of JSAs only
A planned safety observation is when you when you use the analysis and when you in-
deliberately schedule a time to watch for safety variably learn more about the jobs you supervise
violations by a person performing a specific job. as a result of doing them. When a supervisor asks
It is usually a part of a continuing program of workers to help develop a JSA, their attitudes im-
safety observation. It is designed to check prove. As a result, they often generate cost-
regularly on how safely all hazardous jobs are reducing improvements for safer working condi-
performed. tions. All those are valuable benefits of the JSA.
When making a planned safety observation, However, the major safety benefits are those
decide in advance which one of your workers and which come from using the completed JSA. You
what specific job you will observe. Correct any can make good use of the JSA in the following
unsafe practices you observe at that time. If you areas:
observe no unsafe practices, compliment the per-
son. Always make a record of whom you observed Initial job safety training
and what job they were doing; that information
will help you in future planned observations. Regular safety contacts
To do a good job of detecting unsafe prac-
tices, you need to use all three types of safety Pre-job safety instructions
observationseach supplements the others.
Together they accomplish the maximum detection Cost-reduction studies
of unsafe practices.
Fill out a Workplace Monitoring Plan,
WHAT JOBS TO OBSERVE OPNAV 5100/14 (fig. 6-2), when making safety
observations and job analyses; or make your own
You cannot, and need not, observe every job form appropriate to your specific work place.
a person does. Not all jobs are equally hazardous.
Some jobs rarely or never produce mishaps; others
have a reputation for producing mishaps. As a ENLISTED SAFETY COMMITTEE
supervisor you have limited time for safety
observations because you have many other tasks. Your commands Enlisted Safety Committee
Therefore, concentrate on observing the jobs most makes recommendations concerning the com-
likely to produce mishaps. Put priority on observ- mand safety program. These recommendations
ing jobs known to be hazardous and those which are submitted to the safety council (at the depart-
have the greatest potential for producing serious ment head level) where they are reviewed for
injury or loss. appropriate action. Your command safety com-
mittee convenes to exchange information; im-
prove communications; review conditions,
JOB SAFETY ANALYSIS mishaps, and injuries; and suggest improvements.
It also convenes to make written safety recom-
A job safety analysis (JSA) is the study of a mendations to the safety council and the com-
job to (1) identify possible hazards or potential manding officer. These meetings should convene
mishaps and (2) develop solutions to eliminate, monthly in an effort to enhance interdepartmental

6-4
SAFETY ENFORCEMENT NAVY OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY
AND HEALTH (NAVOSH)
The safety organization must continually PROGRAM
monitor measures taken to ensure the command
meets established safety standards and criteria. The Navys Occupational Safety and Health
The best policing system is one of self-policing (NAVOSH) Program covers all Navy safety areas.
by both supervisory personnel and workers. Those areas include aviation; weapons and ex-
To evaluate safety enforcement, monitor the plosives; off-duty safety (recreation, public, and
adequacy of inspections of mishap prevention traffic); and occupational safety as well as occupa-
measures, the supervision of routine work, and tional health. The NAVOSH Program specifically
special command evolutions. Monitor your divi- addresses the maintenance of safe and healthful
sions adherence to prescribed operating and main- conditions in the work place. All levels of com-
tenance procedures. Also monitor the correction mand within the naval ashore and afloat establish-
of inspection discrepancies, the submission of ments must begin and manage a NAVOSH
work requests, and the full use of the 3-M systems. Program based on OPNAVINST 5100.23B. Each
As shown by the following quotation, com- Navy member must comply with all NAVOSH
placency, haste to complete a job, and the standards and applicable rules, regulations, and
it-cant-happen-to-me attitude all tend to oppose orders. Violators of NAVOSH regulations or in-
an effective self-policing safety program. Although structions are subject to disciplinary action based
many people may be familiar with that quotation, on the Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ).
its safety message is one all should know. Personnel must report to their supervisor all
observed work place hazards, injuries, occupa-
tional illnesses, or property damage resulting from
THE ENEMY an accident.

I am more powerful than the combined INDUSTRIAL EQUIPMENT


armies of the world. I have destroyed SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
more men than all the wars of all nations.
I massacre thousands of people every year. Industrial equipment includes all fixed or por-
I am more deadly than bullets, and I have table electric-, electronic-, pneumatic-, and
wrecked more homes than the mightiest hydraulic-powered tools used in repairing, main-
guns. taining, calibrating, or testing equipment.
In the United States alone, I steal Before assigning personnel to operate or repair
over 500 million dollars each year. I spare industrial equipment, make sure they have
no one, and I find my victims among the demonstrated a practical knowledge of its opera-
rich and poor alike, the young and old, the tion or repair and of all applicable safety precau-
strong and weak. Widows know me to tions. Before allowing personnel to operate
their everlasting sorrow. I loom up in industrial equipment, make certain the equipment
such proportions that I cast my shadow is in good working condition and all installed or
over every field of labor. attached safety features are in place and work-
I lurk in unseen places and do most ing. Do not allow personnel to operate defective
of my work silently. You can be warned equipment until it is suitably repaired. Disconnect
against me, yet, you heed me not. I am any equipment requiring repair from its power
relentless, merciless and cruel. I am source and tag it out, following OPNAVINST
everywherein the home, on the streets, in 3120.32B, until repair is completed. To minimize
the factory, at railroad crossings, on land, possible injuries, post operating instructions and
in the air, on the sea. safety precautions at each piece of equipment and
I bring sickness, degradation and death locate warning plates where everyone can see
yet few seek me out to destroy me. I crush, them.
I maim, and I wiIl give you nothing and
rob you of all you have. I am your worst PNEUMATIC TOOLS
enemyI am CARELESSNESS.
Only allow authorized and trained personnel to
Author Unknown operate pneumatic tools, and make sure those per-
sonnel wear and use personal protective devices.

6-7
HAZARDOUS WASTE/MATERIAL and booties. Make certain each person
PETTY OFFICER tapes gloves and booties to the sleeves and
legs of the coveralls.
As a senior petty officer, you maybe assigned
as the hazardous waste/material petty officer. As 4. Provide each member of the team with a
the hazardous waste/material petty officer, you continuous-flow air-line respirator with full
are responsible for the proper labeling, handling, faceplate.
and storage procedures of hazardous material and
5. Make sure members wet the asbestos in-
hazardous waste. You are also responsible for
sulation before removing it. Provide
training division personnel in the proper handling
portable vacuum cleaners designed with
and use of hazardous materials and hazardous
special filters for use during the rip out
waste disposal. You must always be on the
and cleanup. Make sure members put all
lookout for hazardous material/waste safety
scraps in special bags and attach caution
violations.
labels to the bags.

ASBESTOS For more detailed information on protective


measures, refer to Naval Ships Technical Manual
For many years, the Navy used asbestos (NSTM), chapter 635, Thermal, Fire and Acoustic
as the primary insulation (lagging) material Installation.
in high-temperature machinery, boilers, and
the piping of boiler plants at shore facil-
ities. Asbestos is now recognized as a major RESPIRATORY PROTECTION
health hazard. Inhaling asbestos fibers can
result in a lung disease known as asbestosis. Many repair and maintenance operations
Asbestos exposure has also been associated generate air contaminants that can be dan-
with cancer of the lung. Aboard ship, many gerous if inhaled. See that your people are
pipes and boilers are still insulated with properly protected from such contaminants.
asbestos. However, the Navy has instituted These contaminants may be in the form of dust,
a program to use less harmful materials, such as fumes, gas, or mist or fog from sprays and spray
fibrous glass, for pipe and boiler insulation. painting.
Asbestos insulation cannot be removed except
for an emergency as approved by the commanding The commanding officer of each unit
officer. designates a program manager for respiratory pro-
tection, usually the units safety officer or gas-
free engineering officer. The program manager
CONTROL MEASURES FOR trains safety petty officers (SPOs) or damage con-
ASBESTOS REMOVAL trol petty officers (DCPOs) in selecting, fit-testing,
and maintaining respirators. The designated
If you or your people are required to rip out department/division SPO or DCPO does the
asbestos insulation, take the following control following:
measures:
1. Provides annual training on respirator
1. Arrange for each person assigned to a selection, use, care, and maintenance
rip-out team to receive a special physical
examination. 2. Issues respirators appropriate for protec-
tion against the hazardous exposure
2. Make certain each rip-out team consists of
three qualified persons, including one 3. Monitors the use, cleaning, and reissue of
supervisor. respirators and provides the program
manager with a monthly program report
3. Provide each person on the team with the
following complete set of protective cloth- 4. Assures continuing availability of the
ing: special overalls, head covering, gloves, required respiratory protection

6-9
Figure 6-5.Supplied-air system.

injury may result if the respirator or its air line fails.

The self-contained breathing apparatus (SCBA)


(fig. 6-6) provides protection in oxygen-deficient
environments or other environments dangerous to
life or health. Since the SCBA is the most complex
respirator in use today, use it only after receiving
proper training in its use. Use the oxygen breathing
apparatus (OBA) only in emergency situations. Use
Mark V gas masks only for protection against
chemical warfare agents and high airborne
radioactivity levels. Surgical masks are for medical
use only; never use them in place of a filter
respirator.

IDENTIFICATION
OF RESPIRATOR CARTRIDGES
AND GAS MASK CANISTERS

Each air-purifying respirator cartridge type is


designed specifically for the class of contaminant it
removes. Federal regulations require each cartridge
type to be color-coded. The color-coding may be in the
form of an affixed label or a colored plastic cartridge
case. To identify the type to be worn for protection
Figure 6-6.Self-contained breathing apparatus against a
(SCBA).

6-11
particular atmospheric contaminant, refer to Education is vital to the overall success of a
table 6-1. hearing conservation program. Make sure your
personnel receive instruction in and understand
NOTE: When labels only are colored, the cart- the rationale for the following elements of the
ridge or canister will either be gray or a natural hearing conservation program:
metallic color. The National Institute for Occupa-
tional Safety and Health (NIOSH) must approve 1. Proper wearing and maintenance of
all cartridges. hearing-protective devices
2. The command program and personnel
The color-coded label also specifies the max- responsibilities for off-duty practices to
imum contaminant concentration level against help protect hearing
which the cartridge or canister provides protec-
tion. For example, a label may read as follows: Encourage your personnel to use hearing-
protective devices during off-duty activities when
DO NOT WEAR IN ATMOSPHERES
they are exposed to hazardous noise sources, such
IMMEDIATELY DANGEROUS TO
as lawn mowers, chain saws, and firearms. All
LIFE. MUST BE USED IN AREAS
personnel exposed to gunfire in a training situa-
CONTAINING AT LEAST 20% OXY-
tion or to artillery or missile firing under any cir-
GEN. DO NOT WEAR IN ATMO-
cumstances must wear hearing-protective devices.
SPHERES CONTAINING MORE THAN
If your personnel must work in hazardous
1/10% ORGANIC VAPORS BY VOL-
noise areas or with equipment that produces
UME. REFER TO COMPLETE LABEL
sound levels greater than 84 dB or peak sound
ON RESPIRATOR OR CARTRIDGE
pressure levels of 140 dB, enter them in a hear-
CONTAINER FOR ASSEMBLY, MAIN-
ing testing program. Personnel should have
TENANCE, AND USE.
received a reference hearing test upon entry into
NOTE: The 20% oxygen requirement naval service. Do not assign personnel who do not
cited above does not apply to submarines, have a reference hearing test in their health record
which may operate with an atmosphere of to duty in designated hazardous noise areas until
as low as 18.5% oxygen. they receive a reference hearing test. All person-
nel should receive a hearing test periodically and
before termination of naval service.
HEARING CONSERVATION
AND NOISE ABATEMENT
HEAT STRESS
Hearing loss is recognized as an occupational
hazard related to certain trades. For example, Heat stress is the strain placed on the body
gunfire and rocket fire produce high-intensity im- as it attempts to regulate its temperature as a result
pulse or blast noises, which can cause hearing loss. of any combination of air temperature, thermal
Hearing loss can also result from the continuous radiation, humidity, air flow, and work load. This
or intermittent noises of aircraft and marine condition can readily produce fatigue, severe
engines and industrial activities. Hearing loss has headache, nausea, and poor physical and mental
been and continues to be a serious concern. performance. Prolonged exposure will cause heat
Therefore, the Navy has developed a hearing con- exhaustion or heat stroke and severe impairment
servation program to prevent occupational noise- of the bodys temperature-regulating ability. If
related hearing loss. The program requires the not properly treated, these conditions can be life
following preventive measures: threatening.
Adhere to the commands Heat Stress Pro-
1. The survey of work environments to iden- gram by reporting heat stress conditions as they
tify potentially hazardous noise levels and occur. Educate your division about the Heat
to identify personnel at risk Stress Program, the identification of heat stress
2. The modification of environments that conditions, stay time, and rotation of personnel.
contain, or equipment that produces, Heat stress has occurred in engineering spaces,
potentially hazardous noise to reduce the laundries, sculleries, steam catapult spaces, and
noise level to acceptable levels whenever workshops aboard our ships. In many instances,
technologically and economically feasible clogged ventilation systems, damaged or missing

6-12
The PHEL curves are accurate for normal, You have a duty to yourself and the people
healthy personnel who have had adequate rest (6 you work with to know and enforce all safety
hours sleep in the past 24 hours) and adequate regulations. Before assigning personnel to a task
recovery time from previous heat stress exposure that can harm them in any way, ensure they are
(2 hours recovery for every 1 hour of exposure, familiar with and know the correct safety pro-
or 4 hours maximum). cedures. Check to see that they wear the proper
Develop a working knowledge of all aspects protective clothing, use the correct respirator for
of this program so that you can recognize heat the work being performed, and have adequate eye
stress conditions as or if they occur. Then take and hearing protection. Take no short cuts in
proper actions. doing a job safely. Obtain copies of OPNAVINST
5100.23B, Naval Occupational Safety and Health
(NAVOSH) Program Manual, and OPNAVINST
SIGHT CONSERVATION 5100.19B, NAVOSH Manual for Forces Afloat.
Become familiar with them, Remember the old
Navy policy requires the provision of eye adage The life you save may be your own.
protection for Navy personnel working in eye-
hazardous areas at government expense. Person-
nel must wear eye protection while performing any EQUIPMENT TAG-OUT LOG
eye-hazardous operations. Eye-hazardous opera-
The equipment tag-out log is the controlling
tions include pouring or handling molten metals
document for the entire tag-out procedure. The
or corrosive liquids and solids, cutting and
number of tag-out logs maintained depends on
welding, drilling, grinding, chipping, and sand-
the ships size. For example, a minesweeper may
blasting or other dust producing operations. Any
only require one tag-out log for the whole ship,
persons in the vicinity of such operations must
while a major combatant may require a separate
also wear eye-protective equipment.
log for each department. Individual force com-
All Navy activities that perform eye-hazardous
manders specify the number of logs various ship
operations must have a sight conservation pro-
classes must maintain and the areas in which the
gram. The program should include, but not be
ship will maintain them.
restricted to, the following:
On ships maintaining more than one tag-out
log, authorizing officers must exchange informa-
1. Determination and evaluation of eye-
tion concerning tag-out actions. When a tag-out
hazardous areas, processes, and occupa-
affects other authorizing officers, the initiating
tions
party obtains verbal permission from those of-
2. Operation of a vision-screening program
ficers to tag-out the system or equipment in ques-
3. An effective equipment maintenance pro-
tion before authorizing the tag-out. Examples of
gram
systems that may require such coordination are
4. Procedures for the use of temporary eye
ships service electrical distribution, hydraulics,
wear
air, ventilation, and air-conditioning chill-water
5. A comprehensive training/education pro-
systems.
gram
The tag-out log is a record of authorization
6. An effective enforcement program
of each effective tag-out action. It contains the
following documents:
To establish an effective sight conservation
program, the safety officer must identify eye- 1. A copy of the main instruction and any
hazardous areas and post appropriate warning other amplifying directives for administer-
signs. Commands must equip all areas where per- ing the system (These documents are kept
sonnel maybe exposed to corrosive materials with in the front of the log.)
emergency eyewash facilities. The Navy considers 2. A DANGER/CAUTION tag-out index
any person found to have vision in one eye of and record of audits (index/audit record)
20/200 or worse to be visually impaired. You can- (The index/audit record provides a sequen-
not assign people who have visual impairment to tial list of all tag-outs and ensures serial
duties that present a hazard to their remaining eye. numbers are sequentially issued. They are
Make certain these personnel wear protective eye used in audits of the log. The cognizant
wear at all times, regardless of their occupation department head may remove the index
or work station. page with all tag-outs listed as cleared.)

6-14
3. A log on one effective DANGER/ under some conditions. Audit all outstanding tag-
CAUTION tag-out record sheet of all tags out sheets against the index/audit record section.
associated with tag-out of systems and As part of the audit, check each tag-out record
components for the stated reason(s) (This sheet for completeness and check the installed
log helps identify all tags associated with tags. Make sure the positions of valves or switches
the stated reason(s). All effective sheets are havent been changed from the description on the
kept in one section of the log.) tag, the label, and the record sheet. Log the date
4. Cleared DANGER/CAUTION tag-out and time on each tag-out record sheet. Note any
record sheets that have been cleared and discrepancies you found (if you found none, note
completed (These sheets are kept in the that also) followed by your signature. Your
log until received and removed by the signature verifies the log is up to date.
cognizant department head.)
SURVIVAL
INSTRUMENT LOG
Survival requires the desire and ability to live.
Labels associated with OUT-OF-COMMIS- In a survival situation, you may find yourself in
SION and OUT-OF-CALIBRATION instruments unusual conditions of deprivation, emotional
are logged in the instrument log. This log con- shock, and hardship. These conditions may oc-
tains record sheets identifying various instruments cur for an indefinite period. They are often
that are out of commission or out of calibration. brought about by the forced landing of an air-
The authorizing officer signs the labels and the craft at sea or in a remote jungle, a desert, or an
record sheets and signs for the clearing of the Arctic land area.
items from the record sheets. Survival depends on you. You must be
physically fit and know how to locate or collect
RECORD SHEETS water. You must know what plants and animals
are available for food, how to find or catch them,
Some ships going through an overhaul have how to prepare them, and how to recognize those
used between 2,000 and 3,000 DANGER/CAU- which will harm you. The more you know about
TION tags. A record sheet keeps track of all these the conditions peculiar to the region you are in,
tags. The front of the record sheet contains the including the plant and animal life, the better are
name of the system or component, serial number your chances for survival.
of the tag-out, date and time of tag-out issue, and You can remain alive anywhere in the world
reason for the tag-out. It also has a place for when you keep your wits. Remember that nature
documentation (blueprints, rip-outs, and so forth) and the elements are neither your friend nor your
and authorizing signatures. On the back of the enemy. By using your wits, you can make them
record sheet, you will find a record of the number work for you instead of allowing them to work
of the tags, the person hanging the tags, and the against you.
person second-checking all the tags. It also con- Before learning basic survival facts, you first
tains the authorization for clearance of the tags need to understand the psychological obstacles of
by the authorizing officer and the repair activity survival. Those obstacles all have in common that
representative. The record includes the date and very normal human emotion called fear: fear of
time of removal of the tags along with the initials the unknown, fear of discomfort, fear of people,
of the person(s) removing them. After the tags and fear of ones weaknesses. Fear of the environ-
have been cleared and the record sheet properly ment leads us to fear the discomfort we may
filled out for the removal of the tags, the sheet suffer.
is put in the back of the tag-out log in the cleared Although you may have many natural fears
section for destruction at a later time. The date in a survival situation, they need not be a
and time cleared are recorded in the tag-out index/ drawback. Fear is the reaction that enables you
audit record. to get out of the situation youre in. If you con-
trol it, fear is a very valuable tool for survival,
AUDITS but you must recognize its presence. Proper train-
ing lessens the fear of the unknown. By adding
Audits are an important part of the tag-out your equipment and survival knowledge to your
system. You should audit every 2 weeks, except will to survive, you can survive with much less
on nuclear-powered ships, where you audit weekly discomfort and risk of bodily injury.

6-15
Normal reaction to basic human fear can be is equally important. Since you could also find
very useful. When you are afraid, your body be- yourself as the senior person in a survival situa-
comes more alert, you hear better, you see better, tion, you need to know your authority and respon-
and you can perform amazing feats of strength. sibilities.
Even though we overcome our fears to some
extent, a lack of confidence in our strength and AUTHORITY AND
ability may seriously weaken our will to survive. RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE
Therefore, you must prepare, both physically and SENIOR PERSON IN A
psychologically, to deal with stresses in survival SURVIVAL SITUATION
situations.
We have each acquired, to some degree, many You have worked hard to advance to your
personality traits that are helpful in a survival position of leadership. One of the most impor-
situation. Most of us have come through some tant responsibilities you may have is to function
difficult, drawn out, emotionally draining prob- as the senior person in a survival situation. That
lems. We have learned the value of persistence and is where the leadership skills you have been work-
perseverance when the odds seemed against us. ing on will pay off. You will be responsible for
Reaching a coveted goal in sports requires such the lives of your shipmates and for seeing that they
traits. You may have surmounted moments of are safe.
danger or crisis with a physical or psychological Navy Regulations and article IV of the Code
strength you didnt know you had. of Conduct give the senior person in a survival
The key to survival is your attitude. The situation the authority to take charge. Even if you
development of at least twelve important traits, are not the senior person in charge, you have the
or characteristics, will help you develop a survival responsibility to fully back the senior person in
attiude: charge. If the senior member becomes injured or
dies and you are the next senior person, you will
Courage assume responsibility for your group. The
members of your group will depend on you to lead
Determination them in evading the enemy and reaching safety.
Although you have the authority and respon-
Cheerfulness sibility of leadership, listen to your subordinates,
as they may have useful ideas. Survival requires
Positiveness every person to give 100 percent toward a group
effort. Failure on one persons part could cause
Flexibility the group to end up in a prisoner-of-war camp.
Think before you act, and weigh every situation
Willingness carefully. Use the helpful ideas of the group.

Purpose ASHORE

Attentiveness Survival ashore becomes a personal struggle


between the environment and the specific qualities
Confidence people bring to the situation. Disaster subjects
people to severe stresses they are not normally ex-
Productiveness posed to. Some people remain remarkably calm
for varying periods, even under extreme stress.
Persistence Others, however, become overwhelmed by
disaster and unable to cope with what might be
Certainty a life-threatening situation. People suffer the
worst reactions when, with little or no warning
We cannot overemphasize the importance of or preparation, they suddenly find themselves in
developing these traits. They can be more valuable an unstructured and undefined situation.
to your survival than your survival equipment. When you are faced with a survival situation
You could find yourself in two types of on land, remember several facts. The obstacles
survival situationssurvival ashore and survival to overcome arent so much physical as mental.
at sea. Knowing how to survive in each situation In all probability, others have survived in that

6-16
The following mistakes can lead to capture for Escape is tough; not being caught after escape
you and your group: is even tougher. Escape demands courage,
cunning, and much planningof ways to escape,
1. Lack of, or insufficient, preparation and a route to follow, and the location of friends.
poor physical condition Above all, escape demands physical stamina
2. Absence of either opportunity or motiva- stamina you must acquire under the worst con-
tion ditions imaginable. Experience has proven that
3. Failure to realize civilians areas dangerous model camps with regular rations and con-
to an evader as members of the military siderate treatment are the exception. But no mat-
4. Attempting to fit into the society rather ter what extremes you encounter as a POW, strive
than into the background to keep yourself physically able and sufficiently
5. Knowing nothing about the topography, equipped to escape as soon as possible.
climate, or people of the area If you are captured, try to make your escape
6. Not knowing how to use your equipment, early. You may never be in any better physical
where it is located, or its purpose (and condition to escape than at that moment. Prison
thus its value) rations barely sustain life, certainly not enough
7. Failure to use any opportunity to leave to build up a reserve of energy. The physical treat-
the vicinity of your landing when the ment, lack of medical care, and insufficient
enemy is in the area rations of prison life soon show their effects in
8. Failure to properly hide discarded equip- morale and physical weakness, night blindness,
ment or trash and loss of coordination and reasoning power.
9. Improper cover and concealment while There are other reasons for making your
traveling escape early after your capture. Friendly artillery
10. Improper and careless use of fire fire and air strikes occurring during that time may
11. Ineffective and insufficient camouflage of increase your chances of getting away. The first
persons, equipment, and shelter guards you will have are not as well trained in
12. Leaving evidence of passage, such as handling prisoners as those farther back from the
tracks in soft ground and broken twigs front lines. Some of the first-line guards may even
13. Approaching members of the local be walking wounded who are distracted by their
population, assuming them to be friendly own condition. In addition, you know something
14. Lack of noise discipline about the terrain where you are captured, and you
15. Traveling too near to roads, streams, know the approximate location of friendly units.
lakes, or populated areas Several days later and many miles away, you may
16. Not treating injuries, which can later be in strange territory. An escape from a POW
weaken your evasion chances camp is much more difficult and requires more
17. Failure to use deceptive techniques while detailed planning. It must be organized and sup-
procuring domestic plants and animals ported as any other military operation.
18. Taking easy, short travel routes The misfortune of being captured by the
enemy does not end your usefulness to your
You must consider a lot of conditions when country. Your duty is to continue to resist the
evading the enemy. Remember, you and your enemy by all possible means, to escape, and to
group will probably be captured if you are seen. help others escape.
While a prisoner of war, never accept special
Prisoner-of-War (POW) Camp favors in return for your promise not to escape
or a promise to provide the enemy with informa-
What happens if you and your group become tion. Informing, or any other action endanger-
prisoners of war? After all, that is possible. Isola- ing the well-being of a fellow prisoner, is
tion, fear, injuryall work in favor of the enemy FORBIDDEN. Prisoners of war may not help the
to increase your chances of capture in spite of a enemy by identifying fellow prisoners who may
determined effort on your part to evade. The sur- have valuable knowledge.
render of your arms, however, doesnt mean you If you are the senior person in a POW camp,
forfeit your responsibilities as an American ser- you must provide strong leadership to maintain
viceperson. The Code of Conduct directs that you discipline. Organization, resistance, and even sur-
begin planning your escape the minute you are vival may be extremely difficult without discipline.
taken prisoner. Therefore, discipline yourself and your group to

6-18
maintain personal hygiene and sanitation and to dragged through the brush. The interrogations
care for the sick and wounded. and beatings continued for 3 days, but LTJG
All United States officers and noncommis- Dengler refused to give in. Later he escaped from
sioned officers should continue to carry out their his guards but was recaptured and again severely
responsibilities and exercise their authority if cap- beaten. After 6 months in captivity, LTJG
tured. The senior line officer or noncommissioned Dengler successfully escaped, killing several
officer within the group of prisoners assumes guards in the process. On the 17th day, a pilot
command according to rank or date of rank, who escaped with him was killed, and LTJG
without regard to his or her branch of service. Dengler had to continue alone. Although suffer-
That person is the lawful superior of all lower ing from malnutrition, jaundice, fatigue, and
ranking personnel. If the senior officer or non- badly cut and swollen feet, LTJG Dengler refused
commissioned officer is incapacitated or unable to give up. Finally, on the 22nd day after his
to command for any reason, the next senior per- escape, he managed to lay out a crude SOS on
son will assume command. a bed of rocks, which attracted the attention of
Article I of the Code of Conduct says I am a United States Air Force aircraft. Later, a rescue
an American, fighting in the forces which guard helicopter ended his ordeal by plucking him to
my country and our way of life. I am prepared safety.
to give my life in their defense. These are perhaps The stories of personnel who steadfastly
the most important words of the Code, because followed both the spirit and letter of the Code of
they signify the faith and confidence of Americans Conduct are numerous.
in their government, their country, and their Full compliance with the laws of armed con-
service. From the time John Paul Jones made his flict is not always easy, especially when you are
defiant reply I have not yet begun to fight to a POW. For instance, you might be extremely
the present, Americans have traditionally fought angry and upset because you were taken prisoner.
wherever the enemy was and with whatever But you should NEVER engage in reprisals or acts
weapons were available. When captured, the of revenge that violate the Code of Conduct,
Americans have continued the battle in a new
arena. When facing an enemy interrogator, they AT SEA
have been under fire just as though bullets
and shell fragments were flying around them. Survival at sea depends upon your knowledge,
Disarmed, POWs have fought back with mind your equipment, your self-control, and your train-
and spirit, remaining faithful to their fellow ing. Basic Military Requirements provides a good
POWs, yielding no military information, and review of survival equipment, abandoning ship
resisting every attempt of indoctrination. Each of procedures, and at-sea survival hints.
us has the responsibility to honor these traditions Think of the vastness of both military and
by carefully adhering to the meaning of each commercial operations at sea. Then you can
article of the Code of Conduct. The many realize the dangers the crews and passengers face
Americans who have accepted that responsibil- under such a wide range of environmental
ity are heroes in the finest sense of the word. conditions.
One such hero was Lieutenant (Junior Grade) As the senior person in an at-sea survival situa-
Dieter Dengler, USNR. In February 1966 LTJG tion, your responsibilities are great. First you must
Dengler was on a bombing mission over North make sure your group is afloat and safe. Then
Vietnam when his aircraft was badly damaged by you must know how to operate the equipment
ground fire. LTJG Dengler crash-landed his air- available to you and ration food and water.
craft in nearby Laos and attempted to evade cap- Take charge of the situation and remain
ture. After successfully evading the enemy for 1 calmthat will greatly increase your chance for
day, he was captured and led to a village where survival. Talk to your people; do your best to keep
he was interrogated and told to sign a Communist morale up by singing, praying, joking, or telling
propaganda statement condemning the United stories. Keep the others involved. Remember, as
States. LTJG Denglers repeated refusal to give long as you are alive, the chance for rescue is
more than his name, rank, service number, date excellent.
of birth, or to sign any statements resulted in Dont sell short the value of group support.
severe beatings. Many survival experiences have proven that stick-
When he continued to refuse to answer ques- ing together as a group may make the difference
tions, he was tied behind a water buffalo and in surviving an ordeal.

6-19
GROUP SURVIVAL on input from their staff. Above all else, never
appear indecisive.
The best chance for survival belongs to the If situations require you to act immediately,
group that works TOGETHER and has a leader consider the facts and make decisions rapidly. The
who accepts responsibility for the group. When ability to think on your feet usually determines
you are the senior person, accept responsibility successful survival.
for your group by taking steps to lead members
to work together. BASIC ELEMENTS OF SURVIVAL
Organize group survival activities. Group sur-
vival depends largely upon the organization of its You can reduce, or even avoid, the shock
manpower. Organized action by group members of finding yourself isolated behind enemy lines,
who know what to do and when to do it, during in enemy hands, or in a desolated area.
ordinary circumstances and during a crisis, Just remember the basic elements of sur-
prevents panic. Keeping the group informed, vival represented by each letter in the word
devising a plan, and sticking to the plan helps S-U-R-V-I-V-A-L shown in figure 6-7.
achieve organization.
Assign each person a task that fits his or her SSize up the situation by consider-
personal qualifications. If one person can catch ing yourself, the country, and the enemy.
fish but cannot cook, let that person provide the
fish. Always learn each members special skills so When you think about yourself and your
that you can use each person to the greatest group, hope for the best, but be prepared for the
benefit of the group. worst. Recall what you have read about survival
Assume command and establish a chain of and expect it to work. That will give you con-
command that includes all members of the group. fidence that you and your group can survive,
Good leadership lessens panic, confusion, and which will increase your chances for success. Get
disorganization. Make certain each person knows to a safe, comfortable place as quickly as possi-
his or her position in the chain of command and ble. Once you find a safe place, look at your situa-
is familiar with the duties of every other person, tion, think, and form a plan. Your fear will lessen
especially your duties as the senior member. while your confidence will increase. Be calm and
Under no circumstances leave leadership of the cautious until you know where you are and where
group to chance acceptance by some member after you are going.
a situation arises. Being in a strange country may cause part of
Maintain respect for your leadership by using your fear. Therefore, try to determine where you
it wisely; be the leader and set the example. Group are by landmarks, by compass directions, or by
survival is a test of effective leadership. Watch recalling intelligence information passed onto you
out for problems that could turn into serious by your leaders.
arguments. Keep troublemakers from attracting Think about what moves the enemy might
undue attention, and keep those who may crack make by putting yourself in the enemys shoes.
up from disrupting the group. Prevent care- What would you do? Watch the enemys habits
lessness caused by fatigue, hunger, and cold. and routines. Base your plans on your observa-
Know yourself and the members of your group; tions. Remember, you know where the enemy is,
take responsibility for each persons welfare. but the enemy does not know where you are.
Develop a feeling of mutual dependence within
the group by stressing that each person depends UUndue haste makes waste.
on the others for survival. Emphasize that the
group will not leave the wounded or injured Dont be too eager to move. Acting hastily
behindthat each members responsibility is to makes you careless and impatient, causing you to
make sure the group returns intact. A feeling of take unnecessary risks. Dont end up like the man
mutual dependence fosters high morale and unity. who rushed ahead without any plan. He tried to
Each member receives support and strength from travel at night but only injured himself by bump-
the others. ing into trees and fences. Instead of lying low and
Make the decisions no matter what the situa- trying to evade the enemy, he fired at them with
tion. However, base your decisions on the infor- his rifle and was caught. Dont lose your temper.
mation and advice of other members of the Loss of self-control may cause wrong thinking
groupmuch as admirals make decisions based and poor judgment. When something irritating

6-20
Your involvement in mishap prevention may REFERENCES
only have been that of a safety-conscious person
trying to do your job as effectively and safely as Naval Safety Supervisor, NAVEDTRA 10808-2,
possible. However, you may gain greater respon- Naval Education and Training Program
sibilities by being appointed as division safety Management Support Activity, Pensacola,
petty officer. In that position, you must become Fla., 1988.
more aware of unsafe working conditions and be
prepared to take immediate action to correct
Naval Ships Technical Manual, S9086-AA-
them. Without your help, a near mishap today STM-010, Chapter 001, GeneralNSTM
could be a fatal mishap tomorrow.
Publications Index and User Guide,
The Navy has gone to great expense to train
Naval Sea Systems Command, Washington,
people like you to run its ships safely. Without
D,C., 1987.
you and your shipmates, we would not have a
Navy. Personnel safety is not automatic; it must
be practiced constantly. The Navy still has in- NAVOSH Manual for Forces Afloat, OP-
juries, but they are less frequent than they were NAVINST 5100.19B, Office of the Chief
in the past because crew members now practice of Naval Operations, Washington, D.C.,
good safety habits. 1985.
You are responsible for the functions of the
safety organization within your ship or unit. You Navy Occupational Safety and Health (NAV-
must promote safety, safety publications, and OSH) Program Manual, OPNAVINST
safety instructions. 5100.23B, Office of the Chief of Naval
The tag-out system is an important part of the Operations, Washington, D.C., 1983.
safety organization. Without it, we would have
a great increase in injuries and deaths. It is a work-
ing system that, if correctly used, will save many Seabee Combat Handbook, NAVEDTRA
lives. 10479-C3, Naval Education and Training
Every ship follows safety procedures for Program Management Support Activity,
hazardous waste and material control. If you are Pensacola, Fla., 1989.
assigned as the hazardous waste/material control
petty officer, your will be responsible for those Shipboard Hazardous Materials/Hazardous
procedures. Waste Management Plan, NAVSEA 59593-
The Navy is safety-conscious. Always prac- A7-PLN-010, Naval Sea Systems Command,
tice safety, whether on or off ship. The Navy and Washington, D.C., 1983.
your loved ones value you and want you to be as
safe as possible.
At some time you and your shipmates may Shipboard Heat Stress Control and Personnel
Protection, OPNAVINST 5100.20C, Office of
find yourselves in a survival situation; you could
be the person in charge. If that happens, you will the Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
have the responsibility of keeping yourself and D.C., 1985.
your people alive until you are rescued. Therefore,
you must know the basic elements of evasion, sur- Standard Organization and Regulations of the
vival at sea, survival ashore, and group survival. U.S. Navy, OPNAVINST 3120.32B, Office of
If you find yourself in a survival situation, the Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
remember to NEVER GIVE UP HOPE. D.C., 1986.

6-22
CHAPTER 7

DAMAGE CONTROL
LEARNING OBJECTIVES

Upon completion of this chapter, you should be able to do the following:

1. Describe the objectives of damage control. 12. Identify the types of damage control com-
munications.
2. Describe the damage control responsibilities
of the commanding officer, executive officer, 13. Describe the purpose of and rules observed
officer of the deck, division officer, damage while administering first aid.
control petty officer, and work center damage
control petty officer. 14. Describe the hazards involved in a nuclear
weapons mishap incident.
3. Describe the damage control central organiza-
tion. 15. Identify the sources of damage control
4. Describe the assignments, responsibilities, information.
and dress requirements of repair parties and
teams. 16. Describe the hazards and non-nuclear effects
of a nuclear attack.
5. Describe the duties and responsibilities of the
on-scene leader. 17. Describe the effects and types of radiation
produced by a nuclear attack.
6. Describe the duties of the at-sea fire party.
7. Describe the procedures used for investigating 18. Describe how biological warfare agents are
flooding, structural damage, and fires. disseminated, detected, and identified.

8. Identify the classes of fire and extinguishing 19. Describe the characteristics and classifications
agents used in damage control. of chemical warfare agents.
9. Describe the methods used to prevent the 20. Describe the effects of and treatment for
spread of fires. chemical warfare agents.
10. Describe the method used to control flooding.
21. Describe the objectives and phases of disaster
11. Describe the two types of flooding. control ashore.

Naval history is filled with instances that collision at sea (fig. 7-1) and recovered to serve
illustrate the important role damage control has again. On too many other occasions, however,
played in naval operations. Ships have been ships that should have been saved have been lost
damaged where their survival seemed impossible. because of needless failures in damage control
Yet, through gallant damage control efforts, these preparations and operations. It has been said that
ships have recovered to fight again. For example, if a ship survives the initial impact of damage,
the USS Belknap (CG-26) survived a terrible it has a good chance of being saved. Along with

7-1
3.282.4
Figure 7-1.USS Belknap (CG-26).

confidence in the integrity of their ships, all repair measures such as supplying casualty power,
party personnel should have confidence in their regaining a safe margin of stability and buoyancy,
ability to control all but the most devastating replacing essential structures, and manning
damage. essential equipment.

All members of the ships company should


OBJECTIVES OF realize the importance of their responsibilities.
DAMAGE CONTROL You should think of damage control as an
offensive as well as a defensive action upon which
The three basic objectives of shipboard damage your ships ability to inflict damage on the enemy
control are PREVENTION, MINIMIZATION, and may depend. Damage control not only is concerned
RESTORATION. with battle damage but also nonbattle damage.
This includes damage from fire, collision,
Prevention means to take all practical grounding, weather, and explosion. Damage
preliminary measures, such as maintaining water- control action may be necessary in port as well as
tight and fumetight integrity, providing reserve at sea and may involve the use of personnel and
buoyancy and stability, removing fire hazards, and facilities from an undamaged ship.
maintaining and distributing emergency
equipment before damage occurs. Damage control requires a detailed knowledge
of the ships construction, characteristics, com-
Minimization is to minimize and localize partmentation, and stability, and of apparatus
damage by taking measures to control flooding, placed on board to prevent or control damage.
preserve stability and buoyancy, combat fire, and Basically, control of damage depends upon the
provide first-aid treatment to injured personnel. ability and the initiative of personnel to take
prompt corrective action, using readily available
Restoration is to accomplish, as quickly as material. Having a thorough knowledge of the
possible, emergency repairs or restorations after ship will enable personnel to take the necessary
the occurrence of damage. Restoration requires corrective action.

7-2
RESPONSIBILITIES situations. The OOD should be able to analyze
a situation quickly and take prompt, positive,
All members of the ships company should and correct counteraction. The OODs ability to
know their damage control responsibilities and react properly and promptly will be directly
realize the importance of damage control. The proportional to his or her knowledge of the ship,
importance of efficient damage control cannot be damage control procedures, equipment available,
overemphasized. Damage control readiness can and training received.
only be achieved by a firm program stimulated
by effective and dynamic leadership. This program Division Officer
should be executed by enthusiastic, well-trained,
and determined officers and crew from all The division officer is responsible for taking
departments on board. While no area can be all practical preliminary measures before damage
fully covered, the basic responsibilities of key occurs, such as maintenance of watertight and air-
individuals in the damage control organization are tight integrity, removal of fire hazards, and
stated in the following paragraphs. upkeep of emergency equipment. Division officers
ensure that all equipment, closures, and markings
Commanding Officer under their cognizance are kept in the best possible
condition. This is done by periodic inspections,
Chapter 8, U.S. Navy Regulations, delineates adherence to planned maintenance system (PMS)
the various broad responsibilities of the com- checks by division damage control petty officers
manding officer (CO). For example, he or she (DDCPOs), and training of personnel within the
must maintain his or her command in a state division.
of maximum effectiveness for war or other
service . . . . Immediately after a battle or action, Damage Control Petty Officer
repair damages so far as possible, [and] exert every
effort to prepare the command for further A qualified senior petty officer in each division
service . . . . is designated as damage control petty officer
To carry out this charge, the commanding (DCPO). Section leaders of each section are
officer ensures the command is well trained and designated as duty DCPOs outside of normal
continually exercised in all aspects of damage working hours in port; they also perform the
control. The commanding officer should be fully duties of the DCPO at some time during their tour
aware of all of the ships weaknesses, including of duty. Division officers notify the fire marshal
the adequacy and operability of all damage and the damage control assistant (DCA) of DCPO
control equipment. and duty DCPO assignments and of any changes
to these assignments. DCPOs should have received
Executive Officer formal training and be qualified before assign-
ment.
The executive officer (XO) keeps the command DCPOs normally serve for a period of 6
advised of the status of the ships damage control months. They check in and out with the fire
readiness. The executive officer carries out the re- marshal and DCA upon being assigned to or
quirements of command damage control training, released from such duties.
including the ships readiness to combat all
casualties and damage caused by hostile acts or Duties and Responsibilities of the DCPO
other occurrences.
The DCPO and duty DCPOs (duty section
Officer of the Deck leaders) have the following duties and
responsibilities:
The officer of the deck (OOD) is the senior
Being acquainted with all phases of the ships
member of the underway watch team and is the
damage control, fire-fighting, and defense pro-
primary assistant to the commanding officer on
cedures
the bridge. The OOD should be intimately
familiar with the ship, its material condition, and Assisting in the instruction of division person-
established procedures for emergencies. The OOD nel in damage control, fire-fighting, and chemical,
should know and understand the correct course biological, and radiological (CBR) defense pro-
of action, or options, for various damage control cedures

7-3
Ensuring the preparation and maintenance of WORK CENTER DAMAGE
damage control checkoff lists for all spaces assigned CONTROL PETTY OFFICER

Supervising the setting of specified damage control Each work center will have a designated work center
material conditions within division spaces and making damage control petty officer (WCDCPO). WCDCPOs are
required reports supervisors responsible for matters concerning damage
control within their work centers. They have basically
Weighing portable C02 bottles, inspecting and testing the same duties and responsibilities as the DCPO but
damage control and fire-fighting equip-ment, and apply them to their respective work centers.
preparing required reports for approval of the division
officer in following the current ships instruction DAMAGE CONTROL
ORGANIZATION
Ensuring all battle lanterns, dog wrenches, spanners,
and other damage control equipment are in place and in The damage control administrative organiza-tion is
a usable condition in all division spaces an integral part of the engineering department.
However, each department has major administrative
Ensuring all compartments, piping, cables, and and preventive maintenance responsibilities to fulfill.
damage control and fire-fighting equipment are properly
stenciled or identified by color codes DAMAGE CONTROL
BATTLE ORGANIZATION
Posting safety precautions and operating instructions
in required division spaces The damage control battle organization includes
damage control central (DCC); repair parties for hull,
Assisting the division officer in inspecting division propulsion, electronics, weapons, and air; and battle
spaces for cleanliness and preservation and assisting in dressing stations. Each person within the organization
the preparation of required reports must be highly trained in all phases of damage control.
Ships should be self-sufficient, and ships personnel
Conducting daily inspections of division spaces for the should be able to take positive action to control any
elimination of fire hazards damage likely to occur. Provisions should be made for
relief of personnel engaged in arduous tasks, for battle
Performing such other duties with reference to messing, and for transition from one condition of
damage control and maintenance of division spaces as readiness to another. Positive,
may be directed by the division leading petty officer,
division officer, fire marshal, and DCA

COMMAND

ELECTRONICS PRIMARY
DAMAGE AT-SEA ENGINEERING WEAPONS CAUSUALTY FLIGHT
CONTROL FIRE PARTY (S) CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL

REPAIR 1 REPAIR 2 REPAIR 3 REPAIR 4 REPAIR 7 REPAIR 5 REPAIR 6 REPAIR 8

ORDANCE CRASH AND


DISPOSAL SALVAGE
TEAM TEAM

* MAIN
BATTLE CHAIN OF COMMAND
DRESSING - - - - - - - - - LIAISON/REPORTING AVIATION FUEL CONFLAGRATION
REPAIR TEAM STATION

* BATTLE DRESSING STATIONS WILL VARY WITH DIFFERENT CLASSES OF SHIPS. APPLICABLE STATIONS
FOR SPECIFIC SHIPS SHOULD BE DRAWN UNDER THE APPROPRIATE PARTY.

Figure 7-2.Damage control battle organization chart.

7-4
accurate, and rapid communications should take coordinate control of all damage the ship may suffer
place between all damage control parties, fire-fighting in battle, and it keeps the commanding officer
parties, or similar groups so that overall coordination advised of the capabilities of the ship after each
of effort and direction can be accomplished. The casualty. It trains repair parties to operate and
primary damage control battle organization repair control damage as independent units.
parties and teams are shown in figure 7-2. DCC personnel check all damage reports and the
The primary duty of the damage control corrective action being taken. DCC issues directions
organization is to control damage in order to keep the when repairs are not progressing satisfactorily,
ship fighting. Damage control objectives are attained damage is beyond the capabilities of the personnel
by taking the necessary action to do the following: involved, advice is requested, or corrective action in
progress is incorrect.
1. Preserve stability DCC maintains status boards showing struc-tural
2. Preserve watertight integrity (buoyancy) damage, location of flooding boundaries, condition of
3. Control list and trim propulsion, condition of electrical and casualty power
4. Maintain effective segregation of vital systems circuits, and corrective actions taken.
5. Prevent, isolate, combat, extinguish, and
remove the effects of fire REPAIR PARTIES AND TEAMS
6. Detect, confine, and remove the effects of
nuclear, biological, and/or chemical attack Each ship will have at least one repair party.
7. Assist in the care of injured personnel Some ships have as many as eight repair parties. In
8. Make rapid repairs to structures and addition, larger ships may have an ordnance disposal
equipment team, a crash and salvage team, or an aviation fuel
repair team. Each repair party will have an officer or
Ships designate one of the repair parties to act as a senior petty officer in charge. Composition of repair
SECONDARY DCC. The repair party designated as parties depends on the number of personnel
secondary DCC maintains status boards and available, type of ship, and area of responsibility. A
communications logs identical to those maintained by repair party organization chart is shown in figure 7-
DCC; it also directs control of damage in the event 3. All repair parties should have the following
DCC is unable to perform its function. capabilities:

FUNCTIONS OF DAMAGE
CONTROL CENTRAL
Making repairs to electrical and sound-
powered telephone circuits.

Damage control central (DCC) is the hub of the


ships damage control efforts. It is organized to

FIRE FIGHTING DAMAGE


NO. GO EVALUATION FLOOD AND CONTROL NBC DEFENSE MISC ASSIG REMARKS
CLO AND COMM A B C SMOKE CONTROL REPAIR

NAME

Figure 7-3.Repair party organization chart.


7-5
Repeat/Detailed Investigation level above and below it. You should look for
such items as splinter holes, ruptured pipelines,
Although a compartment has been inspected warped or fractured frames or stanchions, cracks,
and is free of fire and flooding, you should not open seams, leaky stuffing tubes, bent shafts,
assume it is secure; it must be reinspected. A fire improperly closed fittings, and severed electrical
can break out from undetected damage to an cables. You should note and quickly report any
electrical circuit or from a hot splinter buried in damaged bulkheads that require shoring. Circuit
combustible materials. Flooding may be caused breakers and electrical measuring instruments
by open or partly open valves, especially if mounted on switchboards may give information
intervening watertight boundaries fail. The initial/ on structural damage. When a circuit breaker trips
rapid investigation is a preliminary inspection. A in battle, it may be an indication of physical shock
detailed investigation is made as soon as possible or of an overload caused by damaged cables or
and in greater detail. This investigation should be equipment. Hot bearings on motors and hot
thorough; otherwise, the extent of secondary or electrical cables may also be indications of
minor damage could go undetected. Sound all structural damage. Identify and report the circuits
compartments, tanks, and voids adjacent to the or equipment quickly.
original point of damage to determine penetration
and flooding. Make detailed investigations of Investigation for Fires
every compartment after every hit, particularly
any compartment which lies within 50 feet of the An investigation for fires should not only
point of impact. (Fifty feet is the nominal distance detect fires but imminent causes of fires. You
from the point of impact that damage should should look for items such as smoke; warm
spread if the underwater protective system is bulkheads, hatches, or decks; peeling paint and
initially intact.) If any compartment on the tile; arcing wires; hot/jammed watertight doors
perimeter of this 50-foot arc shows the presence and hatches; and loss of lighting. These symptoms
of water, extend the investigation beyond the normally indicate that a fire is present. In
originally estimated levels until an intact water- addition you should inspect for spilled or ruptured
tight boundary is determined. fuel or flammable liquid tanks and containers;
wreckage; loose stores; and broken or damaged
Investigation for Flooding electrical controllers, power panels, and switches.
These items are potential causes for secondary
As a general rule, complete flooding of a fires.
compartment or flooding to sea level indicates that
a compartment is open to the sea. Flooding to a Reporting Information
lesser height may indicate that the puncture is
relatively small or that progressive flooding is You should use message blanks to report your
occurring. Although progressive flooding can be findings to the repair party leader. Then the repair
verified by subsequent soundings, the general rule party leader will correlate and evaluate the
does not always hold true. In more than one case, information and pass it to the parent repair
an unisolated saltwater line leading through a party and DCC. Local leaders should evaluate the
secured compartment has been ruptured and has information and take immediate steps to isolate
caused the space to become completely flooded damaged systems, to attack casualties in the most
without direct access to the sea. Such a condition logical manner, and to provide the correct equip-
is even more dangerous than a penetration of the ment to meet the emergency. DCC will pass
hull because, in time, the pressure within the essential information to the commanding officer
compartment could reach 100 pounds or more and concerning casualties, their extent, their effects
cause previously undamaged bulkheads to on the ships remaining buoyancy and stability,
collapse. and their probable effects.
After a casualty occurs, the repair party may
Investigation for Structural Damage appear to spend the first hour investigating
damage and too little time localizing the damage
Investigation for structural damage should or effecting repairs. This is not true; much of the
cover a considerable area surrounding the damage is obvious within a few minutes. With a
immediate scene of damage not only on the same well-indoctrinated damage control organization,
level as the principal casualty but also one only a small number of people are required to

7-9
24.99
Figure 7-4.Flight deck fire, USS Enterprise (CVN-65).

devote their entire time to investigative work. The several minutes. Without an investigation, the
remaining people in the repair party are able to unit might waste the same amount of time
start remedial action immediately. attempting an impossible repair on one leak.

Benefits of Investigation FIRE FIGHTING

The first two steps in handling a casualty are Whether a battle casualty is caused by a bomb,
to put out fires and control flooding. However, torpedo, or projectile hit, fire is a common result
without adequate investigation, no one knows (fig. 7-4). Unless the fire is quickly extinguished,
what types and quantities of material must be more serious damage than that caused by the
provided at the scene, which electric circuits or initial explosion may develop. The process of fire is
pipelines must be isolated, and which partially a three-component chemical reaction requiring
flooded compartments can be made watertight and fuel, heat, and oxygen. You control and extinguish
pumped dry. For example, as the result of a proper fires by eliminating one of these components. Fires
investigation, a repair locker or unit could stop are classified by type of fuel, as shown in table 7-3.
progressive flooding in six compartments Methods of extinguishing a fire are shown in table
containing holes that could be plugged in 7-4.

7-10
Table 7-3.Classification of Fires

Class AFires in ordinary combustible materials such as mattresses, dunnage, wood, canvas, and paper.

Class BFires in substances such as gasoline, fuel oil, lubricating oil, diesel oil, and paints.

Class CFires in electrical equipment.

Class DFires in metals such as magnesium, potassium, sodium, titanium, zirconium, powdered aluminum,
zinc, and others which require careful fire attack with special methods and extinguishing agents.

Table 7-4.Fire-fighting Methods.

USEFUL EXTINGUISHING
COMBUSTIBLE INVOLVED TYPE FIRE AGENTS

Woodwork, bedding, clothing, combustible A 1. Fixed water sprinkling


stores 2. High-velocity fog
3. Solid water stream
4. Foam/AFFF
5. Dry Chemical
6. CO2 Extinguisher

Explosive A 1. Magazine sprinkling


Propellants 2. Solid water stream or high-velocity fog
3. Foam/AFFF

Paint, spirits B 1. CO2 (Fixed System)


Flammable liquid stores 2. Foam/AFFF
3. Installed sprinklers
4. High-velocity fog
5. P-K-P Dry Chemical
6. CO2 Portable

Gasoline B 1. Foam/AFFF, handline or sprinkler systems


2. CO2 (Fixed System)
3. Water sprinkling system
4. P-K-P Dry Chemical

Fuel oil, JP-5 B 1. Foam/AFFF, handline or sprinkler systems


2. P-K-P Dry Chemical
3. Water sprinkling system
4. High-velocity fog
5. CO2 (Fixed System)

Electrical and radio C 1. (De-energize affected circuits)


2. Portable CO2 or CO2 hose reel system
3. High-velocity fog
4. FogFoam or Dry Chemical (if CO2 not
available)

Magnesium Alloys D 1. Jettison into the sea


2. High-velocity fogcool
3. Dry SandTalcSmother

Grenades, Napalm D 1. Dry sodium Chloride


2. Stow in kerosene or similar Hydrocarbon

The above extinguishing agents are listed in the order of their preferred use for each fire substance. They act in the following
manner: (1) Solid Water Streamwetting, penetrating, and cooling (2) Water Fogwetting, cooling, and shielding (3) Foam
permanent smothering (4) CO2temporary smothering (5) P-K-P Dry Chemicaltemporary smothering.

7-11
have all necessary postfire equipment at the scene An important first step is for all personnel
by the time the fire is out. This equipment should concerned with damage control to learn what
include axes, rakes, cutting torches, an oxygen features have been designed into their ship to
analyzer, an explosimeter. You should enable it to resist flooding. The most significant
of these features is the extent and type of vessel
set the reflash watch with a charged subdivision. The subdivision of the vessel will
hose manned and ready to extinguish any determine the extent and type of flooding that can
flare-up of the fire; occur and the type of corrective measures needed
after damage. The DCA, repair party officers,
test the compartment for explosive gases and repair party leaders should also know the
and oxygen content, in that order; extent to which bulkheads adjacent to damage can
be submerged before uncontrolled flooding arises.
overhaul the fire, breaking up any areas To combat flooding successfully, you need
where danger of smoldering embers exists; speed and accuracy. To be effective in applying
corrective measures, damage control personnel
retest the compartment for explosive gases; should be familiar with the equipment provided
and then to control list and trim and to improve stability.
All hands should learn the general effects of
desmoke and retest again. a torpedo hit or other underwater damage to their
ship. Since a single hit may wipe out entire repair
FLOODING CONTROL parties or possibly carry away the damage control
central station, ships may have to depend on other
One of the most important damage control than repair parties to confine the flooding, to
measures is to control flooding. Drainage by fixed fight fire, and so forth. More important, vessels
systems or portable pumps is ineffective in have been lost because personnel escaping from
handling flooding caused by damage until the rate damaged areas left doors and hatches open behind
of flooding has been controlled. The entire them, thus permitting rapid spread of loose water.
pumping capacity of the drainage systems is All hands should be trained to confine flooding
sufficient to care for flooding only when the leaks by securing doors and hatches, lest stability
are small. A hole in the hull, with an area of efforts be too little or too late.
only 1 square foot, 15 feet below the surface, will Certain material preparations are vital in
admit water at 13,900 gallons per minute (gpm). toughening the ship to resist flooding. They
The total pumping capacity of the fixed drainage include
systems in a large combatant ship, for example,
is only 12,200 gpm. maintaining watertight integrity of the
All pumping facilities cannot be used on any ships subdivision,
single flooded compartment. Therefore, it is
essential that you isolate compartments flooded properly classifying closures and fittings,
by underwater damage by watertight subdivisions
before dewatering efforts can be successful. properly setting material conditions of
Basically, two methods can be used in the closure, and
control of flooding: (1) restrict or entirely stop
the flow of water entering the hull and (2) confine providing adequate and well-distributed
and remove water that has entered or is still operable damage control equipment.
entering the ship.
Types of Flooding
Preparatory Measures to Resist
Flooding Before Damage There are two major types of flooding: solid
and partial.
It has been wisely said that 90 percent of the
work of damage controlthe important part- SOLID. If your ship has received severe
is accomplished before damage and only about underwater damage, compartments will be badly
10 percent after the ship has been hit. Most ruptured and completely flooded. Little or
preparatory work consists of measures taken to nothing can be done to correct this damage.
toughen the ship to resist flooding. Isolate the compartments to permit concentration

7-13
on compartments that can be repaired to prevent WHAT YOU HAVE; DO EVERYTHING POSSI-
progressive flooding. Solid flooding refers to a BLE TO PREVENT PROGRESSIVE FLOODING
compartment that is completely filled from deck AND BURNING. It is natural to attack the
to overhead. To be able to flood solidly, a obvious damage while completely ignoring hidden
compartment must be vented. Venting can take damage that may sink the ship. Hours are often
place through an air escape, an open scuttle or wasted trying to patch large or multiple holes in
a ventilation fitting, or fragment holes in the compartments that are already flooded. Smaller
overhead. Solid flooding has no other effect than holes through interior bulkheads (holes which are
to add weight at the center of gravity of the ship. causing progressive flooding) are overlooked. In
many cases, plugging those interior holes first
PARTIAL. Compartments that are only would be far better in order to HOLD WHAT
partially flooded because their outboard bulk- YOU HAVE.
heads contain small holes, cracks, loose rivets,
broken seams, or splinter holes allow progressive Holes in Underwater Hull
flooding to take place. If nothing is done about Large holes in the underwater hull, such as
these holes, the ship will take on more and more those caused by torpedoes, contact mines, or near-
water. The ship will lose buoyancy and list or trim miss bombs, cannot be repaired by a ship in
stability. Partial flooding refers to a condition in battle. A dry dock is required for such repairs.
which an intact compartment is not completely Large sections of hull plating are destroyed,
flooded. An intact compartment means that flooding is complete and extensive, and the
the deck on which the water rests and the amount of wreckage is tremendous.
bulkheads that surround it remain watertight. If As you investigate the damage, you may come
the boundaries remain intact, water will neither to a bulkhead that has only small holes in it, such
run into nor out of the flooded compartment as as cracked plates or seams, warped hatches, leaky
the ship rolls. The final result of partial flooding stuffing tubes, or holes made by blast or by
is usually a decided loss in overall stability.
flying debris. Such leaks should be treated as small
Establishing Flooding Boundaries holes in the underwater hull. By plugging those
holes, you can localize flooding and preserve
Flooding boundaries are the bulkheads and buoyancy. If you remove the water from the
decks restricting the partially flooded area from compartments you made watertight, you can
the flooding boundary. If partially flooded begin to minimize the damage. For example,
compartments become completely flooded, the plugging leaks in bulkheads of a boiler room and
flooding boundaries may not hold. There may be clearing the space of water would help minimize
hidden cracks or leaky stuffing tubes or the damage. Small holes in the underwater hull often
bulkheads may not be able to withstand the result from near-miss bombs or from violent
pressure put on them. In other words, just because explosions in some other part of the ship. For ex-
a flooding boundary seems safe one minute is no ample, a torpedo explosion forward may damage
sign that it will be safe the next. Therefore, repair shell plating on the quarters and cause cracks.
party personnel should keep on reinspecting and Cracks may also result from stresses produced by
should make sure the boundary holds (even so far steaming at high speeds in heavy seas.
as to add shoring if bulkhead or overhead strength Two factors that make repairing underwater
is in question). holes rather difficult are water pressure and
accessibility.
Holding What You Have
Rate of Flooding
Many ships have been sunk during battle
action, but very few of them have gone down as It makes no difference whether the hole is
a direct result of initial damage. Most of them made by a shell, a torpedo, a bomb splinter, a
have gone down hours later as a result of pro- defective gasket, or an unpacked stuffing tube;
gressive flooding, fire, collapsing bulkheads, if one side of the hole is submerged, water will
increased free surface, and human errors. Had flow through it. The amount of water that comes
flooding and fire boundaries been established into a ship through the hole or flows from one
when and where it was possible to do so and the compartment to the next varies directly with the
damage confined to its original area, even though area of the hole and the square root of its depth.
the area was large, many of those ships would still Table 7-5 is a chart for determining the flow of
be afloat and fit to fight. The moral is HOLD water through holes in gallons per minute.

7-14
7. Keep open wounds and burns as clean as PLUTONIUM
possible. Avoid touching open wounds and burns
with your hands or unsterile objects unless no Plutonium may become dispersed as small
particles as the result of impact, detonation of the
sterile dressings are available.
high explosives, or by smoke if a fire occurs.
8. Do not try to give liquids to an un-
Plutonium is a hazard only if it enters the body.
conscious person.
When small particles of plutonium are suspended
9. Never give morphine to an unconscious
in the air, the particles can be inhaled into the
person.
lungs or swallowed. Plutonium particles may also
10. Do not move a patient until the extent of
enter the body through cuts in the skin.
the injuries has been determined.

RESPONSE TO A NUCLEAR
NUCLEAR WEAPONS WEAPON ACCIDENT/INCIDENT
ACCIDENT/INCIDENT
Execute a shipboard nuclear accident/incident
Nuclear weapons systems have built-in safety in the same manner as any shipboard general
features and are governed by safety rules during emergency. In port, if less than the entire crew
all operational phases. As a senior petty officer, is aboard and if the situation warrants, sound
you must recognize, however, that hazards do general quarters. Sound general quarters at sea
exist. You must know what to do in the event of and the appropriate repair locker/damage control
a nuclear weapon accident/incident. team takes charge. If you are the first person on
In the United States, nuclear weapons maybe the scene, pass the alarm; then rig any available
transported by aircraft, trucks, trains, or naval fire hose and start cooling the warhead with high
ships. In each case, weapons and components are velocity water fog. Do not use foam on warheads,
installed in special containers that are securely as it acts as an insulator and causes heat
fastened to the transport vehicle by carefully retention rather than cooling.
designed tie-downs and mountings. Because If you are caught in the area of a fire or an
principal methods and procedures related to explosion, obtain some type of respiratory
nuclear weapons accident/incidents are classified, protection, even if it is a handkerchief placed over
only basic information will be covered here. the nose and mouth. An explosion may result in
More detailed information can be found in the scattered, burned, or melted explosives in the
Repair Party Manual (COMNAVSURFLANTINST area. High explosives in this form are especially
3541.lC/COMNAVSURFPACINST 3541.4B). susceptible to shock or movement. They may be
Even though nuclear weapons are designed to recognized by their tan or buff color in their
prevent a nuclear yield in the event of accidental original form, a pink color when fused, or a white
detonation, a possible hazard is still associated powdery appearance when burned. Remember,
with conventional weapons and material. The two stay away from high explosives.
components of a nuclear weapon that constitute
the most probable hazard in the case of an
accident are high explosives and plutonium. CBR DEFENSE
CBR defense is defined as all damage control
HIGH EXPLOSIVES and personnel protective measures used to combat/
minimize the effects of chemical, biological, or
Most nuclear weapons contain high explosives radiological attack. CBR defense measures may
in varying amounts of up to 200 pounds. These be invoked to counter a direct enemy attack or
high explosives present a major hazard. Treat to counter the effects of the use of CBR weapons
accidents or fires involving nuclear weapons by friendly forces in defending themselves.
the same as those involving conventional high In studying CBR defense, remember that new
explosives. If a nuclear weapon is involved approaches are constantly being testednew
in a fire, the high explosives could detonate. weapons are being developed and new protective
Detonation may be very small or of considerable and defense measures are being established.
magnitude. If a nuclear weapon accident occurs, Keeping up to date with new developments is
only personnel trained in high-explosive disposal therefore particularly important in the field of
should attempt to clean up, recover, or dispose CBR defense.
of the high explosives.

7-19
Alpha radiation becomes a hazard only if alpha- are living microorganisms (except toxins) that
emitting contaminants are taken into the body by cause disease in personnel, plants, and animals.
breathing, eating, drinking, or by absorption BW agents differ greatly from chemical agents in
into the bloodstream through broken skin. Major that a living microorganism can grow and multiply
alpha contamination in a nuclear attack is not in a susceptible host. Once infected, an incubation
likely; however, it will present a hazard in the period is required before the infection produces
event of a nuclear weapons handling accident. a casualty. This incubation period varies greatly
among infectious microorganisms. For this
BETA . Beta radiation has a range in the air reason, use of BW agents are unlikely to be used
of only a few feet and has limited penetrating in situations where results are needed in less than
power. Generally, you cannot stop beta radiation 48 to 72 hours.
with light-porous material, such as ordinary
clothing, particularly since the contaminant tends Detection and Identification
to impregnate the material. However, you can
stop beta radiation with dense material, such as Because of the incubation period, there is a
heavy-duty gloves and foul-weather clothing. Beta lapse of time before victims realize they are
contamination is primarily a skin-contact hazard. infected. Detection before the first symptoms are
noticed is difficult, and identification of a
GAMMA. Gamma radiation is similar to X particular agent may take considerable time. It
radiation (X rays). It has an effective range in the is possible to detect excessive organic life in the
air of many hundreds of feet and is highly atmosphere, but identification of the particular
penetrating. It cannot be completely stopped by agent is still in the development stage. Once a
a barrier. A sufficient thickness of material can biological infection is started, it may spread by
reduce the intensity of gamma radiation to an normal contagious processes without further agent
insignificant level. Because of the penetrating deployment. BW agents will infect an individual
power of gamma radiation and the large amount if they enter the lungs, stomach, or bloodstream.
of gamma rays emitted by fallout contaminants,
it is the most significant radiation hazard in most Dissemination
contaminated ship situations.
BW agents are likely to be dispersed as
aerosols of solid or liquid particles and are
CHEMICAL AND BIOLOGICAL invisible except near the source of dissemination.
DEFENSE These particles, when inhaled, can penetrate the
lungs where they can start an infection. Aerosols
The threat of attack with chemical or bio- of BW agents can penetrate buildings and ships.
logical warfare agents is more likely on land. The microorganisms required to infect an in-
However, their uses are still a definite threat in dividual are so small that it is possible for a single
naval engagements and amphibious operations. delivery vehicle to spread a casualty-producing
aerosol over many hundreds of square miles.
BIOLOGICAL WARFARE (BW) When biological agents infect biting flies,
mosquitoes, fleas, and ticks and are released
Large-scale use of biological warfare (BW) into an area, they, in turn, bite and infect
agents has not occurred in modern times. people. BW agents may also be spread by
Therefore, there is little experience with the saboteurs, who may contaminate food and
military potential of BW agents except by noting water supplies, food processing plants, and air-
that naturally occurring diseases have affected the conditioning systems. Shells, rockets, and mortar
outcome of some past wars. Any nation with a bombs are not suitable for dissemination of these
modern scientific program can produce effective agents because of the adverse effect of heat and
biological agents. shock in an explosion.
Biological warfare is the intentional use of
living infectious microorganisms (germs) to reduce Self-Aid
or destroy the military effectiveness of personnel.
The exception to this is the recent use in Southeast If you suspect that BW contamination has
Asia and Afghanistan of toxins classified as BW taken place, put on your protective mask and
agents but are not living organisms. BW agents observe the basic principles of preventive

7-24
medicine, which include individual hygiene, problems, and its impact on medical and logistic
sanitation, and physical checkups. Report any facilities can be enormous. It also reduces perform-
illness to medical authorities immediately. ance because of defensive measures needed to
If there is a possibility of contamination by combat it.
BW agents, carefully remove your clothes to avoid CW agents can attack the body through the
spreading any contamination. Take a thorough eyes, nose, mouth, or skin. CW agents produce
soap and water shower as soon as possible. Pay almost instantaneous casualties when they enter
careful attention to your face and hands. Use a the eyes, are breathed through the nose or mouth,
fingernail brush to remove dirt under your nails. or are ingested. Penetration through the skin is
Frequently brush your teeth and gums, the roof likely to produce casualties more slowly, although
of your mouth, and your tongue. Dispose of your the presence of open wounds can hasten the
contaminated clothing as directed. process. Almost any weapons system can be used
The speed with which the deadly effects of to deliver CW agents.
some biological agents take place will require you
to take immediate self-aid and first-aid measures.
Classification of Chemical Agents
CHEMICAL WARFARE
CW agents maybe classified according to their
Chemical warfare (CW) agents are those physical state, tactical use, or physiological
intended for use in military operations to kill, action. They exist as solids, liquids, or gases.
injure seriously, or incapacitate people through You can also group CW agents according to their
physiological effects. Chemical agents used as tactical use.
weapons of war are almost as old as recorded
history and can be dated from the fifth century CASUALTY CW AGENTS. Casualty CW
B.C. CW operations in the modern sense were agents are capable of producing serious injury or
first used during World War I when the German death. They include nerve agents, blister agents,
army released chlorine gas from large cylinders blood agents, and choking agents. The most
into a favorable wind. Although large stocks of important are the nerve agents. They interfere
chemical agents were produced and stockpiled with the transfer of nerve impulses, thereby
during World War II, none were used. Since the disrupting essential bodily functions, such as
end of World War II, much effort has been breathing, muscular control, and vision. The
directed into research and development of nerve, blood, and choking agents are primarily
chemical agents. The introduction of nuclear killers. The blister agents normally result only in
weapons and the fact that CW agents were not incapacitation; however, they may cause blindness
used in World War II does not exclude the and even death through secondary infection.
possibility of their use in future wars. Detection,
protection, and decontamination are the most INCAPACITATING AGENTS. These agents
important concerns of CW defense. produce temporary physiological or mental effects
that render individuals incapable of performing
Characteristics of Chemical Warfare their assigned duties.

Chemical warfare has unique characteristics, RIOT CONTROL AGENTS. These agents,
and it is not thought of in terms of conventional such as tear gas, produce only temporary irritating
warfare. Since chemical warfare is directed or incapacitating effects when in contact with the
primarily against man, it has obvious tactical eyes or when inhaled.
advantages. It does not damage equipment or
other war materials but rather makes them dirty
and renders them unusable. Chemical warfare is Effects of Chemical Warfare Agents
a weapon of surprise. It is capable of traveling
over and around structures as well as penetrating Victims of casualty agents (nerve, blister,
compartments. Chemical warfare is economical blood, and choking agents) require hospitaliza-
and is capable of affecting large areas for tion. Inhalation of high concentrations of vapor
relatively small material expenditures. In addition from these agents or contact with liquid agents,
to its lethal or incapacitating effects, the use of without prompt medical treatment, will produce
chemical warfare causes morale and psychological death.

7-25
Exposure to high concentrations of nerve seconds. Try to regulate the flow of water so that
agents may bring on a lack of coordination, flushing lasts not less than 30 seconds and not
mental confusion, and physical collapse so fast more than 2 minutes. Decontamination with water
that a person may not be able to perform self- effectively removes mustard gas and is now the
aid measures. If this happens, the necessary standard procedure for all blister agents.
procedures will have to be done for the casualty The risk of leaving blister agents in the eye is
(as first aid) by the nearest person who is able to greater than the risk of exposure to blister agent
do so. vapors. The decontamination procedure MUST
Severe nerve agent exposure may rapidly cause be performed in spite of the presence of vapor.
unconsciousness, muscular paralysis, and stoppage
of breathing. When this occurs, atropine and EFFECTS OF CHOKING AGENTS.
2-PAM chloride injections alone will not save a Choking agents are less effective than nerve
life. Start artificial ventilation, as a first-aid agents; the use is for quick, incapacitating effects.
measure, immediately and continue until you can Death may occur within 3 hours. Choking agents
restore natural breathing or until medical person- are colorless but you can detect them by odor,
nel can take over. Atropine and 2-PAM injections which smells like new-mown hay or grass. They
increase the effectiveness of artificial ventilation enter the body when inhaled through the nose or
and should be administered to the casualty as soon mouth. In low concentrations, there is a delay
as possible. of 3 hours or more in their effect; in high
concentrations, the effect is immediate including
EFFECTS OF BLISTER AGENTS. Blister the possibility of death within minutes.
agents would probably be used in conjunction Irritation of the eyes or a change in the taste
with nerve agents. They cause incapacitating of a cigarette might indicate the presence of the
rather than lethal effects detectable by the senses. choking agent phosgene. Smoking may become
They smell of garlic, fish, or geraniums and may tasteless or offensive in taste. If any signs of
appear as colorless to dark brown oily liquid or choking agents occur, hold your breath and put
droplets. They attack through all body entry on the protective mask at once. Unless you
points, particularly the eyes and those parts of the experience nausea, vomiting, difficulty in
body that are warm and moist. A droplet the size breathing, or more than the usual shortness of
of a pinhead can cause a blister the size of a breath caused by exertion, continue your normal
quarter. Blister agents react almost immediately combat duties. If any of these symptoms occur,
on any part of the body they touch. You must you should rest quietly until you are evacuated
wash the liquid from the eyes in seconds to avoid by medical personnel.
an injury. Treatment after 2 minutes is of little
use. On the skin, depending on the dose received, EFFECTS OF BLOOD AGENTS. Blood
effects appear from 1 hour to days following agents were not very effective in World War I
exposure. The first signs are a reddening of the because the high concentrations necessary to cause
skin, like a severe sunburn, followed by an itching death could not be achieved. Modern methods of
or a burning sensation. Blisters appear in a day delivery make their use possible; and because they
or less after reddening. Recovery time varies from are less persistent than other agents, they can be
about 6 days to as long as 8 weeks. immediately used for quick casualty effects. Blood
Because phosgene oxime (blister agent) reacts agents are colorless but may have a slight odor
rapidly with tissue, decontamination will not be of bitter almonds. They attack the body when
entirely effective after pain has begun. Never- inhaled or ingested through the nose or mouth.
theless, flush the contaminated area as rapidly as A few breaths can cause incapacitation or death.
possible with large amounts of water to remove Incapacitation can occur almost immediately; a
any phosgene oxime that has not yet reacted with lethal dose of vapor can result in death within 15
tissue. minutes.
Whenever liquid or vaporized blister agents In the case of blood agents, speed in self-aid
are known, be sure to wear the protective mask. and first-aid measures is essential. Stop breathing
You must deal with liquid blister agents in your and put your mask on at once if you notice any
eyes or on your skin immediately. stimulation of breathing; an odor of bitter
You can decontaminate a liquid blister agent almonds; or any irritation of the eyes, nose, or
in your eye that does not cause immediate pain throat. The effects of blood agents act so rapidly
by rinsing the eye with water for at least 30 that within a few seconds you will be unable to

7-27
put on the mask by yourself. If at all possible, remove your mask until a monitor tells you
try to hold your breath until the mask is on; this it is safe to do so. In general, personnel
may be very difficult since blood agents strongly decontamination does not take priority over
stimulate respiration. If a persons breathing has urgent battle requirements, but it should be
stopped, administer artificial ventilation. accomplished as soon as possible. The following
is a list of decontamination procedures:
EFFECTS OF VOMITING AGENTS.
1. Remove rain gear and battle dress just out-
Vomiting agents are used for harassment but may
side the decon station. Place it in the trash cans,
be dispersed along with lethal chemical agents.
bags, or other storage provided. Now you will be
Vomiting agents alone cause temporary incapacita-
monitored for contamination. If there is no
tion only. Vomiting effects last from about 30
contamination, go to an uncontaminated space
minutes up to several hours, depending on the
through another route. If there is contamination,
concentration. Vomiting agents are invisible and
go through the process described in paragraph 2
odorless. They attack the body through the nose
through 5 below.
and mouth and irritate the eyes.
2. Enter the first part of the decon station in
EFFECTS OF TEAR AGENTS. Tear agents pairs. Use the buddy system to do gross decon
are used for their harassing effect. They have been of masks and gloves with the M258A1 personnel
used extensively as riot control and chemical decon kits. Decon boots by immersing them in
defense training agents. Tear agents attack the the 2- by 2- by 6-inch pans filled with a 9 percent
eyes and irritate or burn moist areas of the skin. high test hypochlorite (HTH) and water solution.
Effects are instantaneous but normally persist for
only a few minutes. 3. Move to the second part of the decon station
where attendants will cut away your smock and
Table 7-9 shows the properties of blister, help remove your trousers and boots. Place the
blood, nerve, and choking chemical agents. contaminated clothing in trash bags for disposal.

4. Move to the showers, soap and wash your


PERSONNEL DECONTAMINATION entire body thoroughly, and rinse well. Pay special
STATIONS attention to fingernails, hairy parts of the body,
and hidden parts where contamination tends to
Personnel decontamination stations differ concentrate.
somewhat from ship to ship, but the basic
requirements of the stations are the same. Each 5. You are now ready to enter the clean part
decontamination station is divided into two parts: of the ship where you will put on new clothing.
(1) a contaminated or unclean section containing Before you enter the clean part, a monitor with
a washing area and (2) a clean section. This a long-range radiac will check to ensure that you
prevents recontamination of personnel and ship no longer carry contamination. Turn over your
locations. If possible, the unclean and clean DT-60 dosimeter to this monitor. The monitor will
sections have separate access routes or entrances. take the readings and enter them in the log.You
The decontamination station provides showers will be told if you can remove your gas mask.
with warm water (if possible); cleansing agents,
such as ear syringes and eye bath cups; hair and
nail clippers; scissors; surgeons hand soap; MISSION-ORIENTED
towels; and brushes. Radiation instruments for PROTECTIVE POSTURE
monitoring personnel and clothing and supplies
of clean clothing are also on hand at each station. Mission-oriented protective posture (MOPP)
establishes levels of readiness. The MOPP is a
A decontamination (decon) station should flexible system of protection against chemical
be about 8 feet by 9 feet. It should have agents used in chemical warfare defense. MOPP
an entrance from the outside and an exit prescribes various types of protective clothing and
into an uncontaminated area near the showers. equipment for wear, depending on the tactical
If exposed to contamination, you should use mission, work-rate demand, and heat stress
proper decontamination procedures. Do not conditions (actual or possible). There are four

7-28
within the ship, and their relative ability to communications plan. It also establishes disaster
enter and don full-protective clothing while assistance teams. These teams should be self-
continuing to perform assigned duties must also sustaining and have adequate supplies of food
be considered. and water. Each team should also have crowbars,
picks, fire axes, shovels, two blankets, and a
A great number of heat casualties is acceptable stretcher. If fires are anticipated, fire-fighting
since heat casualties are more likely to recover and teams should break out available fire-fighting
ordinarily do not require the intensive medical gear. The supply department provides food
care necessary in treating chemical casualties. and supplies and prepares to establish field
Personnel fully trained in the use of protective kitchens and serve meals to survivors. The
clothing and accustomed to its use will suffer medical department should be prepared to
fewer and less severe heat casualties. set up a field hospital and have medical
teams organized, equipped, and ready to
render assistance as necessary.
DISASTER CONTROL ASHORE

Disaster preparedness means implementing Phase II (Investigation of


actions to promote survival of personnel, Extent of Disaster)
preservation of resources, and restoration of
mission-essential operations following any type Phase II is the investigation of the extent
of disaster. All naval activities must plan for self- of the disaster. Following a large-scale disaster,
recovery and provide an effective system of many confusing and inaccurate reports are
mutual assistance when required. In planning for likely to be received from survivors. A survey
disaster response, units should first consider those team is dispatched to the disaster area. It
requirements necessary for their own survival. should make contact with local authorities
Each unit will have a civil disaster bill based on and determine the extent of immediate assistance
OPNAVINST 3120.32B. needed and relay this information to the senior
officer present. If available, helicopters can
As a senior petty officer, you maybe assigned be used to survey outlying areas to determine
as a member of, or to lead, a civil disaster detail. the extent of the disaster.
When providing civil disaster relief, you may
expect to deal with demoralized, hysterical, or
apathetic survivors. They may be incapable, Phase III (Initial Disaster Relief)
temporarily at least, of intelligent action in their
own behalf. Mass destruction of homes and other Phase III is the initial disaster relief phase. The
buildings, widespread fires, and complete absence general objectives of this phase are to
of all forms of public utilities should be antici-
pated. Disaster relief operations are normally
conducted in five phases (I-V).
rescue persons requiring immediate
attention,

Phase I (Planning)
fight and extinguish fires,

Immediately following the order to provide render medical aid, and


disaster relief to an area, the planning phase (I)
begins and extends until the detail arrives at the aid in any way within the capabilities of
disaster area. During this period, determine the personnel and materials to ease the
need for every aid. Assemble all available maps situation.
and/or charts of the area, and make suitable
reproductions to ensure adequate maps for rescue A command center is set up in the disaster area
operations. The geographic reference (GEOREF) to direct and establish liaison with other rescue
grid system should be used. personnel to avoid duplication of effort. There
will be no armed personnel in the disaster area
The operations department prepares portable unless specifically authorized by the commanding
communications equipment and establishes a officer.

7-32
Phase IV (Routine Aid and Assistance) training on board. Your personnel should be
cross-trained in damage control procedures to
Phase IV consists of routine aid and build more effective and versatile teams.
assistance. The general objectives of this phase
are to In the event of a CBR attack, fast action on
the part of all personnel can minimize injury and
continue medical and rescue work; prolonged incapacity. Knowing what actions
to take and when to take them can mean the
provide food and supplies as required and difference between survival and death and
directed; winning and losing a battle. Properly applied
self-aid, first aid, and personnel decontamination
commence repair of utilities, such as can increase your chances of recovery from CBR
communications, water, and electrical exposure.
supply insofar as practical; and
Natural disasters can occur at any time or any
provide temporary shelter. place in many forms, such as flooding, earth-
quakes, and hurricanes. As a senior petty officer,
you may be required to lead a civil disaster detail
Phase V (Withdrawal) ashore. Knowing what your duties are and what
to expect following a disaster can save lives and
Phase V is the withdrawal phase. When the property.
situation is under control, the unit will withdraw
from the disaster area. Phase V is only emergency
relief, not rehabilitation. Its primary purpose is
to assist in a disaster area. All equipment and REFERENCES
supplies not authorized to be left behind will be
recovered and returned to the command. Naval Ships Technical Manual, Chapter 070,
Radiological Recovery of Ships After Nuclear
Weapons Explosion, Naval Sea Systems Com-
mand, Washington D.C., 1977.
SUMMARY
Naval Ships Technical Manual, Chapter 470,
There can be no substitute for training and Shipboard BW/CW Defense and Counter-
preparation in situations requiring damage control measures, Naval Sea Systems Command,
action. Damage resulting from battle, fire, Washington, D.C., 1990.
collision, and CBR attack must be brought under
control as soon as possible to ensure the survival Repair Party Manual, COMNAVSURFLANT-
of ship and crew. Successful damage control INST 3541.1C and COMNAVSURFPACINST
requires a detailed knowledge of the ships 3541.4B, Commanders Naval Surface Forces,
construction, characteristics, compartmentation, United States, Atlantic/Pacific Fleets, Norfolk,
and stability. It also includes knowledge of those Va. and San Diego, Calif., 1991.
design features and equipments used to prevent
or control damage should the ship be endangered. Ship Repair Party Manual, COMNAVAIRLANT-
The control of damage depends on the ability and INST 5400.27B, Commander, Naval Air
the initiative of personnel to take prompt Forces, United States Atlantic Fleet, Norfolk,
corrective action using materials that are readily Va., 1985.
available.
As a senior petty officer, you will often be Standard Organization and Regulations of the
placed in a position of responsibility for training U.S. Navy, OPNAVINST 3120.32B, Office
or leading damage control repair parties. This is of the Chief of Naval Operations, Washington,
not to say that you must know everything there D.C., 1986.
is to know about damage control. But, you
should be aware of the types of information and Surface Ship Survivability, NWP 62-1 (Rev. C),
training that are available. Take advantage of the Office of the Chief of Naval Operations,
ships damage control library for conducting Washington, D.C., 1989.

7-33
INDEX

A Authority, 4-1

Air blast, heat, and underwater shock, protection general, 4-1


against, 7-21 limitations of, 4-2
personnel in congested topside areas, 7-22 organizational, 4-2
personnel in open topside areas, 7-22 to assign extra military instruction, 4-2
self-aid and first aid, 7-22 to extend working hours, 4-3
Alcohol abuse, 3-14 to withhold privileges, 4-3
Alcohol Rehabilitation Departments (ARDs), 3-21 Awards and recognition, recommending subordinates
for, 2-28
alcoholism, 3-18
types of recognition, 2-28
blood alcohol levels and behavior, 3-16
written format, 2-28
chronic heavy drinking, 3-16
Counseling and Assistance Center (CAAC), 3-21 B
diagnosing alcoholism, 3-18
Battle dressing stations, 7-7
Drug and Alcohol Program Advisor (DAPA), 3-21
Biological warfare (BW), 7-24
drug interactions with alcohol, 3-17
detection and identification, 7-24
helping resources for problems with, 3-20
dissemination, 7-24
long-term effects of, 3-17
self-aid, 7-24
Naval Alcohol Rehabilitation Centers
(NAVALREHCENs), 3-21
C
Navy Drug and Alcohol Counselor, 3-21
Casualty control, 7-18
Navy policy regarding, 3-15
preventing alcohol problems and alcoholism, 3-19 Ceremonies, 4-22

prevention and rehabilitation programs, 3-20 Chemical, biological, and radiological (CBR) defense,
7-19
problem drinking, 3-18
biological warfare (BW), 7-24
short-term effects of, 3-16
chemical and biological defense, 7-24
treating alcoholism, 3-19
chemical warfare (CW), 7-25
understanding alcohol and its effects, 3-15
radiological, 7-20
Alcoholism. See Alcohol abuse
Chemical agents, 7-25
Apprehension, 5-5
blister agents, 7-27
Asylum, granting, 5-6
blood agents, 7-27
foreign territories, 5-6
casualty CW agents, 7-25
high seas and U.S. territories, 5-6
choking agents, 7-27
At-sea tire party, 7-8
incapacitating agents, 7-25

INDEX-1
Chemical agents-Continued Correspondence, naval, 2-30
nerve agents, 7-26 accepting criticism of, 2-38
riot control agents, 7-25 accountability and disposal of, 2-45
tear agents, 7-28 endorsements to, 2-39
vomiting agents, 7-28 files, 2-44
Chemical warfare, 7-15 first draft of, 2-37
casualty CW agents, 7-25 memorandum, 2-42
characteristics of, 7-25 official, 2-36
classification of, 7-25 preparation of, 2-37
effects of blister agents, 7-27 reviewing, 2-38
effects of blood agents, 7-27 security classifications of, 2-39
effects of chemical warfare agents, 7-25 smooth version of, 2-30
effects of choking agents, 7-27 standard naval letter, 2-39
effects of nerve agents, 7-26 standard subject identification codes (SSICs) in,
effects of tear agents, 7-28 2-45

effects of vomiting agents, 7-28 target date of, 2-37

incapacitating agents, 7-25 types of, 2-39

riot control agents, 7-25 writing standards, 2-45

Chief Warrant Officer Physicians Assistant Program, Counseling, 2-8


4-18 command counseling sheets, 2-8
Chief Warrant Officer Program, 4-17 enlisted performance evaluation reports, 2-8
Collateral duties, recommending subordinates for, letters of instruction, 2-8
2-28
page 13 entry in the enlisted service record, 2-8
verbal, 2-28
Counseling and Assistance Center (CAAC), 3-21
written, 2-28
Command assessment team (CAT), 3-3 D

Command training team (CTT), 3-3


Damage control information, sources of, 7-16
Commission, paths to a, 4-15
Damage control responsibilities, 7-3
Chief Warrant Officer Physicians Assistant
communications, 7-16
Program, 4-18
of the commanding officer, 7-3
Chief Warrant Officer Program, 4-17
of the damage control petty officer, 7-3
Enlisted Commissioning Program, 4-20
of the division officer, 7-3
Limited Duty Officer Program, 4-18
of the executive officer, 7-3
Medical Service Corps, 4-20
of the officer of the deck, 7-3
Officer Candidate School, 4-20
Damage control organization, 7-4
Recommended Correspondence Courses, 4-20
Damage control petty officer (DCPO), 7-3
Communications, damage control, 7-16
damage control battle organization, 7-4

INDEX-2
Damage control petty officer (DCPO)-Continued Drugs, types of and their effects-Continued
dress requirements for repair parties, 7-6 marijuana, 3-12
duties and responsibilities, 7-3 methadone, 3-10
functions of damage control central, 7-5 morphine, 3-10
repair parties and teams, 7-5 narcotics, 3-9
repair party assignments, 7-6 opiates, 3-9
setting material condition Zebra, 7-6 stimulants, 3-10
work center DCPO, 7-4 volatile chemicals, 3-11
Damage control central (DCC), 7-5
E
Deck log, in port, 5-6
Decontamination stations, personnel 7-28 Emergency bills, 4-7

Disaster control ashore, 7-32 CBR defense bill, 4-8

initial disaster relief, 7-32 emergency destruction bill, 4-8

investigation, 7-32 general emergency bill, 4-7

planning, 7-32 man overboard bill, 4-7

routine aid and assistance, 7-33 Enlisted Commissioning Program, 4-20

withdrawal, 7-33 Enlisted Performance Evaluation Report, 2-8

Dogs, drug detection, 3-14 adverse, 2-15

Downgrading and declassification markings, 2-36 avenues of recourse for adverse remarks in, 2-15

message cancellations, 2-36 changes and corrections to, 2-17

message readdressals, 2-36 command responsibilities for, 2-11

minimize condition, 2-36 continuity of periods covered in, 2-13

Drug abuse, 3-8 correction of naval records pertaining to, 2-15

abuser identification, 3-13 development of, 2-13

education, 3-8 for other than normal evaluation categories, 2-13

prevention, 3-14 form, 2-18

types of drugs and their effects, 3-8 individual input to, 2-15

Drug and Alcohol Program Advisor (DAPA), 3-21 individual rights and responsibilities toward, 2-14

Drugs, types of and their effects, 3-8 review of, 2-15

amphetamines, 3-10 signature of member on, 2-17

cocaine, 3-10 Special Performance Evaluation Report, 2-11

codeine, 3-10 supplemental reports, 2-17

crack, 3-10 timeliness of, 2-14


Enlisted safety committee, 6-4
depressants, 3-11
Equal opportunity, 3-1
hallucinogens, 3-11
command enforcement, 3-4
heroin, 3-9
command responsibilities, 3-3

INDEX-3
Equal opportunity-Continued I
supervisors responsibilities, 3-2
Inspections, 1-20 and 4-22
Equipment tag-out log, 6-14
administrative, 1-21
audits, 6-15
Board of Inspection and Survey (INSURV), 1-21
instrument log, 6-15
operational readiness (ORI), 1-20
record sheets, 6-15
Propulsion Examination Board (PEB), 1-20
Evaluations. See Enlisted Performance Evaluation
Report. Inventories, 2-2
division damage control space, 2-2
F
division supply, 2-2
Fire fighting, 7-10 division tool, 2-2
CO2 safety precautions, 7-12
J
Halon 1301 hazards, 7-12
initial fire-fighting operations, 7-12 Job safety analysis, 6-4

postfire action, 7-12 Junior officer of the deck, in port, 5-9

preventing spreading of fire,7-12 duties, responsibilities, and authority of, 5-10

Fleet organization, 1-4 organizational relationships of the junior officer of


the deck, 5-9
Flooding control, 7-13
establishing flooding boundaries, 7-14 L
holding what you have, 7-14
Leading petty officer, 4-3
holes in hull above the waterline, 7-16
assignment of duties, 4-4
holes in underwater hull, 7-14
assignment of supervisory jobs, 4-4
methods used in, 7-16
authority and responsibility of a, 2-28
preparatory measures to resist flooding before
cross-training, 4-5
damage, 7-13
delegating signature authority, 2-29
rate of flooding, 7-14
delegation of authority for task completion, 2-29
types of, 7-13
duties, 4-3
H evaluation and prioritization of division jobs, 2-29

Hazardous waste/material petty officer, 6-9 facsimile stamps, 2-30

Hazardous waste/materials, 6-9 responsibilities, 4-3

asbestos, 6-9 signature authority, 2-29

control measures for asbestos removal, 6-9 signature block, 2-30


respiratory protection from, 6-9 Limited Duty Officer Program, 4-18

Hearing conservation and noise abatement, 6-12 M


Heat. See Air blast, heat, and underwater shock,
protection against Mast, 3-4
Heat stress, 6-12 appeals procedure, 3-7

INDEX-4
Mast-Continued Messages-Continued
conduct of, 3-4 releaser of, 2-31
documentation of charges presented at, 3-5 routine, 2-33
effective dates of punishment, 3-7 standard subject identification codes (SSICs) in,
fines, 3-7 2-45

premast advice, 3-6 subject line in, 2-35

premast screenings associated with, 3-6 text of, 2-35

procedures, 3-5 types of, 2-30

punishment resulting from, 3-7 Mishap prevention education and training, 6-3

rights of accused, 3-5 on-the-job training, 6-3

types of punishment, 3-7 safety education, 6-3

Master at Arms/Safety Force, 6-6 Mission-oriented protective posture (MOPP), 7-28

Medical Service Corps, 4-20


N
Messages, 2-30
addressee of, 2-31
National security policy, 1-2
addresses in, 2-33
Naval Alcohol Rehabilitation Centers
cancellation of, 2-36 (NAVALREHCENs), 3-21
classification line, 2-35 NAVGRAM, 2-43
collective address designator (CAD) in, 2-35 Navy Drug and Alcohol Counselor, 3-21
date-time group assigned to, 2-33 Navy Occupational Safety and Health (NAVOSH)
downgrading and declassification markings in, 2-36 Program, 6-7

drafter of, 2-31 hazardous materials, 6-8

flash, 2-33 industrial equipment safety precautions, 6-7


pneumatic tools, 6-7
format of, 2-33
immediate, 2-33 protective clothing and safety equipment, 6-8

Minimize condition, 2-36 Nonjudicial punishment, 3-4

naval, 2-30 appeals procedure 3-7

NAVGRAM, 2-43 effective dates of, 3-7

originator of, 2-31 fines, 3-7


premast advice concerning, 3-6
passing instructions line in, 2-35
precedence of, 2-31 rights of accused regarding, 3-5

preparing, 2-31 types of, 3-7

priority, 2-33 Nuclear weapons, 7-19

reaction time in response to, 2-33 hazards of high explosives, 7-19

readdressals of, 2-36 hazards of plutonium, 7-19


response to an accident/incident, 7-19
reference line in, 2-35
Nuclear radiation, 7-23

INDEX-5
Nuclear radiation-Continued Personnel qualification standards-Continued
alpha, 7-23 qualification process, 4-10
beta, 7-24 qualifiers, 4-11
gamma, 7-23 time limits, 4-10
initial radiation, 7-23 work center supervisors role in, 4-12
radioactive fallout, 7-23 Personnel Advancement Requirements (PARs), 4-15
types of radiation emitted by contamination, 7-23 Policy, input toward, 2-27

O verbal, 2-27
written, 2-27
Officer of the deck (OOD), in port, 5-3
Presenting personnel for quarters, inspections, and
authority to apprehend, 5-5 ceremonies, 4-22
authority to restrain, 5-5
Q
duties, 5-4
granting asylum and temporary refuge, 5-6 Quarters, 4-22
fair weather parade, 4-22
organizational relationship of, 5-3
responsibilities, 5-4 foul weather parade, 4-22

Officer Candidate School, 4-20 general assembly, 4-22


personnel inspections, 4-22
On-scene leader, 7-7
investigating damage, 7-8 R

P Radiological defense, 7-20

Personnel qualification standards (PQS), 4-8 damage by air blast, 7-20

100 SeriesFundamentals, 4-9 damage by underwater shock, 7-20

200 SeriesSystems, 4-9 damage by water waves, 7-21

300 SeriesWatch Station/Maintenance Action, 4-9 damage survival zone, 7-20


non-nuclear effects, 7-20
commanding officers role in, 4-13
nuclear weapons hazards, 7-20
coordination, 4-13
department heads role in, 4-13 protection against air blast, heat, and underwater
shock, 7-21
division officers and division chief petty officers
role in, 4-12 Refuge, granting temporary, 5-6

executive officer's/training officers role in, 4-13 foreign territories, 5-6

final certification and watch station sign-off, 4-11 high seas and U.S. territories, 5-6
Repair parties and teams, 7-5
implementing, 4-9
indoctrination, 4-10 assignments, 7-6

interim qualification, 4-10 benefits of investigation, 7-10


dress requirements for, 7-6
oral examining boards and written examinations,
4-11 for fighting fires, 7-7
organization, 4-11 initial/rapid survey, 7-8

INDEX-6
Repair parties and teams-Continued Safety-Continued
investigation for fires, 2-9 Navy Occupational Safety and Health (NAVOSH)
investigation for flooding, 7-9 Program, 6-7

investigation for structural damage, 7-9 observations, 6-3

investigation teams, 7-8 on-the-job training,6-3

repeat/detailed investigation, 7-9 petty officer, 6-2

reporting of information, 7-9 Schedules, 2-3

Report and Disposition of offenses(s), 3-5 annual employment, 2-3

Respirators, 6-9 command operational, 2-3

identification of respirator cartridges and gas mask timelines, 2-4


canisters, 6-11 work center, 2-3
types of, 6-10 Sea power, 1-1
Restraint, 5-5 Section leaders, 5-13
arrest, 5-6 Security, ships, 5-10
confinement, 5-6 casual visiting, 5-10
restriction in lieu of arrest, 5-5 entertaining guests, 5-11
forecastle and fantail watch, 5-13
S
general visiting, 5-10

Safety observations, 6-3 pier patrol, 5-12

deliberate, 6-3 unauthorized visitors, 5-12

incidental, 6-3 visitors with and without visit clearance, 5-11

planned, 6-4 visits by foreign nationals, 5-11

priorities, 6-4 watches in U.S. and foreign ports, 5-12

Safety petty officer, division, 6-2 Security classifications, 2-39

duties of, 6-2 Service records, enIisted, 4-14

familiarity with safety information, 6-2 Sight conservation, 6-14

mishap prevention education and training provided Special Performance Evaluation Report, 2-11
by, 6-3 Standard subject identification codes (SSIC), 2-45
on-the-job training provided by, 6-3 Strategic nuclear deterrence, 1-3
safety education provided by, 6-3 U.S. Air Force role in, 1-3
Safety, 6-2 U.S Navy role in, 1-3
analysis, 6-4 Strategy, naval maritime, 1-2
committee, 6-4 Striking forces, 1-4
education, 6-3 aircraft carrier battle group, 1-5
enforcement, 6-7 amphibious forces, 1-9
force, 6-6 submarine forces, 1-6

INDEX-7
Striking forces-continued Warfare, naval-continued
surface action group (SAG), 1-7 mine, 1-11
Survival, 6-15 Navy Command and Control Systems (NCCS),
ashore, 6-16 1-11
at sea, 6-19 ocean surveillance, 1-11

authority and responsibilities of the senior person special, 1-11


in, 6-16 strike, 1-11
basic elements of, 6-20 Watch organization, 4-5
evasion of the enemy in, 6-17 emergency bills, 4-7
group, 6-20 Watch, quarter, and station bill, 4-5
in a prisoner-of-war (POW) camp, 6-18 Watches, 5-2

T duties of watch standers, 5-2


preparation for, 5-2
Training, readiness, 1-20
relieving, 5-2
exercises, 1-21
security, 5-12
refresher, 1-20
setting, 5-2
routine drills, 1-20
Weapons and weapons systems, 1-12
Training petty officer, 4-21
Aegis, 1-12
developing training schedules, 4-21
Harpoon antiship cruise missile, 1-16
making entries to training records, 4-22
Phalanx close-in weapons system, 1-16
scheduling training events and lectures, 4-21
Phoenix air-to-air missile, 1-18
Training plan, quarterly, 2-4
surface-launched missiles, 1-14
U Tomahawk cruise missile, 1-19
torpedoes, 1-18
Underwater shock. See Air blast, heat, and underwater
shock, protection against Work center, 2-1
Urinalysis testing, 3-13 annual employment schedule, 2-3
changes, 2-7
W
deadlines, 2-7
Warfare, naval, 1-9 division damage control space inventory or
amphibious, 1-11 inspection, 2-2
antiair (AAW), 1-11 division supply inventory, 2-2
antisubmarine (ASW), 1-11 division tool inventory, 2-2
antisurface ship (ASUW), 1-11 goals, 2-6
electronic, 1-11 job assignments, 2-7
fundamental tasks, 1-11 managing the, 2-1
intelligence, 1-11 manning requirements, 2-2
logistics, 1-12 personnel and material readiness, 2-1

INDEX-8
Work center-Continued Work center-Continued
schedule, 2-3 timelines, 2-4
TAD requirements, 2-2 Writing standards, 2-45
tasks, 2-6

INDEX-9
Assignment Questions

Information: The text pages that you are to study are


provided at the beginning of the assignment questions.
COMMANDING OFFICER
NETPDTC
6490 SAUFLEY FIELD RD
PENSACOLA, FL 32509-5237

ERRATA #1 22 Sep 1997

Specific Instructions and Errata for


Nonresident Training Course

MILITARY REQUIREMENTS FOR PETTY OFFICER FIRST CLASS

1. No attempt has been made to issue corrections for errors in typing,


punctuation, etc., that do not affect your ability to answer the question or
questions.

2. To receive credit for deleted questions, show this errata to your local
course administrator (ESO/scorer). The ESO/scorer is directed to correct the
course and the answer key by indicating the questions deleted.

3. Assignment Booklet

Delete the following questions and leave the corresponding spaces blank on
the answer sheets:

Questions
2-1 through 2-42
4-26
ASSIGNMENT 1
Textbook Assignment: Chapter 1, U.S. Naval Tradition, pages 1-1 through 1-22 and Chapter
2, Leadership and Administrative Responsibilities, pages 2-1 through
2-8.

1-1. An element that enables a sea- 1-5. What are the three fundamental
dependent nation to project its pillars on which United States
political, economic, and military military strategy rests?
strengths seaward is known as
1. Maritime superiority,
1. sea power d e t e r r e n c e , and alliance
2. naval power solidarity
3. global strategy 2. Control of the seas,
4. national strategy deterrence, and forward defense
3. Deterrence, forward defense,
1-2. The true strength of sea power can and alliance solidarity
only be measured in terms of a 4. Forward defense, control of the
nations ability to use the sea to seas, and alliance solidarity
further its
1-6. Which of the following responses
1. national objectives could the United States take in the
2. naval power event of aggression by a potential
3. aggression enemy?
4. population
1. Meet force with force
1-3. It is more feasible to send naval 2. Control the duration of the
forces, in comparison to other fighting
military forces, into crisis areas 3. Increase the intensity of the
for which of the following reasons? conflict
4. Each of the above
1. T h e c o s t i s l o w
2. Naval forces can stay on 1-7. The Navy has the ability to outlast
station indefinitely any aggressor with
3. Naval forces leave behind no
physical reminders of their 1. a great number of personnel and
presence materials
4. All of the above 2. secure sea-lanes
3. a large fleet
1-4. To continue to exist as we know it 4. flexibility
today, the United States must have
a policy that recognizes its 1-8. I n time of emergency the Navy must
be able to venture into harms way.
1. economy
2. naval strengths 1. True
3. national security 2. False
4. worldwide commitments

1
1-9. Which of the following is NOT a 1-14. Which of the following fleets would
component of the TRIAD of strategic you find in the Western Pacific and
nuclear forces? Indian Ocean regions?

1. Intercontinental ballistic 1. First


missiles 2. Second
2. S e a - l a u n c h e d b a l l i s t i c m i s s i l e s 3. Third
3. Aircraft carrier battle groups 4. Seventh
4 . Long-range bombers
1-15. Which of the following terms
1-10. What is the most flexible element describes an attack that is
of the TRIAD? intended to inflict damage to,
seize, or destroy an objective?
1. Intercontinental ballistic
missiles 1. Strike
2. Sea-launched ballistic missiles 2. Threat
3. Long-range bombers 3. Assault
4. Cruise missiles 4 . Ag g ressi on

1-11. What is the sole mission and 1-16. Which of the following
fundamental reason for the characteristics of a strike force
existence of the fleet ballistic is one of its greatest assets?
missile submarine?
1. S i z e
1. T o d e t e r w a r 2. M o b i l i t y
2. To seek out and destroy enemy 3. Strength
submarines 4. Weaponry
3. To provide a backup for the
Strategic Air Command 1-17. Which of the following types of
4. To provide the United States task forces is/are organized
with a first strike capability primarily for strike force
operations?
1-12. The TRIAD has been developed and
maintained for which of the 1. C a r r i e r
following purposes? 2. S u r f a c e
3. Submarine
1. To deter nuclear attack 4. All of the above
2. To provide a first strike
capability 1-18. The primary mission of our
3. To maintain nuclear equality submarine force is to destroy which
with the U.S.S.R. of the following types of enemy
4. To act as an instrument of ships?
political leverage or coercion
1. Submarines
1-13. Ships of the Second Fleet patrol 2. Destroyers
some of the worlds most important 3. Carriers
t r a d e r o u t e s . In what area of the 4. Cargo
world does the Second Fleet
normally patrol? 1-19. The first fleet ballistic missile
submarine was launched in what
1. Mediterranean Sea year?
2. Western Atlantic
3. Eastern Atlantic 1. 1955
4. Eastern Pacific 2. 1959
3. 1960
4. 1961

2
1-20. When the term TRIDENT is used, it 1-24. Naval operations generally accepted
is understood to include which of as being nonconventional in nature.
t h e f o l l o w i n g elements?
1. A
1. The base 2. B
2. The missile 3. D
3. The submarine 4. F
4. All of the above
1-25. This type of warfare prevents the
1-21. Trident I missiles have a multiple effective use of cargo-carrying
warhead capability and a maximum vessels by the enemy.
range of how many nautical miles?
1. A
1. 1,200 2. B
2. 2,500 3. C
3. 3,500 4. D
4 . 4,000
1-26. Correctly interpreted, this type of
warfare permits military decisions
A. Antiair to be based on accurate knowledge
B. Antisubmarine of the enemys forces and
C. Antisurface ship capabilities.
D. Strike
E. Intelligence 1. B
F. Special 2. C
3. D
4. E
Figure 1A. --Types of warfare.
1-27. Which of the following types of
TO ANSWER QUESTIONS 1-22 THROUGH 1-26, warfare assists in detecting and
SELECT FROM FIGURE 1A THE TYPE OF WARFARE t a r g e t i n g h o s t i l e forces and making
DESCRIBED IN THE STATEMENT. RESPONSES MAY i t m o r e d i f f i c u l t for the enemy to
BE USED ONCE, MORE THAN ONCE, OR NOT AT detect and target f r i e n d l y f o r c e s ?
ALL.
1. S p e c i a l
1-22. The destruction or neutralization 2. Electronic
of enemy targets ashore through the 3. Intelligence
use of conventional or nuclear 4 . Ocean surveillance
weapons.
1-28. Antiship missiles can be launched
1. A several hundred miles from the
2. B t a r g e t . From which of the
3. C following platforms can they be
4. D launched?

1-23. The destruction or neutralization 1. Aircraft


of enemy surface combatants and 2. Submarines
merchant ships. 3. Surface ships
4. Each of the above
1. B
2. C
3. E
4. F

3
1-39. Through the various treaties with 1-44. As a minimum, how often should you
other countries in the world, wha t assess your divisions personnel
portion of the land area are we and material readiness?
committed to defend?
1. Daily
1. 25% 2 . Biweekly
2. 50% 3. Monthly
3. 75% 4. Quarterly
4. 80%
1-45. When you assess your workers job
1-40. Our naval forces conduct various performance, you should look at
exercises with allied forces for which of the following areas?
which of the following reasons?
1. Knowledge, work habits, and
1. To prepare for deployment character
2. T o p r o f e s s i o n a l l y o p e r a t e a s 2. Attitude, knowledge, and work
one unit habits
3. To develop better foreign 3. Attitude, work habits, and
relations character
4. To allow less units to deploy 4. Attitude, knowledge, and
overseas character

1-41. To ensure your work center meets 1-46. To keep abreast of the knowledge
the deadlines set for the and experience of your personnel,
completion of tasks, which of the you should randomly review each
following factors must you properly members
manage?
1. departmental record
1. Personnel, maintenance, and 2. divisional record
time 3. training record
2. Material, maintenance, and time 4. service record
3 . Personnel, material, and time
4. Maintenance, watch standing, 1-47. At a minimum, how often should you
and time take inventory so that you will
know when to order additional
1-42. Which of the following resources supplies?
w ithin your d ivision are the most
important in accomplishing a task? 1. D a i l y
2. Weekly
1. Personnel and time 3. Monthly
2. Maintenance and time 4. Quarterly
3. Personnel and materials
4 . Maintenance and personnel 1-48. Which of the following logs is used
by your division or department to
1-43. A little time should be spent in maintain its supply inventory?
your office in the morning and
afternoon, then the rest of your 1. EDL
time should be spent in the work 2. JSN
area. 3. OPTAR
4. POA&M
1. True
2. False 1-49. Each command should ensure all hand
and power tools are assigned serial
numbers.

1. True
2. False

5
1-50. The equipment deficiency list 1-56. Jobs on your work center schedule
contains all of the following are listed by what order of
information except precedence?

1. when it was discovered and the 1. Priority


action taken 2. Location
2. the space and space location 3. Numerical
3. the problem or deficiency 4. Alphabetical
4. the PMS requirements
1-57. What writing instrument should be
1-51. What is the work centers most used to fill out a work center
valuable resource? schedule and time line?

1. Equipment 1. Felt-tip marker


2. Personnel 2. Ball-point pen
3. Material 3. Highlighter
4 Schedule 4. Pencil

1-52. The Enlisted Distribution 1-58. After your schedule is approved,


Verification Report can better which of the following requirements
enable your division to fulfill should be met?
which of the following requirements
without an adverse effect? 1. G o a l s
2 . Working hours
1. L i b e r t y 3. Cleaning assignments
2 . Training 4. Maintenance assignments
3. Watch standing
4. Temporary additional duty 1-59. Including your junior petty
officers in the planning process
1-53. Based on the ships overall prevents which of the following
manpower, how are TAD requirements problems from occurring?
usually allocated?
1. Arguments
1. By TYCOM directive 2. Harassment
2 . By work center 3. Skylarking
3. By department 4. Misunderstandings
4. By division
1-60. How many goal setting elements
1-54. Which of the following schedules should you consider when setting
allows for losses in manpower, goals within the work center?
logistic problems, work stoppages,
and personnel training? 1. 1
2. 2
1. Work center schedule 3. 6
2. Annual employment schedule 4. 8
3. Planning board for training
4. Quarterly employment schedule 1-61. Keeping abreast of changes prevents
crisis management from occurring.
1-55. From the annual employment
schedule, all other schedules are 1. True
developed. 2. False

1. True
2. False

6
1-62. When you attend department 1-68. W h o generates letters of
meetings, remember to check which instruction and command counseling
of the following factors before the sheets?
meeting?
1. Work center supervisor
1. Assess personnel 2. D i v i s i o n o f f i c e r
2. Work progress 3. Division chief
3. Organizing 4. Both 2 and 3 above
4. P l a n n i n g
1-69. Counseling sheets and letters of
1-63. As major job completion dates near, instruction are entered in a
you should never allow which of the members service record.
following situations to happen?
1. True
1. Change the work priority 2. False
2. Shorten the work day
3. Neglect major jobs 1-70. A page 13 entry reflects which of
4. Neglect minor jobs the following types of job
performance?
1-64. Assigning your junior petty
officers challenging jobs will 1. Average
increase which of the following 2. Good
skills? 3. Bad
4. Both 2 and 3 above
1. Management
2 . Leadership
3. Organizational
4. Administrative

1-65. The work center supervisor has the


complete responsibility for the
completion of a job.

1. True
2. False

1-66. When delegating authority, you


should delegate to which of the
following competent levels
to develop your subordinates?

1. Highest
2. Average
3. Lowest

1-67. You should inform your subordinates


of their standing in the division
in which of the following ways?

1. By giving awards
2. By the use of counseling
3. By the use of a memorandum
4. By awarding special privileges

7
ASSIGNMENT 2
Textbook Assignment: Chapter 2, L e a d e r s h i p a n d A d m i n i s t r a t i v e R e s p o n s i b i l i t i e s ,
pages 2-28 through 2-43.

QUESTIONS 2-1 THROUGH 2-42 DELETED.

BE SURE TO LEAVE THE CORRESPONDING SPACES BLANK


ON THE ANSWER SHEET.

8
2-38. DELETED 2-43. If you use a facsimile stamp of
someones signature, what should
appear next to the signature to
authenticate the facsimile?

1. Acting
2. By direction
3. Your initials
4. Your signature

2-44. A naval message should be used


instead of a NAVGRAM under which of
the following circumstances?

1. The communication is urgent and


speed is of primary importance
2-39. DELETED 2. The addressee is an overseas
station
3. The communication is classified
4. Its use is cost effective

2-45. If a command is the information


addressee on a message, which of
the following actions, if any,
should the command take concerning
the message?
2-40. DELETED
1. Route the message to concerned
officers to determine the
action addressees
responsibilities
2 . Whatever action is required
within the command
3. The actions directed by the
action addressee
4 . None of the above

2-46. After a naval message has been


2-41. DELETED prepared and signed by the drafter,
which of the following persons
releases the message?

1. The drafter
2. The senior Radioman
3. The delegated releasing officer
4. The communications watch
officer
2-42. DELETED
2-47. Who is responsible for the
validation of the contents of a
message?

1. Originator
2. Addressee
3. Releaser
4. Drafter

13
ASSIGNMENT 3
Textbook Assignment: Chapter 2, Leadership and Administrative Responsibilities, pages
2-44 through 2-54 and Chapter 3, Programs and Policies pages 3-1
through 3-14.

3-1. Our Navy uses a standard filing 3-5. When writing a naval letter, you
system for which of the following should ensure it is well organized
reasons? a n d o r d e r l y . Which of the
following writing methods is NOT in
1. Frequent rotation of personnel the c o r r e c t o r d e r ?
2. Saves the Navy space
3. Saves the Navy money 1. Stating requests before
4. All of the above justifications
2. Stating explanations before
3-2. Which, if any, of the following answers
classified material does not 3. Giving conclusions before
require controlled routing? discussions
4. Giving summaries before details
1. C o n f i d e n t i a l
2. Top secret 3-6. T h e order that references appear in
3. Secret the r e f e r e n c e b l o c k o f a n a v a l
4 . None of the above letter is based on which of the
following factors?
3-3. When filing material you should
include all of the following except 1. The OPNAV/SECNAV number
assigned
1. the incoming document 2. The length of the title of the
2. a copy of the outgoing reference
correspondence 3. The order in which they appear
3. any essential supporting in the text
documents 4. The numerical listing
4. all early drafts and extra
copies 3-7. Paragraphs in a naval letter should
be short and contain roughly what
3-4. Standard subject identification maximum number of sentences?
codes (SSICs) provide which of the
following standard systems 1. 4 to 5
throughout the Navy? 2. 6 to 7
3. 8 to 10
1. Colors 4. 10 to 12
2. Numbers
3. Symbols 3-8. For an idea to gain emphasis within
4. Alphabets a sentence, where should it appear?

1. At the start or the end of the


sentence
2. At the end of the sentence only
3. At the start of tie sentence
only
4. In the middle of the sentence

17
3-9. To save words, clarify ideas, and 3-14. For economy in writing, you should
provide balance when you wish to use as many abbreviations as
express two or more equally possible.
important ideas in a sentence, you
should use which of the following 1. True
types of sentence construction? 2. False

1. Minisentences 3-15. CMEO is an equal opportunity


2. Topic sentences management system controlled
3. Rambling sentences primarily at which of the following
4. Parallel sentences levels?

3-10. To make your writing more like 1. Command


speaking, you should use which of 2. Secretary of Defense
the following writing techniques? 3. Secretary of the Navy
4. Chief of Naval Operations
1. Use personal pronouns
2. Use everyday words 3-16. Which of the following supervisors
3. Use short sentences supports the Navys Equal
4. All of the above Opportunity program?

3-11. Which of the following writing 1. The one who relates positively
practices is the best approach to a and directly with all people
subject when writing a directive? equally
2. The one who only listens to one
1. W r i t e i n t h e t h i r d p e r s o n point of view
style 3. The one who stereotypes people
2. Write directly to a user 4. The one who feels it necessary
3. Write in terms of how to to intimidate some people to
instructions achieve goals
4. Write in terms of how to
checklists 3-17. To manage and supervise people
effectively, you must have which of
3-12. As a subordinate writing to a the following leadership skills?
senior, which of the following
approaches should you avoid when 1. The ability to ignore conflicts
setting the tone of the letter? among various groups
2. The ability to listen to and
1. Directing understand what people have to
2. Suggesting say
3. Requesting 3. The ability to place people in
4. Recommending correct racial, ethnic, and
religious categories
3-13. Which of the following words hurt 4. The ability to substitute
naval writing by stretching generalized ideas about people
sentences, delaying meaning, and when you arent sure of their
hiding responsibility? motives

1. Request you
2. You are
3. It is
4. I am

18
3-18. To help your subordinates grow both 3-23. What two methods of data collecting
personally and professionally, you by the CAT require other data
must use which of the following sources to be used to draw
supervisory practices? conclusions and produce findings
that can be validly interpreted?
1. Provide timely feedback on
performance 1. Command records and Interviews
2. Provide on-the-job training 2. Interviews and observations
3. Identify their strengths and 3. Observations and surveys
weaknesses 4. Surveys and interviews
4. Each of the above
3-24. Nonjudicial punishment is better
3-19. If a person commits an act of known in the Navy by which of the
arbitrary discrimination, the following titles?
commanding officer may take which
of the following disciplinary 1. Mast
actions? 2. Court-martial
3. Captains mast
1. Assign lower evaluation marks 4. Executive officers
2. Award nonjudicial punishment investigation
3. Submit a recommendation for
separation 3-25. Without using court-martial
4. Each of the above intervention. what article of the
UCMJ empowers a commanding officer
3-20. The Navy Rights and to impose punishment for minor
Responsibilities workshop is offenses on both officer and
conducted by which of the following enlisted personnel?
groups?
1. 5
1. Command Training Team (CTT) 2. 10
2. Command Assessment Team (CAT) 3. 15
3. Command Rights and 4. 20
Responsibilities Team
4. Striker Board 3-26. Under the UCMJ, punishment must be
imposed within 2 years of the
3-21. Which of the following subjects is offense.
NOT covered during the Navy Rights
and Responsibilities workshop? 1. True
2. False
1. Navy Regulations
2. Combatant skills 3-27. The Report and Disposition of
3. Enlistment contract Offense(s), NAVPERS 1626/7,
4. Grievance and redress contains all of the following
information except
3-22. I nforma tion concerning equal
opportunity contained in command 1. preliminary inquiry report
records may NOT be obtained through 2. action of the XO at screening
which of the following methods? mast
3. record of any pre-mast
1. Surveys restraint
2. Training 4. all of the required pre-mast
3. Interviews advice that must be given to
4. Observations the accused

19
3-28. Who must ensure that within a 3-34 . Confinement on bread and water has
reasonable amount of time of the a maximum duration of how many
report of an offense that the days?
accused is fully advised of his or
her rights concerning a possible 1. 1
NJP? 2. 2
3. 3
1. Legal officer 4. 4
2. Chief Master-at-Arms
3. Officer contemplating imposing 3-35. Which of the following punishments
NJP i s considered the most severe form
4. Department head and division o f NJP?
officer of the accused
1. Correctional custody
3-29. Your rights are found under what 2. Reduction in grade
UCMJ article? 3. Forfeiture of pay
4. Restriction
1. 15
2. 31 3-36. Under article 15 of the UCMJ, you
3. 37 have how many days to appeal the
4. 38 punishment awarded to you if you
feel that it was unjust or
3-30. The preliminary i n q u i r y o f f i c e r disproportionate?
(PIO) completes what section of the
NAVPERS 1626/7? 1. 5
2. 10
1. C 3. 15
2. E 4. 20
3. G
4. I 3-37. Which of the following terms
describes the Navys recognition
3-31. Under article 15 of the UCMJ, the that drug and alcohol abuse is
commanding officer has how many incompatible with the Navys effort
punishments identified that he or to instill pride and
she can impose at mast? professionalism?

1. 3 1. Zero defects
2. 6 2. Zero tolerance
3. 9 3. Screening with meaning
4. 12 4. Self-referrals preferable

3-32. Restriction is the least severe 3-38. Why has the Navy taken a firm stand
form of deprivation of liberty. against drug abuse?

1. True 1. Drug abuse undermines combined


2. False readiness
2. Drug abuse is costly in lost
3-33. Arrest in quarters may only be man-hours
imposed on which of the following 3. Drug abuse causes the loss of
naval personnel? morale and esprit de corps
4. Each of the above
1. E-1 through E-9
2. W-2 through W-4
3. 0-1 through 0-10
4. Both 2 and 3 above

20
3-39. What is the most valuable detection 3-44. A person who abuses heroin develops
and deterrence tool used by the a t o l e r a n c e f o r t h e d r u g . How does
Navy to identify drug abusers? this tolerance affect the persons
reaction to the drug?
1. Annual physicals
2. Urinalysis testing 1. The drug no longer has an
3. Drug detection dogs effect on the persons central
4. Undercover military police nervous system
2. Larger doses are required for
3-40. Each urinalysis sample is tested the same effect
how many minimum number of times by 3. Smaller doses are required for
one of the Navys drug screening the same effect
laboratories? 4 . The drug no longer has an
effect on the persons
1. 1 bloodstream
2. 2
3. 3 3-45. Normally, which of the following
4. 5 signs is the first emotional
reaction following a dose of
3-41. Under the Navys policy for drug heroin?
abusers, which of the following
actions is taken if a PO2 commits a 1. A f e e l i n g o f r e l i e f
drug abuse offense? 2. A s t a t e o f i n a c t i v i t y
3. A state of extreme stress
1. The person is screened for drug 4. A feeling of weightlessness
dependency
2. The person is afforded 3-46. Drinking a large amount of cough
in-service residential medication is a common method of
treatment abusing which of the following
3. The person is processed for drugs?
immediate separation
4. The person is given a waiver if 1. Opium
he or she has exhibited 2. Heroin
exceptional service 3. Codeine
4. Morphine
3-42. A drug abuser deeply under the
influence of narcotics displays 3-47. A drug abuser who suffers long
which of the following periods of time without sleeping or
characteristics? eating is probably abusing which of
the following types of drugs?
1. Anxiety
2. Lethargy 1. Alcohol
3. Lucidity 2. Narcotics
4. Hostility 3. Stimulants
4. Depressants
3-43. Which of the following
paraphernalia found in a locker is 3-48. A person who has taken an overdose
an indication that the person is a of cocaine may experience which of
narcotics abuser? the following reactions?

1. Bent spoons 1. Death


2. Eyedroppers 2. Anxiety
3. Cotton balls 3. Euphoria
4. All of the above 4. Excitation

21
3-59. Which of the following persons must
have prior knowledge of a drug
detection dog inspection or search?

1. The dog handler


2. The commanding officer
3. Both 1 and 2 above
4. All personnel involved in the
search

3-60. Which of the following types of


behavior could be a positive clue
that a person is abusing some form
of drugs?

1. Wanting to sell a stereo system


and TV set at the same time
2. Repeatedly showing symptoms
associated with drug abuse
3. Botching a job when it is known
that the person is usually a
top performer
4. Keeping tablets, capsules, or
other forms of drugs in ones
locker

23
ASSIGNMENT 4
Textbook Assignment: Chapter 3, Programs and Policies, pages 3-14 through 3-23 and
Chapter 4, P r o f e s s i o n a l R e s p o n s i b i l i t i e s , p a g e s 4 - 1 t h r o u g h 4 - 1 3 .

4-1. The number one drug problem in the 4-5. When, if ever, would the promotion
United States is the abuse of which prospects of a recovered alcoholic
of the following substances? be affected?

1. Alcohol 1. If the recovered alcoholic


2. Cocaine attended a rehabilitation
3. Marijuana program
4. Barbiturates 2. If misconduct or poor
performance resulted from
4-2. Alcohol is classified as what type alcoholism
of drug? 3. If the recovered alcoholic is
still attending AA meetings
1. Hallucinogen 4 . Never
2. Depressant
3. Stimulant 4-6. For which of the following reasons
4. Narcotic does alcohol quickly affect the
central nervous system?
4-3. Which of the following
characteristics or symptoms 1. It is rapidly absorbed by the
identifies a person suffering from kidneys
alcoholism? 2. It remains in the digestive
tract for long periods
1. Physical dependence 3. It is immediately absorbed into
2. Psychological dependence the bloodstream
3. Both 1 and 2 above 4. It is metabolized at a faster
4. Infrequent consumption rate as more is consumed

4-4. All Navy supervisors should be 4-7. What indicator is used by most
familiar with the Navys policy states to determine whether or not
regarding alcoholism as outlined in a person is intoxicated?
the OPNAVINST on alcohol and drug
abuse prevention and control. What 1. Slurred speech
is the purpose of this instruction 2. Blood-alcohol level
with regard to alcohol abuse? 3. Poor motor coordination
4. Number of drinks consumed
1. To discourage the use of
alcohol 4-8. I n the chronic stages of
2. To acknowledge the Navys alcoholism, tolerance decreases
responsibility for counseling markedly until the victim may
and to aid alcoholics in become drunk on relatively small
recovery amounts of alcohol.
3. To publish the disciplinary
action that may be taken 1. True
against a known alcoholic 2. False
4. To set limits on the amount of
alcohol that may be consumed
before a person is considered a
problem drinker

24
4-9. In which of the following ways does 4-12. Many definitions are used to
alcohol, when taken in combination describe problem drinking or
with other drugs, affect the body? alcoholism. Which of the following
statements describes an alcoholic?
1. The other drug is metabolized
quicker than the alcohol and 1. A person who depends on alcohol
has no effect to help him or her function in
2. The other drug is metabolized everyday life
slower than the alcohol and 2. A person who depends on friends
remains active for longer to purchase alcohol
periods 3. A person who frequents bars for
3. The alcohol counteracts the the purpose of getting drunk
other drug, causing little, if 4. A person who thinks that he or
any, effect on the body she must drink to be accepted
4. Both work as a stimulant and
cause severe hyperactivity 4-13. Which of the following statements
i s true concerning the diagnosing
4-10. Which of the following long-term o f alcoholism?
effects can be expected by a person
who is a heavy drinker for a 1. It is often slow to be
prolonged period of time? recognized
2. It is an easily identifiable
1. L o w e r e d r e s i s t a n c e t o disease
infectious diseases 3. It is usually diagnosed in the
2. Damage to the major organs of early stage
the body 4. It is a simple procedure if
3. Deterioration of memory and caught in the early stages of
judgement problem drinking
4. All of the above
4-14. What treatment technique does the
4-11. One definition of a problem drinker Navy use in returning an alcoholic
is one who must drink to function to a useful and productive life?
o r t o c o p e w i t h l i f e . How does the
Navy define a l c o h o l i s m ? 1. A treatment that is developed
by the command
1. Complying with ord inary soc i a l 2. A treatment that must be
drinking customs developed by the individual
2. Drinking alcohol even though 3. One that matches the needs of
under the state-approved age the person to the appropriate
for purchasing alcoholic therapy
beverages 4 . One that provides treatment and
3. Depending on alcohol appropriate disciplinary action
psychologically and/or for each case
physiologically
4. Doing something under the 4-15. Which of the following social
influence of alcohol that would stigmas is usually attached to an
not normally be done alcoholic?

1. Alcoholism only affects the


poor and uneducated
2. Alcoholism is a moral weakness
rather than an illness
3. Alcoholism is a treatable
disease only in its earlier
stages
4. Alcoholism only affects people
who are social outcasts

25
4-16. Alcohol abuse prevention is the 4-21. The Navy operates how many alcohol
responsibility of which of the rehabilitation centers
following persons? (NAVALREHCEN)?

1. The individual 1. 5
2. The commanding officer 2. 6
3. The Chief of Naval Education 3. 3
and Training 4. 4
4. The master chief petty officer
of the Navy 4-22. As a supervisor faced with a drug
or alcohol problem caused by one of
4-17. Which of the following actions can your division personnel, which of
commands take to help eliminate the following helping resources can
practices and customs that you turn to for advice and
encourage personnel to drink? assistance?

1. Emphasize moderation 1. The chaplain


2. Provide educational programs 2. The command master chief
3. Ensure adequate quantities of 3 . The senior personnel around you
nonalcoholic beverages 4. Each of the above
4. Each of the above
4-23. The authority which is granted to
4-18. What is the maximum time a person all officers and petty officers to
may be assigned to a Level II fulfill their duties and
counseling program? responsibilities is known as what
type of authority?
1. 6 months
2. 2 months 1. General
3. 6 weeks 2. Unlimited
4. 4 weeks 3. Meritorious
4. Organizational
4-19. Navy personnel who have a drinking
problem can receive which of the 4-24. The authority that an individual
following types of care from a Navy may hold by virtue of assignment to
hospital? a specific billet within an
organizational unit of the Navy is
1. Evaluation known as what type of authority?
2. Detoxification
3. Primary rehabilitation 1. General
4. All of the above 2. Unlimited
3. Meritorious
4-20. Who is responsible to the 4. Organizational
commanding officer for carrying out
the policies of the Navy Drug and
Alcohol Abuse Program (NADAP)?

1. DAPA
2. CAAC
3. ARD
4. NAVALREHCEN

26
4-34. The temporary withholding of 4-38. When making duty assignments such
privileges is an effective tool in as general quarters stations or a
correcting a minor infraction of a cleaning station, who should be
m i l i t a r y r e g u l a t i o n . Which of the assigned responsibility for that
following privileges CANNOT be duty?
withheld as part of this
nonpunitive measure? 1. A specific work center
2. A specific person
1. Exchange of duty 3. The department
2. Normal liberty 4. The division
3. Base parking
4. Special pay 4-39. As the LPO you are assigning a work
center supervisor to coordinate the
4-35. Which of the following persons has painting of a compartment. The job
the final authority to withhold a is assigned poorly if which of the
privilege? following persons has (a) the
responsibility for the task and (b)
1. Division chief petty officer the authority to accomplish the
2. Work center supervisor task?
3. Commanding officer
4. Each of the above 1. (a) Supervisor
(b) you
4-36. For which of the following reasons 2. (a) Supervisor
would it NOT be appropriate for a (b) supervisor
supervisor to extend an 3. (a) You
individuals normal working hours? (b) supervisor
4. (a) You
1. T o c o m p l e t e a d d i t i o n a l (b) you
essential work
2. To complete a work assignment 4-40. An action or task required by ones
that should have been completed position that is expected or
during working hours required by moral or legal
3 . To perform work to maintain a obligation is a duty. Duties fall
required level of operational into which of the following
readiness categories?
4. To perform work as punishment
for substandard performance of 1. Military only
duty 2. Moral and military
3. Administrative only
4-37. In which of the following 4. Military and administrative
publications will you find the
description of the duties, 4-41. The ships watch organization is
responsibilities, and authority of second in importance only to the
a division officer? o r g a n i z a t i o n f o r b a t t l e . Which of
the following personnel is/are
1. Standard Organization and responsible for understanding the
Regulations of the U.S. Navy wat c h or g ani z at i on?
2. Tactical Action Officers
Handbook 1. Nonrated personnel only
3. Watch Officers Guide 2. Petty officers only
4. Navy Regulations 3. Officers only
4. All hands -

28
4-42. The watch, quarter, and station 4-47. Which of the following management
bill contains which of the tools should be used by the
foll ow ing assignments? division officer to maintain a
current watch, quarter, and station
1. Messing assignments bill?
2. Liberty boat assignments
3. Collision station assignments 1. Battle bill
4. Each of the above 2. Ships bill
3. Division notebook
4-43. Who should approve changes to the 4. Division officers guide
divisions watch, quarter, and
station bill? 4-48. Which of the following explanations
is a purpose of the general
1. Executive officer emergency bill?
2. Commanding officer
3. Officer of the deck 1. To provide detailed procedures
4. Command duty officer for every emergency that can
occur
4-44. Billet numbers on the watch, 2. T o e s t a b l i s h a p l a n f o r
quarter, and station bill consist salvaging captured enemy
of either four numerals or a letter vessels
and three numerals. What do the 3. To organize the crew to handle
last two numerals indicate? the effects of a major
emergency
1. Section seniority 4. Each of the above
2. Division assigned
3. Watch precedence 4-49. Which of the following actions
4. Recall priority should you immediately take if you
see one of your shipmates fall
4-45. Responsibility for ensuring overboard?
division members are aware of their
watch, quarter, and station bill 1. Notify the OOD
assignments is delegated to which 2. C a l l o u t , Man overboard, port
of the following persons? (or starboard) side
3. Provide lifesaving equipment to
1. Division chief the person if possible
2. Division officer 4. All of the above
3. Division leading petty officer
4. Division training petty officer 4-50. Which of the following officers is
responsible for the administration
4-46. The watch, quarter, and station of the CBR defense bill?
bill should be updated at
approximately what minimum 1. Safety officer
frequency? 2. Division officer
3. CBR defense officer
1. Continually 4. Damage control assistant
2. Quarterly
3. Monthly 4-51. Which of the following commands
4. Weekly must have an emergency destruction
bill?

1. A deployable command
2. A command located outside the
United States
3. A command having COMSEC
material
4. A l l o f t h e a b o v e

29
ASSIGNMENT 5
Textbook Assignment: Chapter 4, Professional Responsibilities, pages 4-14 through 4-24
and Chapter 5, Military Requirements, pages 5-1 through 5-15 and
Chapter 6, S a f e t y a n d S u r v i v a l , p a g e s 6 - 1 t h r o u g h 6 - 4 .

5-1. The enlisted service record 5-6. What maximum number of years
contains both official and active service can a master chief
unofficial papers. petty officer serve and still be
eligible to apply for the Chief
1. True Warrant Officer Program?
2. False
1. 24 years
5-2. The actual service record is 2. 20 years
contained on which of the following 3. 16 years
side(s) of the enlisted service 4. 12 years
record?
5-7. Which of the following officer
1. L e f t programs does/do not require a
2. R i g h t college education?
3. Both 1 and 2 above
1. Officer Candidate School
5-3. Personnel Advancement Requirements Program
(PARs) must be completed before you 2. Chief Warrant Officer Program
can participate 3. Limited Duty Officer Program
4. Both 2 and 3 above
1. in the PQS program
2. as a proper watchstander 5-8. Which of the following personnel
3. in the Navywide advancement may apply for the Chief Warrant
exam Officer Program?
4. as the divisional training
petty officer 1. E-6, regular Navy, with 18
years of active service
5-4. Navywide advancement exams are 2. E-7, Naval Reserve, with 10
based on which of the following years of Reserve service
standards? 3. E-8, Regular Navy, with 26
years of active service
1. PQS standards 4. E-9, Training and
2. PMS standards Administration of Reserves
3. Naval standards (TAR), with 22 years of service
4. Occupational standards
5-9. Personnel who apply for the CWO
5-5. Which of the following Physicians Assistant Program must
commissioning programs provides the be graduates of only the Basic
Navy with officers who are Hospital Corps School.
technical specialists in their
fields? 1. True
2. False
1. Limited Duty Officer Program
2. Chief Warrant Officer Program
3. Enlisted Commissioning Program
4. Officer Candidate School
Program

32
5-10. Which of the following personnel 5-14. Which of the following
may NOT apply for the Limited Duty commissioning programs requires
Officer Program? that you have at least a
baccalaureate degree?
1. E-7 with 8 years of active
service 1. Enlisted Commissioning Program
2. E-8 with 14 years of active 2. Limited Duty Officer Program
service 3. Officer Candidate School
3. E-9 with 15 years of active Program
service 4. Chief Warrant Officer Program
4. E-6 with 10 years of active
service and 2 years time in 5-15. Which of the following courses
rate is/are recommended for an
individual preparing for LDO
5-11. If you are a PO1 applicant for LDO selection?
and have met all requirements of
CPO/SCPO applicants, which of the 1. Navy Regulations
following additional requirements 2. Human Behavior
must you meet? 3. Watch Officer
4 . Each of the above
1. Have a final multiple score
(FMS) equal to or greater than 5-16. Quarters for muster and inspection
the lowest FMS for PASS are held each work day just before
SELECTION BOARD ELIGIBLE
2. Have Personnel Advancement 1. 0600
Requirements for E-8 signed off 2. 0700
3. Have been awarded the Navy 3. 0800
Commendation Medal 4. 0900
4. All of the above
5-17. Navy Regulations requires the
5-12. What minimum active service clothing of all nonrated personnel
obligation must ECP selectees have to be inspected at what interval?
before detaching from their present
command? 1. Annually
2. Semiannually
1. 6 years 3. At regular intervals
2. 2 years 4. At irregular intervals
3. 3 years
4. 4 years 5-18. As a senior watch stander in charge
of a watch, you are responsible for
5-13. ECP selectees must have finished the personnel assigned to your
sufficient undergraduate course watch. Which of the following
work to be able to complete requirements should you ensure is
requirements for a technical degree met concerning the proper relief of
within what maximum length of time? your watch personnel?

1. 36 months 1. They should all be relieved at


2. 48 months the same time
3. 50 months 2 . They should remain on station
4. 60 months until properly relieved
3. They should train their reliefs
on proper relieving procedures
4. They should instruct their
reliefs on proper performance
of duty

33
5-19. As the relieving OOD of a ship 5-24. What phrase should you use as the
moored to a pier, which of the relieving OOD when you are ready to
following checks should be part of relieve the watch?
your relieving procedure?
1. I have it, you are relieved
1. Determining which lines are in sir/maam
use 2. I am ready to relieve you,
2. Reviewing current SOPA sir/maam
instructions 3. I am prepared to assume the
3. Determining which special watch
conditions exist or are 4. I will take the watch after
expected briefing
4. Each of the above
5-25. In the absence of the commanding
5-20. A change in a ships watch officer in port, who is primarily
condition when getting underway, responsible for the safety and
mooring, or modifying the condition proper operation of the unit?
of readiness is called
1. S a f e t y o f f i c e r
1. dogging the watch 2. MAA safety force
2. setting the watch 3. Officer of the deck
3. changing the guard 4. Command master chief
4. relieving the watch
5-26. Which of the following
5-21. Experience has shown that the watchstanding assignments gives a
ability to handle casualties and petty officer equal status with a
tactical decisions is significantly commissioned or chief warrant
reduced during which of the officer assigned to the same watch?
following events?
1. MAA
1. When the watch is being set 2. OOD
2. When the ship is entering port 3. POOW
3. When the watch is being changed 4. Each of the above
4. When the ship is leaving
anchorage 5-27. To stand OOD inport watches, you
must be designated in writing by
5-22. If continuity of watches has been which of the following individuals?
interrupted, you should read the
commentary sections of the ships 1. Commanding officer
deck log for what minimum number of 2. Senior watch officer
preceding watches before relieving 3. Command duty officer
the OOD? 4. Watch bill coordinator

1. One 5-28. If weather conditions are such that


2. Two suspending boating operations is
3. Three advisable, what officer does the
4. Four OOD immediately notify?

5-23. During the relief of the OOD, who 1. Safety officer


is responsible for ensuring the 2. Boating officer
oncoming OOD is properly briefed on 3. First lieutenant
the overall situation of the ship? 4. Command duty officer

1. The offgoing OOD only


2. The oncoming OOD only
3. The offgoing and the oncoming
OOD
4. The operations officer

34
5-29. As part of a routine watch, at 5-34. While in Rota, Spain, refuge is
which of the following times does granted to a person aboard your
the 00D obtain permission from the ship, but foreign authorities
commanding officer to strike eight request return of the person. To
bells? which of the following authorities
should the request be reported?
1. 2400, 0400, and 0800
2. 1200, 2400, and 0400 1. Chief of Naval Operations
3. 0800, 1200, and 2000 2. Secretary of the Navy
4 . 0800, 1600, and 2400 3. American Embassy
4. Spanish Embassy
5-30. On ships having a Marine
detachment, brow and pier sentries 5-35. Which of the following publications
report to which of the following provides detailed guidance in
individuals? preparing the Ships Deck Log?

1. Officer of the deck 1. United States Navy Regulations


2. Sergeant of the guard 2. Standard Organization and
3. Petty officer of the watch Regulations of the U.S. Navy
4. Junior officer of the deck 3. Preparing, Maintaining, and
Submitting the Ships Deck Log
5-31. If you apprehend someone for a 4. Boatswains Mate 1 & C
violation of the UCMJ, at what
point does your responsibility for 5-36. The ships deck log may be used in
the apprehension end? which of the following ways?

1. When the person is delivered to 1. A s a c h r o n o l o g i c a l r e c o r d o f


proper authority ships events
2. When the person is placed in 2. A s l e g a l e v i d e n c e i n f a c t
confinement finding proceedings
3. When the person is given his or 3. Both 1 and 2 above
her rights 4. As a record of the proceedings
4. When the person is physically of a safety committee meeting
restrained
5-37. The original copy of the ships
5-32. During which of the following deck log is submitted monthly to
degrees of restraint may an the CNO. For what minimum length
individual be required to perform of time is a copy of the deck log
full military duties? retained on board before being
destroyed?
1. Arrest
2. Confinement 1. 1 year
3. Restriction in lieu of arrest 2. 6 months
4. Each of the above 3. 3 months
4. 5 years
5-33. A person seeking asylum aboard a
Navy ship on the high seas may be
surrendered to foreign authorities
upon the authorization of which of
the following persons?

1. U.S. Customs agent


2. Commanding officer
3. Secretary of the Navy
4. Each of the above

35
5-38. If you make a mistake in the ships 5-42. During general visiting a guide
deck log, which of the following should be assigned to each group of
procedures should you use to visitors. What maximum number of
correct the mistake? visitors should be in each group?

1. Draw a single line through the 1. 10


error, insert the correct 2. 15
entry, and initial 3. 25
2. Print the word error after 4. 50
the mistake and insert the
correct entry 5-43. If the commanding officer of a ship
3. Erase the error and insert the approves a classified visit by a
correct entry foreign national, who, if anyone,
4. Black out the error, insert the mus t a l s o a ut ho r i z e t h e vis i t ?
correct entry, and initial
1. Secretary of Defense
5-39. Certifying that the ships deck log 2. Secretary of the Navy
entries are correct and complete 3. Chief of Naval Operations
before submitting the log to the 4. No one
commanding officer for signature is
the responsibility of the 5-44. Who is directly responsible to the
commanding officer for the posting
1. engineer of all security watches and
2. navigator sentries?
3. quartermaster
4. command duty officer 1. O f f i c e r o f t h e d e c k
2. Command duty officer
5-40. During a quiet, uneventful watch, 3. Sergeant of the guard
what attitude should the OOD take 4. Petty officer of the watch
concerning the security of the
ship? 5-45. When armed and standing the OOD
watch, when may you remove the
1. Vigilance must be maintained by pistol from its holster?
at least one alert person
2. Security may be relaxed, 1. When a pleasure boat refuses to
depending on the situation, but leave the area
the possibly of sabotage must 2 . When you must resist forceful
be kept in mind entry to the ship
3. Threats to the ship are minimal 3. When you must make the
and the watch should be inspection required when
permitted to relax for short relieving the watch
periods 4. Both 2 and 3 above
4. Security of the ship is
paramount at all times and must 5-46. If the fantail security watch
never be relaxed issues a challenge and no answer is
received, which of the following
5-41. General visiting aboard ship is actions should be taken to summon
normally conducted between which of assistance?
the following hours?
1. Sound a whistle
1. 0800 to 1100 2. Y e l l , Help, help, help
2. 1100 to 1300 3. Fire three shots into the air
3. 1300 to 1600 4. Leave the post and call the OOD
4. 1800 to 2100 from the nearest phone

36
5-57. Which of the f o l l o w i n g p u b l i c a t i o n s
o u t l i n e s t h e command safety program
and the safety organization?

1. Standard Organization and


Regulations of the U.S. Navy
2. U.S. Navy Safety Precautions
Manual
3. Navy Safety Precautions for
Forces Afloat
4. Navy Occupational Safety and
Health Program

5-58. In general, safe working conditions


cannot be achieved by one person or
one program. Which of the
following efforts is required to
achieve mishap-free working
conditions?

1. The support of all hands


2. Effective safety monitors
3. An effective safety program
4. An active safety petty officer

5-59. To do a good job of detecting


unsafe practices, which of the
following types of safety
observations should you use?

1. Planned
2. Deliberate
3. Incidental
4. Each of the above

38
ASSIGNMENT 6
Textbook Assignment: Chapter 6, Safety and Survival, pages 6-4 through 6-22.

6-1. Which of the following tools does a 6-5. Enlisted safety committee
supervisor use to identify and recommendations concerning the
develop solutions to eliminate command safety program are
hazards? submitted to which of the following
persons?
1. Job inventory
2. Job safety analysis 1. Safety council (department head
3. Incidental observation level)
4. Deliberate observation 2. Division officer
3. Engineer officer
6-2. Which of the following factors is a 4. Chief master at arms
safety benefit of a job safety
analysis (JSA)? 6-6. The commands enlisted safety
committee should convene according
1. The use of the completed JSA to what schedule?
2. The discovery of cost-reducing
improvements 1. Weekly
3. The improvement of the workers 2. Monthly
safety attitudes 3. Bimonthly
4. The improvement to the work 4. Biannually
environment
6-7. Assisting the safety officer in
6-3. Which of the following forms can be keeping the safety program visible
used to document a safety to all hands is the responsibility
observation or a JSA? of which of the following groups?

1. OPNAV Form 1348/6 1. Safety council


2. OPNAV Form 5100/14 2. MAA/Safety force
3. A locally prepared form 3. Safety committee
4. Either 2 or 3 above 4. Division safety petty officers

6-4. Which of the following are the two 6-8. Which of the following people can
basic principles of mishap provide the best safety policing
prevention? system?

1. To spot potential mishap causes 1. MAA/Safety force


and provide safety training 2. Safety petty officers
2. To eliminate potential mishap 3. Each person on board
causes and prevent mishaps 4 . Safety committee
3. To spot and to eliminate
potential mishap causes 6-9. According to NAVOSH regulations,
4 . Both 2 and 3 above you are required to immediately
report all observed workplace
hazards to which of the following
persons?

1. Supervisor
2. Executive officer
3. Commanding officer
4. Safety petty officer

39
6-10. Before allowing personnel to 6-15. Rip-out teams to remove asbestos
operate or repair industrial will be composed of what minimum
equipment, you should ensure that number of persons?
they have a practical knowledge of
which of the following aspects of 1. 5
the equipment? 2. 2
3. 3
1. Applicable safety precautions 4. 4
2. Operation or repair
3. Both 1 and 2 above 6-16. Who trains safety petty officers
4. Current value and damage control petty officers
in selecting, fit-testing, and
6-11. I f one of your people has a maintaining respirators?
circulatory disease, you should not
allow that person to operate which 1. Fire marshall
of the following types of tools? 2. Division officer
3. Damage control assistant
1. Power driven tools 4. Gas-free engineering officer
2. Woodworking tools
3. Vibrating tools 6-17. Which of the following types of
4. Hand tools equipment should be used as a
source of breathing air ONLY in
6-12. What OPNAV instruction requires emergency situations?
supervisors to ensure that their
personnel are aware of safety 1. Mark V gas mask
precautions, the work site is safe, 2. Supplied-air respirator
and personnel are outfitted with 3. Oxygen breathing apparatus
protective clothing? 4. Self-contained breathing
apparatus
1. 3120.3A
2. 5100.19B 6-18. Surgical masks can be used in place
3. 5100.23B of a filter respirator.
4. 5100.12A
1. True
6-13. Which of the following materials is 2. False
prohibited from use or storage
aboard ship? 6-19. What respirator cartridge color
should be used when working around
1. Bleach slurry org a n i c v a p ors?
2. Methyl bromide
3. Sodium bisulfite 1. Black
4. High-test hypochlorite 2. Green
3. Brown
6-14. Who must approve the removal of 4. Yellow
asbestos insulation aboard ship?
6-20. Wh a t col or ca rtri d g e p r o t e c t s
1. Damage control assistant a g a i n st ra d i oa cti v e m a t e r i a l s ?
2. Commanding officer
3. Engineer officer 1. Orange
4. Safety officer 2. Green
3. Purple
4. Red

40
6-21. Personnel should be entered in a 6-26. The controlling document for the
hearing testing program if they are entire tag-out procedure is the
required to work in a designated
noise hazard area with sound levels 1. 3-M Manual
that average more than what maximum 2. tag-out log
decibel (dB) level? 3. maintenance manual
4. NAVOSH Manual for Forces Afloat
1. 25 dB
2. 56 dB 6-27. The number of tag-out logs that
3. 78 dB each ship class must maintain is
4. 84 dB specified by which of the following
individuals?
6-22. Which of the following tasks
requires that you wear eye 1. Chief of Naval Operations
protection while preforming the 2. Commanding officer
job? 3. Squadron commander
4. Force commander
1. Sandblasting
2. Pouring molten metals 6-28. The tag-out log has 4 sections
3. Dust-producing operations maintained within the log.
4. Each of the above
1. True
6-23. Which of the following personnel is 2. False
responsible for identifying eye-
hazardous areas? 6-29. On non-nuclear ships a tag-out
audit is conducted every
1. Safety officer
2. Commanding officer 1. week
3. Safety petty officer 2. two weeks
4. Work center supervisor 3. month
4. quarter
6-24. If a worker has a visual impairment
in one eye, the person is required 6-30. Your signature on the tag-out log
to wear protective eye wear when after an audit serves which of the
performing which of the following following purposes?
jobs?
1. That you have seen the log
1. Combat duties 2. That you found no errors in the
2. Mess cooking duties log
3. Standing a military watch 3. That you have signed By
4. Each of the above direction for the commanding
officer
6-25. A heat stress survey should be 4. That the log is verified up to
conducted whenever the work station date
dry-bulb reading exceeds what
temperature? 6-31. When placed in a survival
situation, what publication(s)
1. 100 F give(s) the senior person the
2. 90 F a u th ori ty to b e i n ch a rg e?
3. 80 F
4. 75 F 1. Code of Conuct
2. Navy Regulations
3. Both 1 and 2 above
4. Secret ballot voting

41
6-32. Survival is a group or team effort. 6-37. In the art of survival, which of
What total percentage of individual the f o l l o w i n g requirements permits
effort must be put forth by each you to see but not be seen?
member to make sure the group or
team is not captured? 1. Your sight
2. Camouflage
1. 20 percent 3. The terrain
2. 60 percent 4. your hearing
3. 85 percent
4. 100 percent 6-38. Evading the enemy in open woods is
difficult because under favorable
6-33. In a shore survival situation, if conditions enemy observers are able
you are the senior member, the will to see up to what maximum distance?
to survive becomes a personal
struggle between the environment 1. 100 yards
and 2. 150 yards
3. 200 yards
1. your specific personal 4. 250 yards
qualities
2. your weakest team member 6-39. The most common deterrent to
3. your emergency rations successful evasion is a negative
4. your junior personnel a t t i t u d e . A negative attitude can
be related to, caused by, or a lack
6-34. A l l persons placed in a survival of which of the following survival
situation feel which of the traits?
following useful emotions?
1. Patience
1. Fear 2. Security
2. Confusion 3. Common sense
3. Exhaustion 4. All of the above
4. Frustration
6-40. At times, even though you do all
6-35. In a survival situation, when you that you can to evade the enemy,
become more alert, hear better, see you are captured. When this
better, and are able to perform happens, what does the Code of
feats of strength, you are Conduct direct you to do as soon as
experiencing you are captured?

1. a normal reaction to fear 1. Answer any and all of the


2. a psychological breakdown enemys questions
3. harmonic convergence 2. Begin planning your escape
4. complete exhaustion 3. Be nice to the enemy
4. Relax
6-36. To improve your chances of s u r v i v a l
i n any situation, you must have the 6-41. Experience has proved that model
attitude that you will survive at POW camps, where food is regular
a l l c o s t s . Which of the following and treatment is considerate, fall
traits will enhance your chances of into which of the following
survival? categories?

1. Courage 1. They are only found within 100


2. Persistence miles of the front lines
3. Attentiveness 2. They are located only in enemy
4. All of the above territory
3. They are the normal camps
4. They are the exception

42
6-42. Being captured does not mean that 6-46. If you are the senior person in a
you cannot still be useful to your survival at-sea situation, you will
Country. If captured, your duty is be responsible for making sure your
to take which of the following group is safe. Which of the
actions? following techniques will aid you
in boosting morale?
1. Resist the enemy by all
possible means 1. Singing
2. Provide any information the 2. Praying
enemy wants 3. Joking
3. Work for the enemy to get 4. All of the above
special favors
4. Promise the enemy you wont try 6-47. As the senior person in charge of a
to escape survival group, you are in charge
and must use authority fairly.
6-43. Informing on a fellow prisoner in a Besides the Code of Conduct, what
POW camp is forbidden except under else gives you this authority?
which, if any, of the following
conditions? 1. The Geneva Convention
2. The U.S. Constitution
1. You feel no one will be injured 3. The Bill of Rights
2. You feel the information will 4. Navy Regulations
help all fellow prisoners
3. You feel the fellow prisoner 6-48. I f you and your group are isolated
has betrayed all other behind enemy lines, your chances of
prisoners making it to friendly forces can be
4. None of the above greatly enhanced if you always
remember the meaning of the letters
6-44. I n a Prisoner of war camp, the in what key word?
senior line officer or non-
commissioned officer (NCO) assumes 1. Evasion
command of fellow prisoners without 2. Capture
regard to branch of service. If 3. Survival
this senior officer or NCO becomes 4. Regulation
incapacitated for any reason, who,
i f anyone, assumes command? 6-49. It is often said that undue haste
makes waste. In a survival
1. No one situation, if you are careless and
2. Any staff-NCO impatient, you will begin to
3. The next senior person encounter which of the following
4. The junior enlisted person experiences?

6-45. What words in the Code of Conduct 1. The taking of unnecessary risks
signify each Americans faith and 2. The feeling of being more at
confidence in their country and ease
service? 3. An increase in your survival
chances
1. If I become a prisoner of war, 4. A decrease in your fear of the
I will keep faith with my enemy
fellow prisoners
2. If I am captured I will
continue to resist by all means
available
3. I will never surrender of my
own free will
4. I am an American, fighting in
the forces which guard my
country and our way of life

43
6-50. In a survival situation, you can 6-55. Which of the following factors is
always improve your situation if important in a survival situation
you take which of the following and greatly reduces your chances of
actions? survival and escape if it is lost?

1. Improvise 1. Your knowledge of the area


2. Fight sleep 2. Your ability to find enough
3. Submit to fear food
4. Get lots of sleep 3. Your health and strength and
that of your group
6-51. The best chance for survival 4. Your ability to understand the
belongs to a group with a leader language of your enemy
who encourages the group to
practice which of the following
methods of working with others?

1. Work in separate groups


2. Work with the enemy
3. Work independently
4. Work together

6-52. If a group is to survive, it must


be highly organized; therefore,
each person must be assigned tasks
based on which of the following
criteria?

1. The desires of the leader


2. The results of secret ballot
votes
3. The feelings of the group at
the time
4. The personal qualifications of
each person

6-53. Having wounded personnel in a


survival situation can place a
strain on the group. Which of the
following policies will help to
ease the strain?

1. Each person must look out for


himself
2 . Wounded and injured persons
will NOT be left behind
3. Before leaving wounded and
injured persons behind, first
aid will be provided
4 . Injured and wounded will be
directed toward the nearest Red
Cross-sanctioned POW camp

6-54. Your best chance for survival is to


learn the techniques and methods of
survival.

1. True
2. False

44
7-11. After the DCPO and duty DCPO 7-17. When making assignments to repair
selections are made by the division parties, which of the following
officer, which of the following practices should you avoid?
officials must be informed of the
assignments? 1. Reassigning mass numbers of
personnel
1. Executive officer 2. Replacing a petty officer with
2. Fire marshal a Seaman
3. Damage control assistant 3. Assigning someone who has not
4. Both 2 and 3 above fully completed damage control
PQS
7-12. Who is responsible for supervising 4. Replacing a person with someone
the setting of specified damage who has just reported aboard
control material conditions within
division spaces? 7-18. When personnel are engaged in
repair party activities, they
1. Damage control petty officer should NOT wear uniforms made of
2. Work center supervisor which of the following types of
3. Leading petty officer material?
4. Division officer
1. Polyester double knit
7-13. The damage control administrative 2. Gabardine
organization is contained within 3. Cotton
what department? 4. Wool

1. Engineering 7-19. Under which of the following


2. Operations circumstances may repair party
3. Weapons personnel omit wearing life jackets
4. Deck and carrying a protective mask?

7-14. What organization is responsible 1. When acting as repair party


for keeping the commanding officer leader
advised of the capabilities of the 2. When acting as on-scene leader
ship after a casualty? 3. When performing first aid
4. When wearing the OBA
1. Deck division
2. Repair parties 7-20. What is the minimum acceptable
3. Operations department number of personnel needed to
4. Damage control central compose the duty damage control
p a rty ?
7-15. What person is responsible for
assigning personnel to repair 1. 6
parties? 2. 12
3. 15
1. Commanding officer 4. 18
2. E x e c u t i v e o f f i c e r
3. Division officer 7-21. During general quarters which of
4 . Department head the following persons is/are
responsible for setting material
7-16. Who ensure(s) replacement personnel condition Zebra in manned spaces?
assigned to repair parties are
properly trained and that they 1. Damage control assistant
attain PQS qualifications? 2. Personnel in the space
3. Repair party leader
1. Division officers 4. On-scene leader
2. Engineering officer
3. Repair party leaders
4. Damage control assistant

46
7-22. Condition Zebra is fully set when 7-28. The at-sea fire party normally
which of the following conditions consists of what minimum number of
has been met? persons?

1. When all Yoke and Circle W 1. 5


fittings have been checked 2. 10
2. When all X-ray and Circle W 3. 15
fittings have been checked 4. 18
3. When all X-ray and Yoke
fittings have been checked 7-29. At-sea, which of the following
4. When all Circle W and Red indications may be a symptom of a
Circle Zebra fittings have been dangerous condition?
checked
1. Wisp of smoke
7-23. To handle battle casualties, most 2 . Minor loss of power
ships have what minimum number of 3. Excessive warmth of a bulkhead
battle dressing stations? 4 . Each of the above

1. One 7-30. What are the first two steps in


2. Two handling battle damage?
3. Three
4. Four 1. Secure electrical circuits and
put out fires
7-24. In the absence of the repair party 2. Put out fires and control
leader, what person is in charge of flooding
the repair locker? 3. Remove casualties and control
flooding
1. Damage control petty officer 4. Isolate broken pipelines and
2. Senior person at the locker effect repairs
3. On-scene leader
4. Investigator 7-31. For which of the following reasons
should a detailed investigation be
7-25. What person informs DCC of the made as soon as possible after
nature of a fire or damage at the damage occurs?
scene?
1. Secondary damage may be
1. Investigator undetected
2. Boundary setter 2. Hot splinters may be buried in
3. On-scene leader combustibles
4. Repair party leader 3. Flooding may be occurring from
partly opened valves
7-26. To be an on-scene leader, you 4. Each of the above
should be qualified in which of the
following areas? 7-32. As a general rule, what degree of
flooding indicates that a
1. Investigator compartment is open to the sea?
2. Fire fighting
3. Damage control repair 1. Compartment is completely
4. Each of the above flooded
2. Compartment is flooded to sea
7-27. Each repair locker has what minimum level
number of investigators assigned to 3. Both 1 and 2 above
it? 4. Compartment has water leaking
from seams
1. E i g h t
2. S i x
3. Five
4 . Four

47
7-33. For a compartment to completely 7-38. When fighting a class C fire which
flood from the deck to the of the following actions should you
overhead, which of the following take first?
conditions must exist in the
compartment? 1. Secure the compartment
2. Deenergize all circuits
1. It must be vented 3. Establish fire boundaries
2. It must be completely secured 4. Spray with water to cool the
from the sea fire
3. It must be isolated from all
other compartments 7-39. After a compartment has been
4. It must have no ventilation flooded with CO 2 , what minimum
fittings length of time should you wait
before opening the compartment?
7-34. Which of the following methods can
be used to control flooding? 1. 1 hour
2. 30 minutes
1. Jettisoning equipment 3. 15 minutes
2. Ensure water tight doors are 4. 10 minutes
open
3. Ensure all electrical power is 7-40. What is the primary means of
secured communicating between stations
4. Each of the above while combating damage?

7-35. When rendering first aid to a 1. Sound-powered telephone


victim, you should check the person 2. Ships service telephone
for breathing, shock, and 3. Messenger
hemorrhage in what order? 4. Intercom

1. Hemorrhage, breathing, shock 7-41. Which of the following circuits is


2. Breathing, hemorrhage, shock the main damage control intercom
3. Shock, breathing, hemorrhage circuit?
4. Hemorrhage, shock, breathing
1. 1 MC
7-36. A fire will be extinguished when 2. X-40J
which of the following components 3. 3 MC
is eliminated? 4. 4 MC

1. Fuel 7-42. Which of the following components


2. Heat of a nuclear weapon constitutes the
3. Oxygen most probable hazards in the event
4. Each of the above of an accident?

7-37. When you are treating an 1. Radiation and plutonium


unconscious person, you should NOT 2. Radiation and gamma rays
provide which of the following 3. High explosives and plutonium
actions? 4. High explosives and gamma rays

1. Remove clothing 7-43. Any accident involving a nuclear


2. Administer water or morphine weapon will result in a nuclear
3. Administer medical assistance explosion.
4. Each of the above
1. True
2. False

48
7-54. In a contaminated ship, which of 7-60. Symptoms of a nerve agent will
the following types of radiation is occur about 1 minute after
the most significant radiation exposure. Approximately what
hazard? length of time will pass before
death occurs?
1. Alpha particles
2. Beta particles 1. 1 hour
3. Gamma rays 2. 6 minutes
4. All of the above 3. 30 minutes
4. 1 day
7-55. Which of the following methods
would most likely be used to 7-61. If a nerve agent is in the
disseminate BW agents? atmosphere in your location, you
should don your protective mask.
1. Aerosol The mask may be removed under which
2. Rocket of the following circumstances?
3. Shell
4. Bomb 1. One hour has elapsed since the
attack
7-56. The use of chemical warfare is 2 . Two hours have elapsed since
directed primarily toward which of the attack
the following targets? 3. The all clear signal is given
4. The agent can no longer be seen
1. Man in the atmosphere
2. Animals
3. Equipment 7-62. What is the maximum number of
4. Buildings atropine injections you may give
yourself without medical
7-57. Which of the following weapons can supervision?
be used to deliver CW agents?
1. 1
1. Bombs 2. 2
2. Shells 3. 3
3. Rockets 4. 4
4. Each of the above
7-63. What is the first thing you should
7-58. Which of the following CW agents is do if your eyes become contaminated
NOT considered a casualty agent? with a nerve agent?

1. Vomiting 1. Use a nerve agent antidote


2. Blister 2. Put on your protective mask
3. Blood 3. Report to the nearest medical
4. Nerve facility
4. Flush your eyes with
7-59. Which of the following CW agents is uncontaminated water
considered to be the most
dangerous? 7-64. What is the immediate
decontamination procedure for the
1. Blood treatment of blister agents in the
2. Nerve eyes?
3. Blister
4. Choking 1. Inject atropoine
2. Flush with water
3. Use the skin decontamination
kit
4. Report to the nearest medical
facility

50
7-65. If a person receives a heavy 7-70. During what phase of disaster
concentration of a choking agent, relief are survey teams dispatched
death may occur within what to the disaster area?
approximate length of time?
1. Phase I
1. 12 hours 2. Phase II
2. 24 hours 3. Phase III
3. 3 hours 4. Phase IV
4. 48 hours
7-71. Under which of the following
7-66. If you receive a concentration of a conditions should personnel going
choking agent and experience into a disaster area be armed?
nausea, v o m i t i n g , o r d i f f i c u l t y i n
breathing, which of the following 1. When authorized by the
actions should you take? commanding officer
2. When food and water will be in
1. Continue your normal combat short supply
duties 3. When the relief party will
2. R e p o r t t o t h e n e a r e s t m e d i c a l remain overnight
facility 4. When looting will be a problem
3. I n j e c t t h r e e s h o t s o f a t r o p i n e
4. Rest quietly until evacuated by 7-72. The purpose of disaster relief is
medical personnel to provide

7-67. Which of the following CW agents 1. rehabilitation


has been employed extensively as a 2. emergency relief
riot control agent? 3. permanent shelter
4. disaster prevention
1. Choking
2. Vomiting 7-73. During what level of mission-
3. Blister oriented protective posture (MOPP)
4. Tear is all protective equipment
required to be worn?
7-68. Which of the following CW agents is
used for harassment but also may be 1. Level 1
dispersed with lethal chemical 2. Level 2
agents? 3. Level 3
4. Level 4
1. Vomiting
2. Blister 7-74. As the on-scene leader, which of
3. Nerve the following postfire actions
4. Tear should you take?

7-69 When planning for a disaster 1. Test for explosive gases


response, your activity should 2. Set a reflash watch
first be concerned with which of 3. Overhaul the fire
the following considerations? 4. All of the above

1. Survival of the community 7-75. Which of the following odors may


2. The activitys own survival indicate the presence of blood
3. Type of communications needed agents?
4. Type of communications
available 1. Garlic
2. New-mown hay
3. Bitter almonds
4. Fruity camphor

51

Das könnte Ihnen auch gefallen